Está en la página 1de 400

VOLVO V60

Owners Manual Web Edition


DEAR VOLVO OWNER
THANK YOU FOR CHOOSING VOLVO

We hope you will enjoy many years of driving pleasure in your Volvo. In order to increase your enjoyment of the car, we recommend that
The car has been designed for the safety and comfort of you and your you familiarise yourself with the equipment, instructions and mainte-
passengers. Volvo is one of the safest cars in the world. Your Volvo nance information contained in this owner's manual.
has also been designed to satisfy all current safety and environmental
requirements.
Table of contents

00 01 02
00 Introduction 01 Safety 02 Locks and alarm
Important information................................. 6 Seatbelts .................................................. 16 Remote control key/key blade.................. 46
Volvo and the environment....................... 11 Airbags...................................................... 19 Privacy locking*......................................... 51
Activating/deactivating the airbag*........... 22 Battery replacement, remote control key/
Side airbags (SIPS bags) ......................... 24 PCC*......................................................... 53
Inflatable Curtain (IC) ............................... 26 Keyless drive*............................................ 55
WHIPS ...................................................... 27 Locking/unlocking..................................... 59
When the systems deploy ........................ 29 Child safety locks...................................... 64
Safety mode.............................................. 30 Alarm*....................................................... 65
Child safety............................................... 31

2 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


Table of contents

03 04 05
03 Your driving environment 04 Comfort and driving pleasure 05 Infotainment system
Instruments and controls.......................... 70 Menus and messages............................. 142 General information on infotainment...... 220
Volvo Sensus ........................................... 79 Menu source MY CAR............................ 144 Quick start............................................... 222
Key positions............................................ 80 Climate control........................................ 152 General infotainment functions............... 226
Seats......................................................... 82 Fuel-driven engine block heater and pas- Radio....................................................... 229
Steering wheel.......................................... 87 senger compartment heater*.................. 162 Media player........................................... 236
Lighting..................................................... 88 Additional heater*.................................... 165 External audio source via AUX/USB*
Wipers and washing.................................. 97 Trip computer......................................... 166 input........................................................ 240
Windows, rearview and door mirrors...... 100 DSTC – Stability and traction control sys- Media BluetoothŸ* ................................. 243
tem.......................................................... 168
Compass*............................................... 105 TV*........................................................... 246
Adapting driving characteristics............. 170
Power sunroof*....................................... 106 Remote control* ..................................... 249
Cruise control*........................................ 171
Alcoguard*.............................................. 108 BluetoothŸ handsfree*............................ 251
Speed limiter*.......................................... 173
Starting the engine.................................. 112 Voice recognition* mobile phone............ 259
Adaptive cruise control*.......................... 175
Starting the engine – Flexifuel................. 114 Menu navigation, Infotainment............... 263
Distance Warning*.................................. 185
Starting the engine – external battery..... 116
City Safety™........................................... 188
Gearboxes............................................... 117
Collision Warning with Auto Brake &
Eco Start/Stop DRIVe*............................ 123 Pedestrian Protection*............................ 192
All-wheel drive – AWD*........................... 130 Driver Alert System – DAC*..................... 199
Foot brake............................................... 131 Driver Alert System - LDW*..................... 202
Parking brake.......................................... 133 Park assist syst*...................................... 205
HomeLinkŸ *............................................ 137 Park assist camera*................................ 208
BLIS* – Blind Spot Information System. . 211
Comfort inside the passenger compart-
ment........................................................ 215

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 3


Table of contents

06 07 08
06 During your journey 07 Wheels and tyres 08 Maintenance and service
Recommendations during driving........... 270 General ................................................... 294 Engine compartment............................... 312
Refuelling................................................ 273 Changing wheels ................................... 298 Lamps..................................................... 319
Fuel......................................................... 274 Tyre pressure ......................................... 301 Wiper blades and washer fluid................ 325
Loading................................................... 278 Warning triangle and first-aid kit*............ 302 Battery..................................................... 327
Cargo area.............................................. 280 Tyre pressure monitoring (TPMS)*.......... 303 Fuses...................................................... 333
Driving with a trailer................................ 283 Emergency puncture repair (TMK) ......... 305 Car care.................................................. 344
Towing and recovery.............................. 289

4 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


Table of contents

09 10
09 Specifications 10 Alphabetical Index
Type designations................................... 352 Alphabetical Index.................................. 386
Dimensions and weights......................... 354
Engine specifications.............................. 358
Engine oil................................................ 359
Fluids and lubricants............................... 361
Fuel......................................................... 363
Wheel and tyres, dimensions and pres-
sure ........................................................ 366
Electrical system..................................... 369
Type approval......................................... 370
Symbols in the display............................ 382

5
Introduction

Important information

Reading the Owner's Manual In the event of uncertainty over what is stand- lighted in the owner's manual by means of the
ard or an option/accessory, contact a Volvo text being slightly larger and printed in grey.
Introduction dealer. Examples of this are in menu texts and mes-
A good way of getting to know your new car is sage texts on the information display (e.g.
to read the owner's manual, ideally before your Special texts Audio settings).
first journey. This will give you the opportunity
to familiarise yourself with new functions, to WARNING Decals
see how best to handle the car in different sit- The car contains different types of decal which
Warning texts advise of a risk of personal
uations, and to make the best use of all the are designed to convey important information
injury.
car's features. Please pay attention to the in a simple and clear manner. The decals in the
safety instructions contained in the manual. car have the following descending degree of
The specifications, design features and illus- IMPORTANT importance for the warning/information.
trations in this owner's manual are not binding. Important texts advise of a risk of material Warning for personal injury
We reserve the right to make modifications damage.
without prior notice.
© Volvo Car Corporation NOTE
Option NOTE texts give advice or tips that facilitate
the use of features and functions for exam-
All types of option/accessory are marked with
ple.
an asterisk*.
In addition to standard equipment, this manual Footnote
also describes options (factory fitted equip-
There is footnote information in the owner's
ment) and certain accessories (retrofitted extra
manual that is located at the bottom of the
equipment).
page. This information is an addition to the text
The equipment described in the owner's man- that it refers to via a number. If the footnote
ual is not available in all cars - they have dif- refers to text in a table then letters are used G031590

ferent equipment depending on adaptations instead of numbers for referral.


for the needs of different markets and national Black ISO symbols on yellow warning field,
or local laws and regulations. Message texts white text/image on black message field. Used
There are displays in the car that show text to indicate the presence of danger which, if the
messages. These text messages are high-

6 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


Introduction

Important information

warning is ignored, may result in serious per- Information Procedure lists


sonal injury or fatality. Procedures where action must be taken in a
Risk of property damage certain sequence are numbered in the owner's
manual.
When there is a series of illustrations for
step-by-step instructions each step is
numbered in the same way as the corres-
ponding illustration.
There are numbered lists with letters adja-
cent to the series of illustrations where the
order of the instructions is not significant.
Arrows appear numbered and unnum-

G031593
bered and are used to illustrate a move-
ment.
G031592

If there is no series of illustrations for step-by-


White ISO symbols and white text/image on step instructions then the different steps are
black message field. numbered with normal numbers.
White ISO symbols and white text/image on
black or blue warning field and message field. NOTE Position lists
Used to indicate the presence of danger which, Red circles containing a number are used
The labels shown in the owner's manual are
if the warning is ignored, may result in damage not provided as exact reproductions of in overview images where different com-
to property. those in the car. The purpose is to show ponents are pointed out. The number
their approximate appearance and location recurs in the position list featured in con-
in the car. The information that applies to nection with the illustration that describes
your car in particular is available on the label the item.
in question in your car.
Bulleted lists
A bulleted list is used when there is a list of
points in the owner's manual.
Example:

7
Introduction

Important information

• Coolant way the driver drives the vehicle, such as vehi- applicable legal requirements. For further infor-
• Engine oil cle speed, brake and accelerator pedal use, mation - contact a Volvo dealer.
steering wheel movement and whether or not
To be continued the driver and passengers have used their
Accessories and extra equipment
`` This symbol is located furthest down to the seatbelts. For the reasons given this informa-
tion may be stored in the vehicle's computers The incorrect connection and installation of
right when a section continues on the following
for a certain length of time, but also as a result accessories can negatively affect the car's
page.
of a collision or incident. This information may electrical system. Certain accessories only
be stored by Volvo as long as it can help to function when their associated software is
Recording data installed in the car's computer system. Volvo
further develop and further enhance safety and
Your vehicle contains a number of computers quality and as long as there are legal require- therefore recommends that you always con-
whose function is to continuously check and ments and other regulations that Volvo needs tact an authorised Volvo workshop before
monitor the vehicle's operation and function- to consider. installing accessories which are connected to
ality. Some of the computers can record infor- or affect the electrical system.
mation during normal driving if they detect an Volvo will not contribute to the above-descri-
error. In addition, information is recorded in the bed information being disclosed to third parties
without the vehicle owner's consent. However, Change of ownership for cars with
event of a crash or incident. Parts of the recor-
due to national legislation and regulations Volvo On Call*
ded information are required so that techni-
cians can diagnose and rectify faults in the Volvo may be required to disclose such infor- Volvo On Call is a supplemental service that
vehicle during servicing and maintenance and mation to authorities such as police authorities, consists of safety, security and comfort serv-
so that Volvo can fulfil legal requirements and or others who may assert a legal right to have ices. If the car has Volvo On Call and there is a
other regulations. In addition to this, the infor- access to it. change of owner, it is very important that these
mation is used for research purposes by Volvo services are discontinued so that the former
To be able to read and interpret the information owner cannot access the services in the car.
in order to continually develop quality and recorded by the computers in the vehicle
safety, as the information can contribute to a Contact the call centre by pressing the ON
requires special technical equipment that CALL button in the car or contact an author-
better understanding of the factors that cause Volvo, and workshops that have entered into
accidents and injuries. The information ised Volvo workshop. See also "Changing the
agreements with Volvo, have access to. Volvo security code" in the owner's manual for Volvo
includes details of the status and functionality is responsible that the information, which is
of various systems and modules in the vehicle On Call.
transferred to Volvo during servicing and main-
with regard to engine, throttle, steering and tenance, is stored and handled in a secure
brake systems, amongst other things. This manner and that the handling complies with
information may include details regarding the

8 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


Introduction

Important information

Laser sensor exception of deviations in accordance with WARNING


This vehicle is equipped with a sensor which "Laser Notice No. 50" from 26 July 2001.
If any of these instructions are not followed
transmits laser light. It is absolutely essential to then there is a risk of eye injury!
Radiation data for the laser sensor
follow the prescribed instructions when han-
The following table specifies the laser sensor's • Never look into the laser sensor (which
dling the laser sensor.
physical data. emits spreading invisible laser radiation)
The following two labels in English are fitted at a distance of 100 mm or closer with
directly on the laser sensor unit: Maximum pulse energy 2.64 μJ magnifying optics such as a magnifying
glass, microscope, lens or similar opti-
Maximum average output 45 mW cal instruments.
Pulse duration 33 ns • Testing, repair, removal, adjustment
and/or replacement of the laser sen-
Divergence (horizontal x verti- 28° × 12° sor's spare parts must only be carried
cal) out by a qualified workshop - we rec-
ommend an authorised Volvo work-
shop.
• To avoid exposure to harmful radiation,
do not carry out any readjustments or
maintenance other than those specified
here.

The upper label in the figure describes the laser


• The repairer must follow specially
drawn up workshop information for the
beam's classification: laser sensor.
• Laser radiation - Do not look into the laser • Do not remove the laser sensor (this
beam with optical instruments - Class 1M includes removing the lenses). A
laser product. removed laser sensor does not fulfil
The lower label in the figure describes the laser laser class 3B as per standard IEC
beam's physical data: 60825-1. Laser class 3B is not eye-safe
and therefore entails a risk of injury.
• IEC 60825-1:1993 + A2:2001. Complies
with FDA (U.S. Food Administration) stand-
ards for laser product design with the

9
Introduction

Important information

• The laser sensor's connector must be


unplugged before removal from the
windscreen.
• The laser sensor must be fitted onto the
windscreen before the sensor's con-
nector is plugged in.
• The laser sensor transmits laser light
when the remote control key is in posi-
tion II and also with the engine switched
off (see page 80 on key positions).

For more information on the laser sensor, see


page 188.

Information on the Internet


At www.volvocars.com there is further infor-
mation concerning your car.

10
Introduction

Volvo and the environment

Volvo Cars' environmental philosophy

G000000
Environmental care is one of Volvo Car Corpo- Fuel consumption many cases the exhaust emissions are well
ration's core values which influence all opera- Volvo cars have competitive fuel consumption below the applicable standards.
tions. We also believe that our customers share in each of their respective classes. Lower fuel
our consideration for the environment. consumption generally results in lower emis- Clean air in the passenger compartment
sion of the greenhouse gas, carbon dioxide. A passenger compartment filter prevents dust
Your Volvo complies with strict international and pollen from entering the passenger com-
environmental standards and is also manufac- It is possible for the driver to influence fuel con- partment via the air intake.
tured in one of the cleanest and most resource- sumption. For more information read under the
efficient plants in the world. Volvo Car Corpo- heading, Reducing environmental impact. A sophisticated air quality system, IAQS* (Inte-
ration has global ISO certification, which rior Air Quality System) ensures that the incom-
includes the environmental standard ISO Efficient emission control ing air is cleaner than the air in the traffic out-
14001 covering all factories and several of our Your Volvo is manufactured following the con- side.
other units. We also set requirements for our cept "Clean inside and out" – a concept that The system consists of an electronic sensor
partners so that they work systematically with encompasses a clean interior environment as and a carbon filter. The incoming air is moni-
environmental issues. well as highly efficient emission control. In tored continuously and if there is an increase in

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 11


Introduction

Volvo and the environment

the level of certain unhealthy gases such as • Avoid letting the engine idle - switch off the Recycling
carbon monoxide then the air intake is closed. engine when stationary for longer periods. As a part of Volvo's environmental work, it is
Such a situation may arise in heavy traffic, Pay attention to local regulations. important that the car is recycled in an envi-
queues and tunnels for example. • Drive economically - think ahead. ronmentally sound manner. Almost all of the
The entry of nitrous oxides, ground-level ozone • Perform service and maintenance in car can be recycled. The last owner of the car
and hydrocarbons is prevented by the carbon accordance with the owner's manual's is therefore requested to contact a dealer for
filter. instructions - follow the Service and War- referral to a certified/approved recycling
ranty Booklet's recommended intervals. facility.
Interior
• If the car is equipped with an engine block
The interior of a Volvo is designed to be plea- heater*, use it before starting from cold - it The owner's manual and the
sant and comfortable, even for people with improves starting capacity and reduces environment
contact allergies and for asthma sufferers. wear in cold weather and the engine rea-
Extreme attention has been given to choosing The Forest Stewardship CouncilŸ symbol
ches normal operating temperature more shows that the paper pulp in this publication
environmentally-compatible materials. quickly, which lowers consumption and
comes from FSCŸ certified forests or other
reduces emissions.
Volvo workshops and the environment controlled sources.
Regular maintenance creates the conditions • High speed increases consumption con-
siderably due to increased wind resistance
for a long service life and low fuel consumption
- a doubling of speed increases wind resis-
for your car. In this way you contribute to a
tance 4 times.
cleaner environment. When Volvo's workshops
are entrusted with the service and mainte- • Always dispose of environmentally hazar-
nance of your car it becomes part of our sys- dous waste, such as batteries and oils, in
tem. Volvo makes clear demands regarding the an environmentally safe manner. Consult a
way in which our workshops are designed in workshop in the event of uncertainty about
how this type of waste should be discarded
order to prevent spills and discharges into the
- an authorised Volvo workshop is recom-
environment. Our workshop staff have the
mended.
knowledge and the tools required to guarantee
good environmental care. Following this advice can save money, the
planet's resources are saved, and the car's
Reducing environmental impact durability is extended. For more information
You can easily help reduce environmental and further advice, see the pages 270 and
impact - here are a few tips: 363.

12 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


Introduction

13
Seatbelts ................................................................................................ 16
Airbags.................................................................................................... 19
Activating/deactivating the airbag*......................................................... 22
Side airbags (SIPS bags) ....................................................................... 24
Inflatable Curtain (IC) ............................................................................. 26
WHIPS .................................................................................................... 27
When the systems deploy ...................................................................... 29
Safety mode............................................................................................ 30
Child safety............................................................................................. 31

14 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


SAFETY
01 Safety

01 Seatbelts

General information

Correctly fitted seatbelt. Height adjustment of seatbelt's upper fix-point.


Press in the button and move the upper fix-point
Heavy braking can have serious consequences vertically. Position the upper fix-point as high as
if the seatbelts are not used. Ensure that all possible without the belt chafing against your
throat.
passengers use their seatbelts.
The buckles only fit the intended lock in the rear
It is important that the seatbelt lies against the
seat1.
body so it can provide maximum protection.
Do not lean the backrest too far back. The Releasing the seatbelt
seatbelt is designed to protect in a normal Press the red button on the seatbelt buckle and
seating position. then let the belt retract. If the seatbelt does not
retract fully, feed it in by hand so that it does
Putting on a seatbelt
not hang loose.
Pull the belt out slowly and secure it by press-
ing its locking tab into the seatbelt buckle. A The seatbelt locks and cannot be with-
Incorrectly fitted seatbelt. The belt must rest on
loud "click" indicates that the belt has locked. the shoulder. drawn:

1 Certain markets.

16
01 Safety

Seatbelts 01

• if it is pulled out too quickly WARNING in the correct way. The diagonal section should
• during braking and acceleration wrap over the shoulder then be routed between
Never modify or repair the seatbelts your- the breasts and to the side of the abdomen.
• if the car leans heavily. self. Volvo recommends that you contact an
authorised Volvo workshop. The lap section should lay flat over the thighs
Make sure that you: and as low as possible under the abdomen. –
If a seatbelt has been subjected to a major
• do not use clips or anything else that can load, such as in conjunction with a collision, It must never be allowed to ride upward.
prevent the seatbelt from fitting properly the entire seatbelt must be replaced. Some Remove the slack from the seatbelt and ensure
• ensure that the seatbelt is not twisted or of the protective characteristics of the seat- that it fits as close to the body as possible. In
caught on anything belt may have been lost, even if it appears addition, check that there are no twists in the
to be undamaged. In addition, replace the seatbelt.
• the hip strap must be positioned low down seatbelt if the belt is worn or damaged. The
(not over the abdomen) new seatbelt must be type-approved and As the pregnancy progresses, pregnant drivers
• tension the hip strap over the lap by pulling intended for installation in the same position should adjust their seats and steering wheel
the diagonal shoulder belt up towards the as the replaced seatbelt. such that they can easily maintain control of the
shoulder. vehicle as they drive (which means that they
must be able to easily operate the foot pedals
WARNING Seatbelts and pregnancy and steering wheel). The aim should be to posi-
tion the seat with as large a distance as possi-
The seatbelts and airbags interact. If a seat-
ble between abdomen and steering wheel.
belt is not used or is used incorrectly, this
may diminish the protection provided by the
airbag in the event of a collision.

WARNING
Each seatbelt is designed for only one per-
son.

G020998
The seatbelt should always be worn during
pregnancy. But it is then crucial that it be worn

17
01 Safety

01 Seatbelts

Seatbelt reminder Rear seat Certain markets


The seatbelt reminder in the rear seat has two An acoustic signal and indicator lamp remind
subfunctions: the driver and front seat passenger to use a
seatbelt if either of them is not wearing one. At
• Provides information on which seatbelts low speed, the audio reminder will sound for
are being used in the rear seat. A message
appears in the information display when the first 6 seconds.
the seatbelts are in use, or if one of the rear
doors has been opened. The message is Seatbelt tensioner
cleared automatically after driving for All the seatbelts are equipped with belt ten-
approximately 30 seconds or after press-
sioners. A mechanism in the seatbelt tensioner
ing the indicator stalk's READ button.
tightens the seatbelt in the event of a suffi-
G017726 • Provides a warning if one of the rear seat- ciently violent collision. The seatbelt then pro-
belts is unfastened during travel. This vides more effective restraint for the occu-
warning takes the form of a message on pants.
Unbelted occupants will be reminded to fasten
the information display along with the
their seatbelts by means of an audio and visual
audio/visual signal. The warning stops
reminder. The audio reminder is speed when the seatbelt is re-fastened, or it can
WARNING
dependent, and in some cases time depend- also be acknowledged manually by press- Never insert the tongue of the passenger's
ent. The visual reminder is located in the roof ing the READ button. seatbelt into the buckle on the driver's side.
console and the combined instrument panel. Always insert the tongue of the seatbelt into
The message on the information display show-
Child seats are not covered by the seatbelt the buckle on the correct side. Do not make
ing which seatbelts are in use is always avail- any damages on seatbelts nor insert any
reminder system. able. Press the READ button to see stored foreign objects into a buckle. The seatbelts
messages. and buckles would then possibly not func-
tion as intended in the event of a collision.
There is a risk of serous injury.

18
01 Safety

Airbags 01

Warning symbol on the combined As well as the warning symbol, a message may
instrument panel appear on the information display in appropri-
ate cases. If the warning symbol malfunctions,
the warning triangle illuminates and SRS
Airbag Service required or SRS Airbag
Service urgent appears in the display. Volvo
recommends that you contact an authorised
Volvo workshop immediately.

Airbag system

G018666
Airbag system, right-hand drive car.
The system consists of airbags and sensors. A
sufficiently violent collision trips the sensors
The warning symbol in the combined instru-
and the airbag(s) are inflated with hot gas. To
ment panel illuminates when the remote con-
cushion the impact, the airbag deflates when
trol key is in key position II or III. The symbol
compressed. When this occurs, smoke
clears after approx. 6 seconds provided the
escapes into the car. This is completely nor-
airbag system is fault-free.
mal. The entire process, including inflation and

G018665
deflation of the airbag, occurs within tenths of
WARNING a second.
If the warning symbol for the airbag system Airbag system, left-hand drive car.
remains illuminated or illuminates while driv- WARNING
ing, it means that the airbag system does
not have full functionality. The symbol indi- Volvo recommends that you contact an
cates a fault in the seatbelt tensioner sys- authorised Volvo workshop for repair.
tem, SIPS, the IC system or some other fault Defective work in the airbag system could
in the system. Volvo recommends that you cause malfunction and result in serious per-
contact an authorised Volvo workshop sonal injury.
immediately.

19
01 Safety

01 Airbags

NOTE Passenger airbag


The car has an airbag to supplement the pro-
The sensors react differently depending on
the course of the collision and whether or tection afforded by the seatbelt on the passen-
not the seatbelts on the driver and passen- ger side. It is folded up into a compartment
ger side are used. above the glovebox. Its cover panel is marked
AIRBAG.
It is therefore possible that only one (or
none) of the airbags may inflate in a colli-
sion. The airbag system senses the force of WARNING
the collision on the car and adapts accord-
ingly so that one or more airbags are To minimise the risk of injury if the airbag
deployed. deploys, passengers must sit as upright as
possible with their feet on the floor and
The capacity of the airbags is also adapted backs against the backrest. Seatbelts must
to the collision force to which the vehicle is Location of the front passenger airbag in a right- be secured.
subjected. hand drive car.

Airbag on the driver's side WARNING


The car has an airbag to supplement the pro- Do not put objects in front of or above the
tection afforded by the seatbelt on the driver's dashboard where the passenger airbag is
side. It is folded up into the centre of the steer- located.
ing wheel. The steering wheel is marked
AIRBAG.

WARNING
The seatbelts and airbags interact. If a seat-
belt is not used or is used incorrectly, this
may diminish the protection provided by the
airbag in the event of a collision.
Location of the front passenger airbag in a left-
hand drive car.

20
01 Safety

Airbags 01

WARNING
Never place a child in a child seat or on a
booster cushion in the front seat if the airbag
is activated.
Never allow anybody to stand or sit in front
of the front passenger seat.
No one shorter than 140 cm should ever sit
in the front passenger seat if the airbag is
activated.
Failure to follow the advice given above can
endanger life.

21
01 Safety

01 Activating/deactivating the airbag*

Key switch off - PACOS* WARNING Activating/deactivating


General information If the car is equipped with a front passenger
The airbag for the front passenger seat can be airbag, but does not have a PACOS switch
deactivated if the car is equipped with a switch, (Passenger Airbag Cut Off Switch), then the
airbag will always be activated.
PACOS (Passenger Airbag Cut Off Switch). For
information on how to activate/deactivate, see
under the heading Activating/deactivating. WARNING
Key switch off/switch Never place a child in a child seat or on a
The switch for the passenger airbag (PACOS) booster cushion in the front seat if the airbag
is located on the passenger end of the instru- is activated and the symbol in the roof
ment panel and is accessible when the pas- console is illuminated. Failure to follow this
advice could endanger the life of the child.
senger door is open (see under the heading
Switch location.
below, Activating/deactivating).
WARNING The airbag is activated. With the switch in
Check that the switch is in the required posi- this position, persons taller than 140 cm
tion. Volvo recommends that the remote con- Do not allow anyone to sit in the front pas- can sit in the front passenger seat, but
trol key's key blade be used to change posi- senger seat if the message in the roof con- never children in a child seat or on a
tion. sole (see page 23) indicates that the air-
booster cushion.
bag is deactivated and if the warning sym-
For information on the key blade, see bol for the airbag system is also displayed The airbag is deactivated. With the switch
page 50. in the combined instrument panel. This indi- in this position, children in a child seat or
cates that there has been a severe malfunc- on a booster cushion can sit in the front
WARNING tion. Visit a workshop as soon as possible. passenger seat, but never persons taller
Volvo recommends that you contact an
Failure to follow the advice given above than 140 cm.
authorised Volvo workshop.
could endanger the life of passengers in the
car.

22 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


01 Safety

Activating/deactivating the airbag* 01

WARNING A text message and a symbol in the roof con- NOTE


sole indicate that the airbag for the front pas-
Activated airbag (passenger seat): senger seat is deactivated (see preceding illus- When the remote control key is in key posi-
tration). tion II or III the warning symbol for the airbag
Never place a child in a child seat or on a
is displayed on the combined instrument
booster cushion on the front passenger seat
panel for approx. 6 seconds (see page 19).
when the airbag is activated. This applies to
everyone shorter than 140 cm. Following which, the indicator in the roof
console is illuminated showing the correct
Deactivated airbag (passenger seat):
status for the front passenger seat airbag.
No one taller than 140 cm should ever sit in For more information about the different key
the front passenger seat when the airbag is positions for the remote control key, see
deactivated. page 80.
Failure to follow the advice given above can
endanger life.

G017800
Messages

Indicator showing that the passenger airbag is


activated.
2 A warning symbol in the roof console indicates
that the airbag for the front passenger seat is
activated (see preceding illustration).

2
G017724

Indicator showing that the passenger airbag is


deactivated.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 23


01 Safety

01 Side airbags (SIPS bags)

Side airbag WARNING Location


• Volvo recommends that repairs are only
carried out by an authorised Volvo
workshop. Defective work in the SIPS-
bag system could cause malfunction
and result in serious personal injury.
• Do not put objects in the area between
the outside of the seat and the door
panel, since this area is required by the
side airbag.

G032949
Volvo recommends the use only of car
seat covers approved by Volvo. Other
seat covers may impede the operation Driver's seat, left-hand drive.
In a side impact collision a large proportion of of the side airbags.
the collision force is transferred by the SIPS • The side airbag is a supplement to the
(Side Impact Protection System) to beams, pil- seatbelts. Always use a seatbelt.
lars, the floor, the roof and other structural
parts of the body. The side airbags at the driv-
er's and front passenger seats protect the Child seats and side airbags
chest area and the hip and are an important The protection provided by the car to children
part of the SIPS. seated in a child seat or on a booster cushion
is not diminished by the side airbag.
The SIPS bag system consists of two main
components, side airbag and sensors. The A child seat or booster cushion can be placed
side airbags are located in the front seat back- on the front passenger seat provided that the
rests. car does not have an activated1 passenger air-
bag.
Front passenger seat, left-hand drive.
The SIPS bag system consists of side airbags
and sensors. A sufficiently violent collision trips

1 For information on activating/deactivating the airbag, see page 22.

24
01 Safety

Side airbags (SIPS bags) 01

the sensors and the side airbags are inflated.


The airbag inflates between the occupant and
the door panel and thereby cushions the initial
impact. The airbag deflates when compressed
by the collision. The side airbag is normally only
deployed on the side of the collision.

25
01 Safety

01 Inflatable Curtain (IC)

Properties WARNING
Never hang or attach heavy items onto the
handles in the roof. The hook is only
designed for light clothing (not for solid
objects such as umbrellas for example).
Do not screw or install anything onto the
car's headlining, door pillars or side panels.
This could compromise the intended pro-
tection. Volvo recommends that you only
ever use Volvo genuine parts that are
approved for placement in these areas.

WARNING
The inflatable curtain IC (Inflatable Curtain) is a Do not load the car higher than 50 mm under
part of SIPS and the airbags. It is fitted in the the top edge of the door windows. Other-
headlining along both sides of the roof and wise, the intended protection of the inflat-
protects the car's occupants sitting in the outer able curtain, which is concealed in the head-
seats. A sufficiently violent collision trips the lining, may be compromised.
sensors and the inflatable curtain is inflated.
The inflatable curtain helps to prevent the
WARNING
driver and passengers from striking their heads
on the inside of the car during a collision. The inflatable curtain is a supplement to the
seatbelts.
Always use a seatbelt.

26
01 Safety

WHIPS 01

Protection against whiplash injury – The whiplash protection system (WHIPS) con- Correct seating position
WHIPS sists of energy absorbing backrests and spe- For the best possible protection, the driver and
cially designed head restraints in the front front seat passenger should sit in the centre of
seats. The system is actuated by a rear-end the seat with as little space as possible
collision, where the angle and speed of the col- between the head and the head restraint.
lision, and the nature of the colliding vehicle all
have an influence. Do not obstruct the WHIPS system

WARNING
The WHIPS system is a supplement to the
seatbelts. Always use a seatbelt.

Properties of the seat


When the WHIPS system is deployed, the front
seat backrests are lowered backward to alter
the seating position of the driver and front seat
passenger. This reduces the risk of whiplash
injury.
Do not leave any objects on the floor behind the
WARNING driver's seat/passenger seat that may prevent the
WHIPS system from functioning.
Never modify or repair the seat or WHIPS
system yourself. Volvo recommends that WARNING
you contact an authorised Volvo workshop.
Do not squeeze rigid objects between the
rear seat cushion and the front seat back-
WHIPS system and child seats/booster rest. Make sure you do not to obstruct the
cushions function of the WHIPS system.
The protection provided by the car to children
seated in a child seat or on a booster cushion
is not diminished by the WHIPS system.

27
01 Safety

01 WHIPS

WARNING
If a seat has been subjected to extreme
forces, such as due to a rear-end collision,
the WHIPS system must be checked. Volvo
recommends that it is checked by an
authorised Volvo workshop.
Part of the WHIPS system's protective
capacity may have been lost even if the
seats appear to be undamaged.
Volvo recommends that you contact an
authorised Volvo workshop to have the sys-
tem checked even after a minor rear-end
Do not place objects on the rear seat that may collision.
prevent the WHIPS system from functioning.

WARNING
If a rear seat backrest is folded down, the
corresponding front seat must be moved
forward so that it does not touch the folded
backrest.

28
01 Safety

When the systems deploy 01

When the systems deploy If the airbags have deployed, the following is WARNING
recommended:
System Triggered Never drive with deployed airbags. They
• Recovering the car. Volvo recommends can make steering difficult. Other safety
Seatbelt tensioner, In the event of a that you have it conveyed to an authorised systems may also be damaged. The smoke
front seat frontal collision, Volvo workshop. Do not drive with and dust created when the airbags are
and/or side-impact deployed airbags. deployed can cause skin and eye irritation/
collision, and/or injury after intensive exposure. In case of
• Volvo recommends that you engage an irritation, wash with cold water. The rapid
rear-end collision authorised Volvo workshop to handle the deployment sequence and airbag fabric
and overturning replacement of components in the car's may cause friction and skin burns.
safety systems.
Seatbelt tensioner, In the event of a
rear seat frontal collision and • Always contact a doctor.
overturning
NOTE
Airbags (SRS) In a frontal collisionA
The SRS, SIPS, IC and belt tensioner sys-
Side airbags (SIPS) In a side-impact tems are deployed only once during a colli-
sion.
accident

Inflatable Curtain IC In the event of a


WARNING
side-impact acci-
dent, overturning The airbag control module is located in the
and a frontal colli- centre console. If the centre console is
sion if the car is not drenched with water or other liquid, discon-
nect the battery cables. Do not attempt to
hit directly head-on
start the car since the airbags may deploy.
Whiplash protection In a rear-end colli- Recovering the car. Volvo recommends that
you have it conveyed to an authorised Volvo
WHIPS sion
workshop.
A The bodywork of the car could be greatly deformed in a col-
lision without airbag deployment. A number of factors such
as the rigidity and weight of the object hit, the speed of the
car, the angle of the collision etc. affects how the different
safety systems of the car are activated.

29
01 Safety

01 Safety mode

Driving after a collision effect that the ignition is on, press the start WARNING
button. Then close the door and reinsert the
remote control key. The car's electronics will Never, under any circumstances, attempt to
now try to reset themselves to normal mode. restart the car if it smells of fuel when the
Safety mode See manual message is dis-
Then try to start the car. played. Leave the car at once.
If the message Safety mode See manual is
still shown on the display then the car must not
be driven or towed, but a vehicle recovery serv-
WARNING
ice used instead. Even if the car appears to be If the car is in safety mode it must not be
driveable, hidden damage may make the car towed. It must be transported from its loca-
impossible to control once moving. tion. Volvo recommends that it is transpor-
ted to an authorised Volvo workshop.
Moving the car
If Normal mode is shown after Safety mode
If the car is involved in a collision, the text See manual has been reset, the car can be
Safety mode See manual may appear on the moved carefully out of a dangerous position.
information display. This means that the car Do not move the car further than necessary.
has reduced functionality. Safety mode is a
protective state that is enforced when the col-
lision may have damaged any of the car's vital
WARNING
functions, such as the fuel lines, sensors for Never attempt to repair your car or reset the
one of the safety systems, or the brake system. electronics yourself if the car has been in
safety mode. This could result in personal
Attempting to start the car injury or the car not functioning as normal.
First, check that no fuel is leaking from the car. Volvo recommends that you engage an
There must be no smell of fuel either. authorised Volvo workshop to check and
restore the car to normal status after Safety
If everything seems normal and you have mode See manual has been displayed.
checked for indications of fuel leakage, you
may attempt to start the car.
Remove the remote control key and open the
driver's door. If a message is now shown to the

30
01 Safety

Child safety 01

Children should sit comfortably and NOTE beams under the seat. Sharp edges can dam-
safely age the straps.
In the event of questions when fitting child
Volvo recommends that children travel in rear- safety products, contact the manufacturer Look in the installation instructions for the child
facing child seats until as late an age as pos- for clearer instructions. seat for the correct fitting.
sible, at least until 3-4 years of age, and then
front-facing booster cushions/child seats until
Location of child seats
up to 10 years of age. Child seats
You may place:
The position of a child in the car and the choice
of equipment are dictated by the child's weight • a child seat/booster cushion on the pas-
and size, for more information, see page 33. senger seat, provided the passenger air-
bag is not activated1.
NOTE • one or more child seats/booster cushions
in the rear seat.
Regulations regarding the placement of
children in cars vary from country to coun- Always fit child seats/booster cushions in the
try. Check what does apply. rear seat if the passenger airbag is activated. If
a child is sitting on the front passenger seat
then he/she could suffer serious injury if the

G020739
Children of all ages and sizes must always sit
airbag deploys.
correctly secured in the car. Never allow a child
to sit on the knee of a passenger. Child seats and airbags are not compatible.
Volvo has child safety equipment (child seats,
booster cushions & attachment devices) which NOTE
is designed for your particular car. Using Vol- When using child safety products it is
vo's child safety equipment provides you with important to read the installation instruc-
optimum conditions for your child to travel tions included.
safely in the car. Furthermore, the child safety
equipment fits and is easy to use. Do not attach the straps for the child seat to
the horizontal adjustment bar, springs, rails or

1 For information on activated/deactivated airbag, see page 22.

31
01 Safety

01 Child safety

WARNING WARNING Label Airbag


Never place a child in a child seat or on a Booster cushions/child seats with steel
booster cushion in the front seat if the airbag braces or some other design that could rest
(SRS) is activated. on the seatbelt buckle's opening button
must not be used, as they could cause the
No one shorter than 140 cm should ever sit
seatbelt buckle to open accidentally.
in the front passenger seat if the airbag
(SRS) is activated. Do not allow the upper section of the child Label fitted on the end face of the instrument panel
seat to rest against the windscreen. on the passenger side, see the illustration on page
Failure to follow the advice given above can
endanger life. 22.

32
01 Safety

Child safety 01

Recommended child seats2


Weight Front seat (with deactivated air- Outer rear seat Centre rear seat
bag)
Group 0 Volvo infant seat (Volvo Infant Seat) -
rear-facing child seat, secured with the
max 10 kg
ISOFIX fixture system.
Group 0+ Type approval: E5 04301146
max 13 kg (L)

Volvo infant seat (Volvo Infant Seat) - Volvo infant seat (Volvo Infant Seat) - Volvo infant seat (Volvo Infant Seat) -
rear-facing child seat, secured with the rear-facing child seat, secured with the rear-facing child seat, secured with the
car's seatbelt. car's seatbelt. car's seatbelt.
Type approval: E1 04301146 Type approval: E1 04301146 Type approval: E1 04301146
(U) (U) (U)

Child seats which are universally Child seats which are universally Child seats which are universally
approved. approved. approved.
(U) (U) (U)

2 With regard to other child seats your car should be included in the manufacturer's enclosed list of vehicles or be universally approved in accordance with the ECE R44 legal requirement.
``

33
01 Safety

01 Child safety

Weight Front seat (with deactivated air- Outer rear seat Centre rear seat
bag)
Group 1 Volvo rear-facing/turnable child seat Volvo rear-facing/turnable child seat
(Volvo Convertible Child Seat) - rear- (Volvo Convertible Child Seat) - rear-
9-18 kg
facing child seat, secured with the facing child seat, secured with the
car's seatbelt and straps. car's seatbelt and straps.
Type approval: E5 04192 Type approval: E5 04192
(L) (L)

Child seats which are universally Child seats which are universally Child seats which are universally
approved. approved. approved.
(U) (U) (U)

Group 2 Volvo rear-facing/turnable child seat Volvo rear-facing/turnable child seat


(Volvo Convertible Child Seat) - rear- (Volvo Convertible Child Seat) - rear-
15-25 kg
facing child seat, secured with the facing child seat, secured with the
car's seatbelt and straps car's seatbelt and straps
Type approval: E5 04192 Type approval: E5 04192
(L) (L)

Volvo rear-facing/turnable child seat Volvo rear-facing/turnable child seat Volvo rear-facing/turnable child seat
(Volvo Convertible Child Seat) - front- (Volvo Convertible Child Seat) - front- (Volvo Convertible Child Seat) - front-
facing child seat, secured with the facing child seat, secured with the facing child seat, secured with the
car's seatbelt. car's seatbelt. car's seatbelt.
Type approval: E5 04191 Type approval: E5 04191 Type approval: E5 04191
(L) (L) (L)

34
01 Safety

Child safety 01

Weight Front seat (with deactivated air- Outer rear seat Centre rear seat
bag)
Group 2/3 Volvo booster seat with backrest Volvo booster seat with backrest Volvo booster seat with backrest
(Volvo Booster Seat with backrest). (Volvo Booster Seat with backrest). (Volvo Booster Seat with backrest).
15-36 kg
Type approval: E1 04301169 Type approval: E1 04301169 Type approval: E1 04301169
(UF) (UF) (UF)

Booster cushion with and without Booster cushion with and without Booster cushion with and without
backrest (Booster Cushion with and backrest (Booster Cushion with and backrest (Booster Cushion with and
without backrest). without backrest). without backrest).
Type approval: E5 03139 Type approval: E5 03139 Type approval: E5 03139
(UF) (UF) (UF)

Integrated booster cushion (Integrated


Booster Cushion) - available as a fac-
tory fitted option.
Type approval: E5 04189
(B)

L: Suitable for specific child seats. These child seats may be intended for use in a special car model, limited or semi-universal categories.
U: Suitable for universally approved child seats in this weight class.
UF: Suitable for front-facing universally approved child seats in this weight class.
B: Built-in child seats approved for this weight class.

``

35
01 Safety

01 Child safety

Integrated two-stage booster The booster cushions are specially designed to Raising the two-stage booster cushion
cushions* provide optimum safety. In combination with
Stage 1
the seatbelt they are approved for children who
weigh between 15 and 36 kg and who are at
least 95 cm in height.
Check before driving that:
• the 2-stage integrated booster cushion is
correctly set (see table below) and in
locked position
• the seatbelt is in contact with the child's
body and is not slack or twisted
• the seatbelt does not lie across the child's
throat or below the shoulder (see preced-
Correct position, the seatbelt should be posi- ing illustrations)
tioned in on the shoulder. • the lap section of the seatbelt is positioned Pull the handle forward and up in order to
low over the pelvis to provide optimal pro- release the booster cushion.
tection.

Stage 1 Stage 2
Weight 22-36 kg 15-25 kg

Incorrect position, the head restraint must be


adjusted as high as the head and the seatbelt must
not be below the shoulder.

36 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


01 Safety

Child safety 01

Press the booster cushion backwards to Lift the booster cushion up at the front edge the booster cushion from the upper stage to
lock. and press it back against the backrest to lock. the lower stage.
Stage 2
WARNING
Volvo recommends that repair or replace-
ment is only carried out by an authorised
Volvo workshop. Do not make any modifi-
cations or additions to the booster cushion.
If an integrated booster cushion has been
subjected to a major load, such as in con-
junction with a collision, the entire booster
cushion must be replaced. Even if the
booster cushion appears to be undamaged,
it may not afford the same level of protec-
tion. The booster cushion must also be
replaced if it is heavily worn.
Pull the handle forwards to release the
Start from the lower stage. Press the but- cushion.
ton. NOTE
It is not possible to adjust the booster cush-
ion from stage 2 to stage 1. It must first be
reset by being fully folded into the seat
cushion. Refer to the heading below, Low-
ering the two-stage booster cushion.

Lowering the two-stage booster cushion


Lowering can take place from both the upper
and lower stage to fully lowered position in the
cushion. However, it is not possible to adjust

37
01 Safety

01 Child safety

Press down with your hand in the centre of ISOFIX fixture system for child seats Consequently, there is a size classification for
the cushion in order to lock it. child seats using the ISOFIX fixture system in
order to assist users in choosing the correct
WARNING child seat (see the following table).

If the instructions regarding the two-stage


booster cushion are not followed then this Size Description
could cause serious injury to a child in the class
event of an accident.
A Full size, front-facing child
seat
IMPORTANT
B Reduced size (alt. 1), front-
Check that there are no loose objects (e.g. facing child seat
toys) left behind in the space under the
cushion before lowering. B1 Reduced size (alt.2), front-
Mounting points for the ISOFIX fixture system
facing child seat
are concealed behind the lower section of the
NOTE rear seat backrest, in the outer seats. C Full size, rear-facing child
The booster cushion must be lowered first The location of the mounting points is indicated seat
when lowering the backrest. by symbols in the backrest upholstery (see pre-
D Reduced size, rear-facing
ceding illustration).
child seat
Child safety locks, rear doors Press the seat cushion down to access the
mounting points. E Rear-facing infant seat
The controls for operating the rear door power
windows and the rear door opening handles Always follow the manufacturer's installation F Transverse infant seat, left-
can be blocked from opening from the inside. instructions when connecting a child seat to hand
For more information, see page 64. the ISOFIX mounting points.
G Transverse infant seat, right-
Size classes hand
Child seats are in different sizes – cars are in
different sizes. This means that not all child
seats are suitable for all seats in all car models.

38
01 Safety

Child safety 01

WARNING NOTE
Never place a child in the passenger seat if Volvo recommends that you contact an
the car is equipped with an activated airbag. authorised Volvo dealer for recommenda-
tions about which ISOFIX child seats Volvo
recommends.
NOTE
If an ISOFIX child seat has no size classifi-
cation then the car model must be included
on the child seat's vehicle list.

Types of ISOFIX child seat


Type of child seat Weight Size class Passenger seats for ISOFIX installation of child seats
Front seat Outer rear seat
Infant seat transverse max 10 kg F X X

G X X

Infant seat, rear-facing max 10 kg E X OK


(IL)

39
01 Safety

01 Child safety

Type of child seat Weight Size class Passenger seats for ISOFIX installation of child seats
Front seat Outer rear seat
Infant seat, rear-facing max 13 kg E X OK
(IL)

D X OK
(IL)

C X OK
(IL)

Child seat, rear-facing 9-18 kg D X OK


(IL)

C X OK
(IL)

40
01 Safety

Child safety 01

Type of child seat Weight Size class Passenger seats for ISOFIX installation of child seats
Front seat Outer rear seat
Front-facing child seat 9-18 kg B X OKA
(IUF)

B1 X OKA
(IUF)

A X OKA
(IUF)

X: The ISOFIX position is not suitable for ISOFIX child seats in this weight class and/or size class.
IL: Suitable for specific ISOFIX child seats. These child seats may be intended for use in a special car model, limited or semi-universal categories.
IUF: Suitable for front-facing ISOFIX child seats that are universally approved in this weight class.
A Volvo recommends rear-facing child seats for this group.

``

41
01 Safety

01 Child safety

Upper mounting points for child seats NOTE


For cars equipped with a cargo area cover
over the cargo area, this must be removed
before a child seat can be fitted in the
mounting points.

For detailed information on how the child seat


should be tensioned in the upper mounting
points, see the seat manufacturer's instruc-
tions.

WARNING
The child seat's straps must always be
The car is equipped with upper mounting drawn through the hole in the head restraint
points for certain front-facing child seats. leg before they are tensioned at the attach-
These mounting points are located on the rear ment point.
of the seat.
The upper mounting points are primarily
intended for use with front-facing child seats.
Volvo recommends that small children should
sit in rear-facing child seats to as late an age
as possible.

NOTE
For cars with folding head restraints on the
outside seats the head restraints should be
folded to facilitate the installation of this
type of child seat.

42
01 Safety

01

43
Remote control key/key blade................................................................ 46
Privacy locking*....................................................................................... 51
Battery replacement, remote control key/PCC*...................................... 53
Keyless drive*.......................................................................................... 55
Locking/unlocking................................................................................... 59
Child safety locks.................................................................................... 64
Alarm*...................................................................................................... 65

44 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


LOCKS AND ALARM
02 Locks and alarm

Remote control key/key blade

General control key must be erased from the system as • Locking - one flash and the door mirrors
The car is supplied with 2 remote control keys a theft prevention measure. are folded2 in.
02
or PCCs (Personal Car Communicator). They The current number of keys registered to the • Unlocking - two flashes and the door mir-
are used to start the car and for locking and car can be checked in the menu system MY rors are folded2 out.
unlocking. CAR under Information Number of keys. After locking the indication is only given if all
More remote control keys can be ordered – up For a description of the menu system, see locks have been activated once the doors have
to 6 can be programmed and used for the same page 144. been closed.
car. Selecting the function
Key memory1 – door mirrors and driver's
The PCC has increased functionality com- Different options for indicating locking/unlock-
seat
pared with the remote control key. The contin- ing with light can be set in the car's menu sys-
The settings are automatically connected to
uation of this chapter describes the functions tem, see page 144.
each respective remote control key, see pages
available in both the PCC and the remote con-
83 and 102. Search in the menu system MY CAR for
trol key.
The function can be activated/deactivated in Settings Car settings Light settings
the menu system MY CAR under Settings and select Lock confirmation light and/or
WARNING
Unlock confirmation light.
If there are children in the car: Car settings Car key memory.

Always remember to switch off the power For a description of the menu system, see
supply to power windows and sunroof by page 144.
removing the remote control key if the driver
leaves the car. For cars with Keyless drive system, see
page 55.

Loss of a remote control key Indicator for locking/unlocking


If you lose a remote control key then new ones When the car is locked or unlocked using the
can be ordered at a workshop - an authorised remote control key, the direction indicators
Volvo workshop is recommended. The remain- confirm that locking/unlocking was correctly
ing remote control keys must then be taken to performed.
the workshop. The code of the missing remote

1 Only in combination with power driver's seat and power mirrors.


2 Only for cars with retractable power door mirrors.

46
02 Locks and alarm

Remote control key/key blade

Lock indicator Message Specification Functions

Insert car key Error when reading 02


the remote control
key during starting -
Remove the key
from the ignition
switch, press it in
again and make a
new start attempt.

Car key not found Error reading the

G021078
PCC during starting
(Only applies to Key-
Same LED as alarm indicator, see page 65.
- Try to start again.
less drive with PCC.) Remote control key, standard version.
A flashing LED in the windscreen verifies that If the error persists: Locking
the car is locked. Insert the remote
key into the ignition Unlocking
switch and try to
NOTE Approach light duration
start again.
Cars that are not equipped with alarm also Tailgate
have this indicator. Immobiliser Try Error in immobiliser
start again system during star- Panic function
ting. If the error per-
Immobiliser
sists: Contact a
Each remote control key has a unique code.
workshop - an
The car can only be driven with the correct
authorised Volvo
remote control key with the correct code.
workshop is recom-
The following error messages in the combined mended.
instrument panel's information display are rela-
ted to the electronic immobiliser: For starting the car, see page 112.

47
02 Locks and alarm

Remote control key/key blade

Press and hold (at least 4 seconds) to open all Range


windows simultaneously. The remote key's functions have a range of
02 about 20 m from the car.
The function can be changed from unlocking
all doors simultaneously, to unlocking the driv- If the car does not verify a button being pressed
er's door only with one press of the button and, - move closer and try again.
after a further press of the button - within 10
seconds - unlocking the remaining doors. NOTE
The function can be changed in the menu sys- The remote control key functions can be
tem MY CAR under Settings Car settings disrupted by surrounding radio waves,

G021079
Lock settings Doors unlock with both buildings, topographical conditions etc. The
car can always be locked/unlocked using
the alternatives All doors and Driver door, the key blade, see page 50.
Remote control key with PCC* - Personal Car then all. For a description of the menu system,
Communicator.
see page 144.
Information
Approach light duration – Used to switch
Function buttons on the car's lighting at a distance. For more
Locking – Locks the doors and tailgate information, see page 93.
while the alarm is activated. Tailgate - Unlocks and disarms the alarm
Press and hold (at least 2 seconds) to close all for the tailgate only. For more information, see
the windows and sunroof* simultaneously. page 62.
Panic function – Used to attract attention
WARNING in an emergency.
If the sunroof and windows are closed using Press and hold the button for at least 3 sec-
the remote control key, check that no one is onds or press it twice within 3 seconds to acti-
in danger of getting hands caught.
vate the direction indicators and the horn.
The function can be turned off with the same
Unlocking – Unlocks the doors and tail-
button once it has been active for at least
gate while the alarm is deactivated. 5 seconds. Otherwise the function switches off
automatically after 2 minutes and 45 seconds.

48 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


02 Locks and alarm

Remote control key/key blade

Unique PCC functions* If any of the other buttons are pressed Red continuous light – the alarm has been
during this time then the reading is inter- triggered since the car was locked.
rupted. 02
Red light flashing alternately in both indi-
cator lamps – The alarm was triggered less
NOTE than 5 minutes ago.
If none of the indicator lamps illumi- Range PCC
nates with repeated use of the information The PCC's range for locking, unlocking and
button and in different locations (as well as
after 7 seconds and after the light has trav- tailgate is about 20 m from the car - for other
elled around on the PCC), contact a work- functions up to about 100 m.
shop - an authorised Volvo workshop is rec- If the car does not verify a button being pressed
G021080
ommended. - move closer and try again.

Remote control key with PCC* - Personal Car Indicator lamps display information in accord- NOTE
Communicator. ance with the following illustration:
Information button The information button functions can be
disrupted by surrounding radio waves,
Indicator lamps buildings, topographical conditions etc.

Using the information button enables access to


certain information from the car via the indica- Out of PCC range
tor lamps. If the PCC is too far away from the car for the
information to be read then the status the car
Using the information button was last left in is shown, without the light trav-
– Press the information button . elling around on the PCC.
> All indicator lamps flash for approxi- If several PCCs are used for the car then it is
mately 7 seconds and the light travels only the PCC last used for locking/unlocking
around on the PCC. This indicates that that shows correct status.
information from the car has been read.
Green continuous light – the car is locked.
Yellow continuous light – the car is
unlocked.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 49


02 Locks and alarm

Remote control key/key blade

NOTE • the right-hand front door and the rear 1. Hold the remote control key with the slot
doors can be locked manually, e.g. in the pointed up and lower the key blade into its
02 If no indicator lamps illuminate when event of power failure, see page 59. slot.
the information button is used within range
then this may be because the last commu-
• access to the glovebox and cargo area 2. Lightly press the key blade. You should
(privacy locking*) can be blocked, see hear a "click" when the key blade is locked
nication between the PCC and the car was
disrupted by surrounding radio waves, page 51. in.
buildings, topographical conditions etc. • the airbag for front passenger seat
(PACOS)* can be activated/deactivated,
see page 22. Unlocking doors with the key blade
Detachable key blade If central locking cannot be activated with the
Removing the key blade remote control key - e.g. if the batteries are
A remote control key contains a detachable discharged - then the left-hand front door can
key blade of metal with which some functions be opened as follows:
can be activated and some operations carried
out. 1. Unlock the left-hand front door with the key
blade in the door handle's lock cylinder.
The key blade's unique code is provided by
authorised Volvo workshops, which are rec- See also the figure and further information
ommended when ordering new key blades. on page see page 56.

Key blade functions NOTE


Using the remote control key's detachable key
When the door has been unlocked using the

G021082
blade: key blade and is opened, the alarm is trig-
• the left-hand front door can be opened gered.
manually if central locking cannot be acti- Slide the spring-loaded catch to the side.
vated with the remote control key, see 2. Deactivate the alarm by inserting the
page 56. At the same time pull the key blade straight
out backwards. remote control key in the ignition switch.
• the rear doors' mechanical child safety For a car with the Keyless system, see
locks can be activated/deactivated, see Attaching the key blade page 56.
page 64. Carefully refit the key blade into its location in
the remote control key.

50 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


02 Locks and alarm

Privacy locking*

General information on privacy locking locked and the tailgate lock is disconnected Activate/deactivate
from the central locking - the tailgate cannot be
opened with either the central locking button in 02
the front doors or the remote control key.
This means that the remote control key without
key blade can only be used to activate/deacti-
vate the alarm, to open the doors and to drive
the car.
The remote control key without key blade can
then be handed over to the service or hotel staff
- the loose key blade is retained by the car
G017869
owner.
Active locks for remote control key with key blade. Activating privacy locking.
NOTE
To activate privacy locking:
Do not forget to pull out the cargo cover
over the cargo area before closing the tail- Insert the key blade in the glovebox lock
gate, see page 281. cylinder.
Turn the key blade 180 degrees clockwise.
The keyhole is vertical in the locked posi-
tion for privacy locking.
Pull out the key blade. The information dis-
play shows a message at the same time.
The glovebox is then locked and the tailgate
G017870

can no longer be unlocked with the remote


control key or the central locking button.
Active locks for remote control key, without key
blade and privacy locking activated.
The privacy locking function is intended for
when the car is left for service, with a hotel
parking valet or similar. The glovebox is then

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 51


02 Locks and alarm

Privacy locking*

NOTE
02 Do not reinsert the key blade into the remote
control key but keep it in a safe place
instead.

• Deactivation takes place in reverse order.


For information on locking the glovebox only,
see page 61.

52 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


02 Locks and alarm

Battery replacement, remote control key/PCC*

Replacing the battery Battery replacement


The batteries should be replaced if: Closely study how the battery/batteries are
secured on the inside of the cover, with 02
• the information symbol is illuminated and regard to their (+) and (–) sides.
the display shows Low battery in remote
control. Please change batteries. Remove control key (1 battery)
and/or 1. Carefully prize out the battery.
2. Install a new one with the (+) side down.
• the locks repeatedly do not react to signals
from the remote control key within PCC* (2 batteries)
20 metres from the car. 1. Carefully prize out the batteries.
Opening
2. First install one new one with the (+) side
Slide the spring-loaded catch to the up.
side.
3. Position the white plastic tab in between
At the same time pull the key blade and finally install a second new battery with
straight out backwards. the (+) side down.

Insert a 3 mm slot screwdriver in the Battery type


hole behind the spring-loaded catch and Use batteries with the designation CR2430, 3V
gently prize the remote control key up. - one in the remote control key and two in the
PCC.
NOTE
Assembly
Turn the remote control key over with the 1. Press the remote control key together.
buttons facing up, this is to avoid the bat-
teries falling out when it is opened. 2. Hold the remote control key with the slot
pointed up and lower the key blade into its
slot.
IMPORTANT
3. Lightly press the key blade. You should
Avoid touching the battery and its terminals hear a "click" when the key blade is locked
with your fingers, as this could damage their in.
functionality.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 53


02 Locks and alarm

Battery replacement, remote control key/PCC*

IMPORTANT
02 Make sure that you dispose of old batteries
in an environmentally-friendly way.

54 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


02 Locks and alarm

Keyless drive*

Keyless lock and ignition system (only the car door handle or tailgate. This means that reactivated. It is therefore important to handle
PCC1) the person who wishes to lock or unlock a door all PCCs with great care.
must have the PCC with him or her. It is not 02
General possible to lock or unlock a door if the PCC is IMPORTANT
on the opposite side of the car.
Never leave a PCC behind in the car.
The red rings in the preceding illustration indi-
cate the range covered by the system's anten-
Interference to PCC function
nas.
Electromagnetic fields and screening can inter-
If all PCCs are removed from the car when the fere with the keyless drive system.
engine is running or key position I or II is active
(see page 80) and if all doors are closed, then NOTE
a warning message is shown in the information
display and an audible reminder signal sounds Do not place/store the PCC near a mobile
at the same time. phone or metal object - no closer than 10-15
cm.
The warning message clears and the audio
The keyless drive function in the PCC allows reminder signal stops when the PCC is brought If interference is experienced nonetheless, use
the car to be unlocked, driven and locked with- back to the car after: the PCC and the key blade as a remote control
out the need for a key. You simply have to have • a door has been opened and closed key, see page 47.
the PCC with you. The system makes it easier
and more convenient to open the car, e.g.
• the PCC is inserted into the ignition switch
when your hands are full. • the READ button has been pressed.
Both of the car's PCCs incorporate the Keyless Handling the PCC safely
function. Additional PCCs can be ordered, see If a PCC with keyless drive function is left in the
page 46. car, it is deactivated temporarily when the car
is locked. This prevents unauthorised entry.
PCC range
However, if someone breaks into the car,
In order to open a door or the tailgate, a PCC
opens the door and finds the PCC, it can be
must be no more than approx. 1.5 metres from

1 Personal Car Communicator, see page 49.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 55


02 Locks and alarm

Keyless drive*

Locking NOTE Unlocking with the key blade


02 On cars with automatic transmission, the
gear selector must be set in the P position
– otherwise the car cannot be locked or the
alarm armed.

Unlocking
Unlocking takes place when a hand grasps a
door handle or the tailgate's rubberised pres-
sure plate is actuated - open the door or tail-
gate as normal.

NOTE
Cars with the Keyless system have a pressure- Hole for key blade - to loosen the cover.
sensitive area on the outer handle of the doors and The door handles normally register a hand
a rubberised button next to the tailgate's rubber- that takes hold of the handle, but with thick If central locking cannot be activated with the
ised pressure plate. gloves on or after a very quick hand move- PCC, e.g. if the batteries are discharged, then
ment a second attempt may be required, or the left-hand front door can be opened with the
Lock the doors and the tailgate with one long
with the glove taken off. PCC's detachable key blade (see page 50).
press on any of the door handles' pressure-
sensitive areas or press the smaller of the tail- To access the lock cylinder, the door handle's
gate's two rubberised buttons - the lock indi- plastic cover must be removed - this is also
cator in the windscreen confirms that locking done with the key blade:
has been completed by starting to flash, see 1. Press the key blade approx. 1 cm straight
page 47. up into the hole on the underside of the
All doors and the tailgate must be closed door handle/cover - do not prize.
before the car can be locked - otherwise the > The plastic cover loosens automatically
car is not locked. by means of the torque when the blade

56 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


02 Locks and alarm

Keyless drive*

is pushed straight up and into the open- presses their PCC's unlock button, see Antenna location
ing. page 47.
02
2. Then insert the key blade in the lock cylin- • Select one of three possible memories for
der and unlock the door. seat adjustment with seat button 1-3, see
page 83.
3. Refit the plastic cover after unlocking.
• Adjust seat and mirrors manually, see
page 83 and 102.
NOTE
When the driver's door is unlocked using the Lock settings
key blade and is opened, the alarm is trig- The Keyless function can be adapted by indi-
gered. It is switched off by inserting the PCC cating in the menu system MY CAR which
in the ignition switch, see page 66. doors shall be unlocked, under Car settings
Lock settings Keyless entry - there
Key memory2 – driver's seat and door select between All doors unlock, Any door,
The keyless system has a number of integrated
mirrors Doors on same side and Both front doors.
antennae located around the car:
PCC memory function For a description of the menu system, see
Rear bumper, centre
If several people each with a PCC approach the page 144.
car, then the settings for seat and mirrors are Door handle, left rear
implemented for the person who opens the
Roof, centre above rear seat
driver's door.
After the driver's door has been opened by Cargo area, central and furthest in under
person A with PCC-A, but person B with PCC- the floor
B shall drive, the settings can be changed in Door handle, right rear
three ways:
Centre console, under the rear section
• Standing by the driver's door, or sitting
behind the steering wheel, person B Centre console, under the front section.

2 Only in combination with power driver's seat and power mirrors.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 57


02 Locks and alarm

Keyless drive*

WARNING
02 People with pacemaker operations should
not come closer than 22 cm to the keyless
system's antennae with their pacemaker.
This is to prevent interference between the
pacemaker and the keyless system.

58 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


02 Locks and alarm

Locking/unlocking

From the outside NOTE Other doors do not have lock cylinders and
The remote control key can lock/unlock all instead have lock knobs on each door's end
Remember that the alarm is triggered when face which must be re-turned - then they are 02
doors and the tailgate simultaneously. Different the door is opened after being unlocked
sequences for unlocking can be selected, see mechanically locked/blocked against opening
with the key blade - the alarm is switched
"Unlocking with the remote control key" page off when the remote control key is inserted from the outside. The doors can still be opened
48. into the ignition switch. from the inside.

In order that the lock sequence can be acti-


vated, the driver's door must be closed - if any WARNING
of the other doors or the tailgate is open, then
it/they is/are locked and the alarm is activated Be aware of the risk of being locked in the
car when it is locked from the outside using
only when it/they are closed. With the Key- the remote control key - it is then not pos-
less* system all the doors and tailgate must be sible to open any of the doors from the
closed. inside with the door controls. Read more
about this in the section "Deadlocks" later
NOTE on.

Be aware of the risk of locking the remote


control key in the car. Automatic relocking
If none of the doors or the tailgate is opened
Manual locking of the door. Not to be mixed up
within 2 minutes of unlocking, all are locked with child safety locks, see page 64.
If it is not possible to lock/unlock with the
again automatically. This function reduces the
remote control key, the battery may be dis- – Use the remote control key's detachable
risk that the car is left unlocked unintentionally.
charged - lock or unlock the left-hand front key blade to turn the knob, see page 50.
(For cars with alarm, see page 65.)
door with the detachable key blade, see
page 50. The door is blocked against opening from
Manual locking the outside.
In certain situations the car must be lockable
manually, e.g. in the event of power failure. The door can be opened from both the
outside and the inside.
The left-hand front door can be locked with its
lock cylinder and the remote control key's
detachable key blade, see page 56.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 59


02 Locks and alarm

Locking/unlocking

NOTE locking button on the driver's door and the Locking


passenger door*. • Press the central locking button - all
02 • A door's knob control only locks that
closed doors are locked.
particular door - not all doors simulta- • Press one side of the button to lock -
neously. the other side to unlock. Press and hold (at least 2 seconds) to also
close all the side windows and the sunroof*
• A manually locked rear door with an
Unlocking simultaneously.
activated manual child safety lock can-
not be opened from either the outside A door can be unlocked from the inside in two
Lock button* rear doors
or the inside, see page 64. A rear door different ways:
that is locked in this way can only be • Press the central locking button .
unlocked with the remote control key or
central locking button. Press and hold (at least 4 seconds) to also
open all the side windows* simultaneously.
• Pull the door handle and open the door -
From the inside the door is unlocked and opened in one
operation.
Central locking
Lamp in lock button
Central locking is available in two variants - the
lamp in the central locking button for the driv-
er's door has different meanings dependent on
the variant. The button's lamp illuminates when the door is
locked.
With central locking button only in the driver's
door, other doors have no button: The rear door lock buttons only lock their
respective rear door.
• Illuminated lamp means that all doors are
locked. To unlock the door:
With central locking button on both front doors • Pull the door handle - the door is unlocked
and electric lock button in each rear door: and opened.
Central locking. • Illuminated lamp means that only that par- Global opening
All of the doors and the tailgate can be locked ticular door is locked. When all buttons are Press and hold the central locking button
or unlocked simultaneously using the central illuminated all doors are locked.
(at least 4 seconds) to also open all the win-

60 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


02 Locks and alarm

Locking/unlocking

dows simultaneously - for example, to quickly Locking the glovebox: The tailgate is held closed by an electrical lock.
ventilate the passenger compartment during To open:
Insert the key blade in the glovebox lock 02
hot weather.
cylinder. 1. Push down gently on the wider of the two
Automatic locking rubberised pressure plates under the outer
Turn the key blade 90 degrees clockwise.
handle - the lock is released.
The doors and tailgate are locked automati- The keyhole is horizontal in the locked
cally when the car starts to move. position. 2. Lift the outside handle in order to fully open
the tailgate.
The function can be activated/deactivated in Pull out the key blade.
the menu system MY CAR under Settings IMPORTANT
Car settings Lock settings Doors • Unlock by carrying this out in reverse
order. • Minimal force is required to release the
automatic lock. For a description of the menu
For information on privacy locking, see rear hatch lock - just gently press the
system, see page 144.
page 51. rubberised panel.
• Do not place the lift force on the rubber
Glovebox panel when opening the rear hatch - lift
Tailgate
the handle. Using too much force may
Manual opening damage the electrical contact for the
rubber panel.

The glovebox can only be locked/unlocked


using the remote control key's detachable key
blade. For information on the key blade, see Rubber plate with electrical contact.
page 50.

61
02 Locks and alarm

Locking/unlocking

Unlocking with the remote control key Unlocking the car from inside Deadlocks*1
Deadlocks means that all door handles are
02
mechanically disengaged, which prevents
doors being opened from the inside.
The deadlocks are activated with the remote
control key and are set after an approximately
10 second delay after the doors have been
locked.

NOTE
If a door is opened within the delay time then
the sequence is interrupted and the alarm is
deactivated.
The alarm for the tailgate can be disarmed* and To unlock the tailgate:
the tailgate unlocked on its own by using the
– Press the lighting panel button (1). The car can only be unlocked from a deadlock
remote control key's button.
> The tailgate is unlocked and can be state with the remote control key. The driver's
The lock indicator on the instrument panel opened within 2 minutes (if the car is door can also be unlocked with the detachable
stops flashing in order to show that not all of locked from the inside). key blade.
the car is locked and the alarm's* level and
movement sensors and the sensors for open- Locking with the remote control key
WARNING
ing the tailgate are disconnected. – Press the remote control key's button for
locking, , see page 47. Do not allow anyone to remain in the car
The doors remain locked and armed. without first deactivating the deadlocks in
> The lock indicator on the instrument order to avoid the risk of anyone being
• The tailgate is unlocked, but remains panel starts flashing, which means that locked in.
closed - press lightly on the rubberised the car is locked and the alarm* has
pressure plate under the outer handle and
been activated.
lift the tailgate.
If the tailgate is not opened within 2 minutes
then it is relocked and the alarm is re-armed.

1 Only in combination with alarm.

62 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


02 Locks and alarm

Locking/unlocking

Temporary deactivation > The instrument panel display shows the NOTE
message Reduced guard See
manual and the deadlocks function is • Remember that the alarm is activated 02
switched off when the car is locked. when the car is locked.

or
• If any of the doors are opened from the
inside then the alarm is triggered.
– Select Ask on exit.
> Each time the engine is switched off the
centre console display screen shows
the message Activate Reduced Guard
until engine has started again? fol-
lowed by the alternatives Confirm with
OK and Cancel with EXIT.
Active menu options are indicated with a cross.
If the deadlocks function shall be switched
MY CAR off
OK MENU – Press OK/MENU and lock the car. (Note
that the alarm's movement and tilt detec-
TUNE knob control
tors* are switched off at the same time, see
EXIT page 66.)
If someone is going to stay in the car but the > The next time the engine is started, the
doors must be locked from the outside, then system is reset to zero and the instru-
the deadlocks function can be temporarily ment panel display shows the message
switched off. This is carried out as follows: Full guard at which the deadlocks
function and the alarm's movement and
1. Access the menu system MY CAR under tilt detectors are re-engaged.
Settings Car settings Reduced
If the locking system shall not be changed
guard (for a detailed description of the
menu system, see page 144). – Press EXIT and lock the car.
2. Select Activate once.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 63


02 Locks and alarm

Child safety locks

Manual blocking of the rear doors WARNING The child safety locks can be activated/deac-
The child safety locks prevent children from tivated in all key positions higher than 0 - see
02 Each rear door has two knob controls - do page 80. Activation/deactivation can be per-
opening a rear door from the inside. not mix up the child safety lock with the
formed up to 2 minutes after switching off the
mechanical door lock.
engine, provided that no door is opened.
To activate the child safety locks:
NOTE
1. Start the engine or choose a key position
• A door's knob control only blocks that higher than 0.
particular door - not both rear doors
simultaneously. 2. Press the button in the driver's door control
panel.
• Cars with an electric child safety lock do
not have a manual child lock. > The information display shows the mes-
sage Rear child locks Activated and
the button's lamp illuminates - the locks
Electrical locking of the rear doors* are active.
With child safety locks. Not to be mixed up with and power windows When the electric child safety lock is active
manual door locks, see page 59.
then the rear:
The child safety locks are located on the trailing
edge of the rear doors and are only accessible
• windows can only be opened with the driv-
er's door control panel
when the doors are open.
• doors cannot be opened from inside.
To activate/deactivate the child safety locks:
The current setting is stored when the engine
– Use the remote control key's detachable is switched off - if the child safety locks are
key blade to turn the knob - see page 50. activated at engine shutdown, the function will
The door is blocked against opening from remain activated the next time the engine is
the inside. started.
The door can be opened from both the
outside and the inside. Control panel driver's door.

64 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


02 Locks and alarm

Alarm*

General NOTE Alarm indicator


Activated alarm is triggered if:
The movement sensors trigger an alarm in 02
• a door, the bonnet or the tailgate is opened the event of movement in the passenger
compartment - air currents are also regis-
• a movement is detected in the passenger tered. For this reason the alarm is triggered
compartment (if fitted with a movement if the car is left with a window or the sunroof
detector*) open or if the passenger compartment
• the car is raised or towed away (if fitted heater is used.
with a tilt detector*) To avoid this: Close the window/sunroof
• the battery's cable is disconnected when leaving the car. If the car's integrated
passenger compartment heater (or a porta-
• the siren is disconnected. ble electric heater) shall be used - direct the
If there is a fault in the alarm system, the infor- airflow from the air vents so that they are not
mation display shows a message. In which pointing upwards in the passenger com- Same LED as lock indicator, see page 47.
case, contact a workshop - an authorised partment.
Volvo workshop is recommended. A red LED on the instrument panel indicates
the alarm system's status:
NOTE
• LED not lit – Alarm not armed
Do not attempt to repair or modify alarm
system components. All such attempts • The LED flashes once every other second
could affect the terms of insurance. – Alarm is armed
• The LED flashes rapidly after disarming the
alarm (and until the remote control key is
inserted in the ignition switch and key posi-
tion I is selected) – Alarm has been trig-
gered.

Arming the alarm


– Press the remote control key lock button.

Deactivate the alarm


– Press the remote control key unlock but-
ton.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 65


02 Locks and alarm

Alarm*

Deactivating a triggered alarm Reduced alarm level


– Press the remote control key unlock button To avoid accidental triggering of the alarm -
02 or insert the remote control key in the igni- e.g. if a dog is left in a locked car or during
tion switch. transport on a car train or car ferry - the move-
ment and tilt detectors should be temporarily
Other alarm functions deactivated.
The procedure is the same as with the tempo-
Automatic re-arming of the alarm
rary disengaging of deadlocks, see page 62.
This function prevents the car being left with
the alarm disarmed unintentionally.
If the car is unlocked with the remote control
key (and the alarm is disarmed) but none of the
doors or the tailgate is opened within 2 2. Insert the remote control key in the ignition
minutes, then the alarm is automatically re- switch.
armed. The car is relocked at the same time. > The alarm is deactivated and the alarm
indicator goes out.
Remote control key not working
If the alarm cannot be deactivated with the 3. Start the engine.
remote control key, e.g. if the key's battery is
discharged - the car can be unlocked, dis-
Alarm signals
armed and the engine started as follows: When the alarm is triggered, the following hap-
pens:
1. Open the driver's door with the detachable
key blade - see page 56. • A siren sounds for 30 seconds or until the
alarm is switched off. The siren has its own
> The alarm is triggered, the alarm indica- battery and works independently of the car
tor flashes rapidly and the siren sounds. battery.
• The direction indicators flash for 5 minutes
or until the alarm is switched off.

66 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


02 Locks and alarm

02

67
Instruments and controls........................................................................ 70
Volvo Sensus ......................................................................................... 79
Key positions.......................................................................................... 80
Seats....................................................................................................... 82
Steering wheel........................................................................................ 87
Lighting................................................................................................... 88
Wipers and washing................................................................................ 97
Windows, rearview and door mirrors.................................................... 100
Compass*.............................................................................................. 105
Power sunroof*..................................................................................... 106
Alcoguard*............................................................................................ 108
Starting the engine................................................................................ 112
Starting the engine – Flexifuel............................................................... 114
Starting the engine – external battery................................................... 116
Gearboxes............................................................................................. 117
Eco Start/Stop DRIVe*.......................................................................... 123
All-wheel drive – AWD*......................................................................... 130
Foot brake............................................................................................. 131
Parking brake........................................................................................ 133
HomeLinkŸ *.......................................................................................... 137

68 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


YOUR DRIVING ENVIRONMENT
03 Your driving environment

Instruments and controls

Instrument overview

03

Left-hand drive.

70
03 Your driving environment

Instruments and controls

Function Page Function Page


Menus and messages, 88, Control for infotainment 144,
direction indicators, 91, 142, and menu control 223, 263
main/dipped beam, trip 166
computer Control panel for climate 155
control 03
Cruise control 171, 175
Gear selector 117
Horn, airbags 20, 87
Controls for active chas- 170
Combined instrument 73, 77 sis (Four-C)*
panel
Wipers and washing 97, 98
Menu, audio and phone 144,
control 224, 251, Steering wheel adjust- 87
263 ment

START/STOP ENGINE 112 Bonnet opener 312


key
Parking brake 133
Ignition switch 80
Seat adjustment* 83
Display for infotainment 144,
and menus 222, 263 Headlamp control, 61, 88,
opener for fuel filler flap 273
Door handle – and tailgate

Control panel 60, 64,


100, 102

Hazard warning flashers 91

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 71


03 Your driving environment

Instruments and controls

03

Right-hand drive.

72
03 Your driving environment

Instruments and controls

Function Page Function Page Information displays

Display for infotainment 144, Parking brake 133


and menus 222, 263
Steering wheel adjust- 87
Ignition switch 80 ment
03
START/STOP ENGINE 112 Menus and messages, 88,
key direction indicators, 91, 142,
main/dipped beam, trip 166
Cruise control 171, 175 computer
Combined instrument 73, 77 Gear selector 117
panel
Controls for active chas- 170
Horn, airbags 20, 87 sis (Four-C)* The information displays show information on
some of the car's functions, e.g. cruise control,
Menu, audio and phone 144, Control panel for climate 155 trip computer and messages. The information
control 224, 251, control is shown with text and symbols.
263
Control for infotainment 144, There are further descriptions under the func-
Wipers and washing 97, 98 and menu control 223, 263 tions that use the information displays.

Door handle – Hazard warning flashers 91

Control panel 60, 64, Bonnet opener 312


100, 102

Headlamp control, 61, 88,


opener for fuel filler flap 273
and tailgate

Seat adjustment* 83

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 73


03 Your driving environment

Instruments and controls

Meters Indicator, information and warning If the engine does not start or if the functionality
symbols check is carried out in key position II then all
symbols go out after 5 seconds except the
symbol for faults in the car's emissions system
and the symbol for low oil pressure.

03
Indicator and information symbols
Symbol Specification
ABL fault

Emissions system

Meters in the combined instrument panel. ABS fault


Speedometer Indicator and warning symbols.
Main beam and direction indicator symbol Rear fog lamp on
Fuel gauge. See also Trip computer, page
166, and Refuelling, page 273. Indicator and warning symbols1
Tachometer. The meter indicates engine Stability system
Symbol for DRIVe - Start/Stop*, see
speed in thousands of revolutions per page 123
minute (rpm). Stability system, sport mode
Indicator and information symbols

Functionality check Engine preheater (diesel)


All indicator and warning symbols illuminate in
key position II or when the engine is started. Low level in fuel tank
When the engine has started, all the symbols
should go out except the parking brake sym- Information, read display text
bol, which only goes out when the brake is dis-
engaged.

1 For certain engine variants, the symbol for low oil pressure is not used. Warnings are made via display text. For information on checking the oil level, see page 313.

74 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


03 Your driving environment

Instruments and controls

Symbol Specification checked. Volvo recommends that you Information, read display text
seek assistance from an authorised Volvo When one of the car's systems does not
Main beam On workshop. behave as intended, this information symbol
Rear fog lamp on illuminates and a text appears on the informa-
Left-hand direction indicators This symbol illuminates when the rear fog lamp tion display. The message text is cleared with
is on. There is only one fog lamp. It is located the READ button, see page 142, or it disap-
on the driver's side. pears automatically after a time (time depend- 03
Right-hand direction indicators ing on which function is indicated). The infor-
Stability system mation symbol can also illuminate in conjunc-
DRIVe - Start/Stop* A flashing symbol indicates that the stability tion with other symbols.
system is operating. If the symbol illuminates
with constant glow then there is a fault in the
NOTE
ABL fault system.
The symbol illuminates if a fault has arisen in When a service message is shown, the sym-
Stability system, Sport mode bol and message are cleared using the
the ABL function (Active Bending Lights). Sport mode allows for a more active driving READ button, or clear automatically after a
Emissions system experience. The system then detects whether while.
If the symbol illuminates then it may be due to the accelerator pedal, steering wheel move-
a fault in the car's emissions system. Drive to ments and cornering are more active than in
normal driving and then allows controlled skid- Main beam On
a workshop for checking. Volvo recommends The symbol illuminates when main beam is on
that you seek assistance from an authorised ding of the rear section up to a certain level
before it intervenes and stabilises the car. and with main beam flash.
Volvo workshop.
Engine preheater (diesel) Left/right-hand direction indicators
ABS fault Both direction indicator symbols flash when
If this symbol illuminates then the system is not This symbol illuminates during engine preheat-
ing. Preheating occurs when the temperature the hazard warning flashers are used.
working. The car's regular brake system con-
tinues to work, but without the ABS function. is below 2 °C. The car can be started once the
symbol goes out.
1. Stop the car in a safe place and turn off the
engine. Low level in fuel tank
When the symbol illuminates the level in the
2. Restart the engine. fuel tank is low, refuel as soon as possible.
3. If the symbol remains illuminated, drive to
a workshop to have the ABS system

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 75


03 Your driving environment

Instruments and controls

Indicator and warning symbols Parking brake applied and check the level in the brake fluid reservoir,
This symbol illuminates with a constant glow see page 317.
Symbol Specification
when the parking brake is applied. The symbol If the brake and ABS symbols illuminate at the
Low oil pressureA flashes during application, and then changes same time, there may be a fault in the brake
over to a constant glow. force distribution system.
Parking brake applied A flashing symbol means that a fault has arisen. 1. Stop the car in a safe place and turn off the
03 Read the message on the information display. engine.
Airbags – SRS Airbags – SRS 2. Restart the engine.
If this symbol remains illuminated or illuminates
Seatbelt reminder while driving, it means a fault has been • If both symbols extinguish, continue
detected in the seatbelt buckle, SRS, SIPS, or driving.

Alternator not charging


IC systems. Drive immediately to a workshop • If the symbols remain illuminated, check
to have the system checked. Volvo recom- the level in the brake fluid reservoir, see
mends that you seek assistance from an page 317. If the brake fluid level is nor-
Fault in brake system authorised Volvo workshop. mal but the symbols are still illuminated,
the car can be driven, with great care, to
Seatbelt reminder
a workshop to have the brake system
Warning This symbol illuminates if someone in a front checked. Volvo recommends that you
seat has not put on their seatbelt or if someone seek assistance from an authorised
A For certain engine variants, the symbol for low oil pressure in a rear seat has taken off their seatbelt. Volvo workshop.
is not used. Warnings are made via display text, see pages
313 and 315. Alternator not charging
This symbol illuminates during driving if a fault WARNING
Low oil pressure has occurred in the electrical system. Visit a
If this symbol illuminates during driving then If the brake fluid is under the MIN level in the
workshop. Volvo recommends that you seek brake fluid reservoir, do not drive further
the engine's oil pressure is too low. Stop the assistance from an authorised Volvo work- before topping up the brake fluid.
engine immediately and check the engine oil shop.
level, top up if necessary. If the symbol illumi- The loss of brake fluid must be investigated
nates and the oil level is normal, contact a
Fault in brake system by a workshop. Volvo recommends that you
workshop. Volvo recommends that you seek If this symbol illuminates, the brake fluid level contact an authorised Volvo workshop.
assistance from an authorised Volvo work- may be too low. Stop the car in a safe place
shop.

76
03 Your driving environment

Instruments and controls

WARNING atory text message in the combined instrument Display for trip meter
panel. Stop the car in a safe place as soon as
If the brake and ABS symbols are illumi- possible and close the door, bonnet or boot lid, Controls for switching between trip meters
nated at the same time, there is a risk that whichever is open. T1 and T2, as well as resetting the trip
the rear end will skid during heavy braking. meters.
If the car is driven at a speed lower than
The meters are used to measure short dis-
approx. 7 km/h then the information
Warning tances. 03
symbol illuminates.
The red warning symbol illuminates when a
One short press on the control switches
fault has been indicated which could affect the If the car is driven at a speed higher
between the two trip meters T1 and T2. A long
safety and/or driveability of the car. An explan- than approx. 7 km/h then the warning
press (more than 2 seconds) resets an active
atory text is shown on the information display symbol illuminates.
trip meter to zero. The distance is shown in the
at the same time. The symbol remains visible
display.
until the fault has been rectified but the text Trip meter
message can be cleared with the READ but-
ton, see page 142. The warning symbol can
also illuminate in conjunction with other sym-
bols.
Action:
1. Stop in a safe place. Do not drive the car
further.
2. Read the information on the information
display. Implement the action in accord-
ance with the message in the display. Clear
the message using the READ button.
Reminder – doors not closed Trip meter and controls.
If one of the doors, the bonnet2 or tailgate is not
closed properly then the information or warn-
ing symbol illuminates together with an explan-

2 Only cars with alarm*.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 77


03 Your driving environment

Instruments and controls

Clock group MY CAR, for more information see


page 144.

03

Clock and setting knob.


Display for showing the time.
1. Locate Settings System options
Controls for setting the clock. Time.
Turn the knob clockwise/anticlockwise to set 2. The cursor is located in the first box for
the clock. Turn first to the end position and then Hour: Press OK - the box is activated.
turn past/over the end position a further 3. Turn TUNE to set the correct hour and
approx. 1 mm - a "click" sounds and is felt in press OK - the box is deactivated.
the button. Each "click" scrolls 1 minute. In 4. Turn TUNE to select the box for Minute (A)
order to change quickly - hold in the "click and press OK - the box is activated (B).
position".
5. Turn TUNE to set the correct minute and
In connection with a message the clock can be press OK - the box is deactivated.
temporarily replaced by a symbol, see 6. Turn TUNE to select the box for OK and
page 142. press OK - the setting is complete.
Setting the clock in MY CAR The menu option Settings System options
In addition to the previous manual/mechanical Time format selects the 24h or 12h system
method the clock can also be set in the menu (AM/PM).

78
03 Your driving environment

Volvo Sensus

General the car can be personalised by means of an


intuitive user interface. Settings can be made
in Car settings, Infotainment, Climate, etc.
With the centre console buttons and controls
or the steering wheel's right-hand keypad*
functions can be activated or deactivated and
many different settings can be made. 03

With a press on MY CAR all settings related to


the driving and control of the car are presented,
such as City Safety, Locks and alarm, setting
the clock, etc.
With a press on the respective function:
Control panel in centre console RADIO, MEDIA, TEL*, NAV* and CAM* other
Navigation* - NAV, see separate owner's sources, systems and functions can be acti-
manual (Road and Traffic Information Sys- vated, e.g. AM, FM1, CD, DVD*, TV*, Blue-
tem - RTI). tooth*, navigation* and park assist camera*.
Infotainment (RADIO, MEDIA, TEL*), see For more information on all functions/systems,
page 222. see the respective section in the owner's man-
ual.
Car settings - MY CAR, see page 144.
Park assist camera - CAM*, see
page 208.
Climate control, see page 152.

Volvo Sensus is the car's operating system, the


heart of your personal Volvo experience. Volvo
Sensus combines and presents many func-
tions in several of the car's systems on the
centre console TV screen. With Volvo Sensus

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 79


03 Your driving environment

Key positions

Insert and remove the remote control IMPORTANT Level Functions


key
Foreign objects in the ignition switch may 0 Odometer, clock and tempera-
jeopardise the function or destroy the lock.
ture gauge are illuminated.
Do not press the remote control key incor-
rectly turned - Hold the end with the detach- Electrically operated seats can be
able key blade, see page 50. adjusted.
03
The audio system can be used for
Withdraw the key a limited time - see page 220.
• Push in the remote control key, allow it to I Sunroof, power windows, 12 V
eject, then pull it out from the ignition
switch. socket in the passenger compart-
ment, RTI, phone, ventilation fan
and windscreen wipers can be
Functions at different levels used.
Ignition switch with remote control key extracted/ To enable the use of a limited number of func-
inserted. tions with the engine switched off, the car's II The headlamps come on.
electrical system can be set in 3 different levels Warning/indicator lamps illumi-
NOTE (key positions) - 0, I and II - with the remote nate for 5 seconds.
For cars with the Keyless* function the key control key. This owner's manual describes
does not need to be inserted into the ignition these levels throughout using the denomina- Several other systems are acti-
switch but can be stored in e.g. a pocket. tion "key positions". vated. However, electric heating
For more information on Keyless functions - in seat cushions and the rear win-
see page 55. The following table shows the functions avail- dow can only be activated after
able in each key position/level. starting the engine.
Insert the key This key position consumes a
1. Hold the end of the remote control key with lot of current from the battery
the detachable key blade and insert the key and should therefore be avoi-
in the ignition switch. ded!
2. Then press the key in the lock up to its end
position.

80 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


03 Your driving environment

Key positions

Selecting key position/level Starting and stopping the engine


Key position 0 For information about starting/switching off the
engine - see page 112.
• Unlock the car - at which point the car's
electrical system is at level 0.
Towing
Key position I For important information about the remote
• With the remote control key fully inserted control key during towing - see page 289. 03
into the ignition switch - Briefly press
START/STOP ENGINE.

NOTE
To reach level I or II without starting the
engine - do not depress the brake/clutch
pedal when these key positions are due to
be selected.

Key position II
• With the remote control key fully inserted
into the ignition switch - Give one long1
press on START/STOP ENGINE.
Back to key position 0
• To return to key position 0 from position II
and I - Briefly press on START/STOP
ENGINE.

Audio system
For information on the audio system's func-
tions with remote control key removed - see
page 220.

1 Approx. 2 seconds.

81
03 Your driving environment

Seats

Front seats WARNING Lift the catches on the rear of the backrest
and fold it forward.
Adjust the position of the driver's seat
before setting off, never while driving. Make 4. Push the seat forward so that the head
sure that the seat is in locked position in restraint "locks" in under the glovebox.
order to avoid personal injury in the event of
sudden braking or an accident. Raising takes place in reverse order.
03
WARNING
Lowering the front seat backrest
Grasp the backrest and make sure that it is
properly locked after being folded up in
order to avoid personal injury in the event of
sudden braking or an accident.

Lumbar support adjustment, turn the


wheel1.
Forward/backward: lift the handle to adjust
the distance to the steering wheel and ped-
als. Check that the seat is locked after
changing position.
Raise/lower* front edge of seat cushion,
pump up/down. The passenger seat backrest can be folded
Adjust backrest rake, turn the wheel. forward to make room for long loads.
Move the seat as far back/down as possi-
Raise/lower the seat, pump up/down.
ble.
Control panel for power seat*. Adjust the backrest to an upright position.

1 Also applies to power seat.

82 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


03 Your driving environment

Seats

Power seat* trol key without the key in the ignition switch. 2. Hold the button depressed to store set-
Seat adjustment is normally made in key posi- tings while depressing one of the memory
tion I and can always be made when the engine buttons.
is running. Using a stored setting
Seat with memory function* Hold one of the memory buttons depressed
until the seat and the door mirrors stop. If you
release the button then the movement of the 03
seat will stop.

Key memory* in remote control key2


The positions of the driver's seat and the door
mirrors3 are stored in the key memory when the
car is locked with the remote control key.
Front edge of seat cushion up/down
Seat forward/backward and up/down
Backrest rake
The power front seats have overload protection Store setting
which is tripped if a seat is blocked by an Memory button
object. If this happens, go to key position I or
0 and wait a short time before adjusting the Memory button
seat again.
Memory button
Only one movement (forward/back/up/down)
can be made at a time. Button for storing settings
1. Adjust the seat and the door mirrors. When the car is unlocked with the same remote
Preparations
The seats can be adjusted for a certain time control key it was locked with and the driver's
after unlocking the door with the remote con-

2 For key memory for keyless drive, see page 57.


3 Only if the car is equipped with power seat with memory and retractable power door mirrors.
``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 83


03 Your driving environment

Seats

door is opened, the driver's seat and also the NOTE Rear seats
door mirrors automatically adopt the positions
stored in the key memory. The key memory in the remote control keys Head restraint, centre seat, rear
and the seat's three memories are com-
pletely independent of each other.
NOTE
The seat and the door mirrors do not move Emergency stop
03 if they are already set the relevant position.
If the seat accidentally begins to move, press
one of the setting buttons for the seat or mem-
It is also possible to use the key memory by ory buttons in order to stop the seat.
pressing the unlock button on the remote con-
Restarting to reach the seat position stored in
trol key when the driver's door is open.
the key memory is performed by pressing the
The key memory can be activated/deactivated unlock button on the remote control key. The
in the menu system MY CAR under Settings driver's door must then be open.
Car settings Car key memory. For a
description of the menu system, see WARNING Adjust the head restraint according to passen-
page 144. ger height so that the whole of the back of the
Risk of crushing! Make sure that children do
not play with the controls. Check that there head is covered if possible. Slide it up as
NOTE are no objects in front of, behind or under required.
the seat during adjustment. Ensure that To lower the head restraint again, the button
In order that the key memory for the driver's
none of the backseat passengers will be (located in the centre between the backrest
seat, and rearview and door mirrors, should
trapped.
work with several remote control keys, the and head restraint, see illustration) must be
key memory must be activated for each one pressed in while the head restraint is pressed
of the remote control keys. Heated seats down.
Each one of the remote control keys must For heated seats, see page 157.
be inserted into the ignition switch when the
key memory is activated for each respective
remote control key.

84
03 Your driving environment

Seats

Manual lowering of the outer head NOTE


restraints, rear seat
The front seats may need to be pushed for-
wards, and/or the backrests adjusted
upwards, in order that the rear backrests
can be folded forward fully.

03
• The left-hand section can be folded sepa-
rately.
• The centre section can be folded sepa-
rately. If the centre backrest is being lowered -
fold and adjust the centre backrest's head
• The right-hand section can only be folded restraint downwards, see page 84.
together with the centre section.
• If the entire backrest is to be folded then The outer head restraints are lowered auto-
the different sections should be folded matically when the outer backrests are
Pull the locking handle closest to the head lowered. Pull up the backrest's locking
separately.
restraint to fold the head restraint forward. handle while folding the backrest for-
The head restraint is moved back manually ward at the same time. A red indicator on
until a "click" can be heard. the lock catch shows that the backrest
is no longer locked in place.
Lowering the rear seat backrest
NOTE
IMPORTANT
When the backrests have been lowered the
There must be no objects on the rear seat head restraints must be moved forward
when the backrest is to be folded down. The slightly so as not to make contact with the
seat belts must not be connected either. seat cushion.
Otherwise there is a risk of damaging the
rear seat upholstery.
Raising takes place in reverse order.
The triple-section backrest can be folded in
different ways.

85
03 Your driving environment

Seats

NOTE 2. Press the button to lower the rear outer


head restraints to improve rearward visi-
When the backrest has been raised, the red bility.
indicator should no longer be showing. If it
is still showing then the backrest is not
locked in place. WARNING
Do not lower the outer head restraints if
03 there are any passengers using of the outer
WARNING seats.
Check that the backrests and head
restraints in the rear seats are firmly locked Move the head restraint back manually until a
after raising.
click is heard.

Electrical lowering of the rear seat's WARNING


outer head restraints*
The head restraints must be in locked posi-
tion after being raised.

1. The remote control key must be in position


I or II.

86 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


03 Your driving environment

Steering wheel

Adjusting WARNING Horn


Adjust and secure the steering wheel before
driving.

With speed related power steering* the level of


steering force can be adjusted, see 03
page 170.

Keypads*

G021138

Adjusting the steering wheel. Horn.


Lever - releasing the steering wheel Press the centre of the steering wheel to signal.
Possible steering wheel positions
The steering wheel can be adjusted for both
height and depth:
1. Pull the lever towards you to release the
steering wheel.
2. Adjust the steering wheel to the position Keypads in the steering wheel.
that suits you. Cruise control, see page 171
3. Push back the lever to fix the steering
Adaptive cruise control, see page 175
wheel in place. If the lever is stiff, press the
steering wheel lightly at the same time as Audio and phone control, see page 224.
you push the lever back.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 87


03 Your driving environment

Lighting

Light switches The intensity of the instrument lighting is Main/dipped beam


adjusted with the thumbwheel.

Headlamp levelling
The load in the car changes the vertical align-
ment of the headlamp beam, which could daz-
03
zle oncoming motorists. Avoid this by adjusting
the height of the beam. Lower the beam if the
car is heavily laden.
1. Allow the engine to run or have the remote
control key in position I.
2. Roll the thumbwheel up/down to raise/
lower beam alignment.
Overview, light switches. Headlamp control and stalk switch.
Cars with Xenon headlamps* have automatic
Thumbwheel for adjusting display and Position for main beam flash
headlamp levelling and therefore do not have
instrument lighting
the thumbwheel. Position for main beam
Rear fog lamp
Light switches

Thumbwheel1 for headlamp levelling

Instrument lighting
Different display and instrument lighting is
switched on depending on key position, see
page 80.
The display lighting is automatically subdued
in darkness - the sensitivity is set with the
thumbwheel.

1 Not available for cars equipped with Xenon headlamps*.

88 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


03 Your driving environment

Lighting

Posi- Specification In position dipped beam is always acti- Active Xenon headlamps - ABL*
tion vated automatically when the engine is running
or when the remote control key is in position
Automatic dipped beam. Main II.
beam and main beam flash
work in this positionA/Deacti- Main beam
vated dipped beam. Main beam can be activated when the head- 03
lamp control is in position 2 or .
Position/parking lamps
Activate/deactivate main beam by moving the
stalk switch towards the steering wheel to the
Dipped beam. Main beam and end position and release. Alternatively, the
main beam flash work in this main beam can be deactivated by a light press
position. of the stalk switch toward the steering wheel.
Headlamp pattern with function deactivated (left)
A Applies to certain markets. When main beam has been activated the sym- and activated (right) respectively.
bol illuminates in the combined instru- If the car is equipped with active Xenon head-
Main beam flash
ment panel. lamps (Active Bending Lights - ABL) the light
Move the stalk switch gently towards the steer-
ing wheel to the position for main beam flash. from the headlamps follows the steering wheel
Main beam comes on until the stalk switch is movement in order to provide maximum light-
released. ing in bends and junctions and so provide
increased safety.
Dipped beam The function is activated automatically when
When the engine is started, dipped beam is the car is started. In the event of a fault in the
activated automatically2 if the headlamp con- function the symbol illuminates in the
trol is in position . If necessary, auto- combined instrument panel at the same time
matic dipped beam for this position can be as the information display shows an explana-
deactivated by a workshop. Volvo recom- tory text and a further illuminated symbol.
mends that you contact an authorised Volvo
workshop.

2 Applies to certain markets.


``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 89


03 Your driving environment

Lighting

Symbol Display Specifica- Auxiliary lamps* tive of what position the headlamp control is in
If the car has auxiliary lamps, the driver can use or what position the ignition is in.
tion
the MY CAR menu system to choose whether
Headlamp The system they should be deactivated or switched on/off Brake lights
failure is disen- simultaneously with the main beam4, see
The brake light automatically comes on during
Service gaged. Visit page 146.
braking. For information on the Emergency
03 required a workshop
brake lights and automatic hazard warning
if the mes-
Position/parking lamps flashers, see page 131.
sage
remains.
Volvo rec- Rear fog lamp
ommends
that you
contact an
authorised
Volvo work-
shop.

The function is only active in twilight or dark-


ness and only when the car is moving.
The function3 can be deactivated/activated in Headlamp control in position for position/parking
the menu system MY CAR under My V60 lamps.
Active bending lights or under Settings Turn the headlamp control to the centre posi- Button for rear fog lamp.
Car settings Light settings Active tion (number plate lighting comes on at the
same time). The rear fog lamp consists of one rear lamp and
bending lights. For a description of the menu can only be switched on in combination with
system, see page 145. When it is dark outside and the tailgate is main/dipped beam.
For headlamp pattern adjustment, see opened the rear position lamps illuminate to
page 93. alert traffic behind. This takes place irrespec-

3 Activated on delivery from the factory.


4 Auxiliary lamps must be connected to the electrical system by a workshop. Volvo recommends that you contact an authorised Volvo workshop.

90 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


03 Your driving environment

Lighting

Press the button for On/Off. The rear fog lamp The hazard warning flashers are activated Short flash sequence
indicator symbol on the combined automatically when the car brakes so suddenly Move the stalk switch up or down to the
instrument panel and the light in the button illu- that the emergency brake lights are activated first position and release. The direction
minate when the rear fog lamp is switched on. and speed is below 30 km/h. They remain on indicators flash three times. The function
when the car has stopped and are deactivated can be activated/deactivated in the menu
The rear fog lamp is switched off automatically automatically when the car is driven off again system MY CAR under Settings Car
when the engine is switched off. or the button is depressed. For more informa- settings Light settings Triple turn 03
tion on Emergency brake lights and automatic
NOTE signal. For a description of the menu sys-
hazard warning flashers, see page 131.
tem, see page 145.
Regulations for using rear fog lamps vary
between different countries. Direction indicators/flashers Continuous flash sequence
Move the stalk switch up or down to the
outer position.
Hazard warning flashers
The stalk switch remains in its position and is
moved back manually, or automatically by the
steering wheel movement.

Direction indicator symbols


For direction indicator symbols, see page 74.

Direction indicators/flashers.

Button for hazard warning flashers.


Press the button to activate the hazard warning
flashers. Both direction indicator symbols in
the combined instrument panel flash when the
hazard warning flashers are in use.

91
03 Your driving environment

Lighting

Interior lighting Front roof lighting Vanity mirror


The front reading lamps are switched on or off The lighting for the vanity mirror, see
by pressing the relevant button in the roof con- page 217, is switched on and off respectively
sole. when the cover is opened or closed.

Rear roof lighting Lighting, cargo area


03 The lighting in the cargo area is switched on
and off respectively when the tailgate is
opened or closed.

Automatic lighting
The switch for passenger compartment light-
G021149 ing has three positions for the lighting in the
passenger compartment:
Controls in roof console for the front reading
lamps and passenger compartment lighting. • Off – right-hand side pressed in, automatic
Reading lamp, left-hand side lighting deactivated.

G021150
• Neutral position – automatic lighting acti-
Reading lamp, right-hand side vated.
Rear roof lighting.
Passenger compartment lighting • On – left-hand side pressed in, passenger
The lamps are switched on or off by pressing compartment lighting switched on.
All lighting in the passenger compartment can each respective button.
be switched on and off manually within Neutral position
30 minutes from when: Courtesy lighting When the button is in neutral position the pas-
Courtesy lighting (and passenger compart- senger compartment lighting is switched on
• the engine has been switched off and the ment lighting) is switched on and off respec- and off automatically in accordance with the
remote control key is in position 0 following.
tively when a side door is opened or closed,
• the car has been unlocked but the engine see page 88 The passenger compartment lighting is
has not been started.
switched on and remains on for 30 seconds if:
Glovebox lighting
Glovebox lighting is switched on and off
respectively when the lid is opened or closed.

92
03 Your driving environment

Lighting

• the car is unlocked with the remote control Home safe light duration Approach light duration
key or key blade, see pages 47 or 50 Some of the exterior lighting can be kept Approach lighting is switched on with the
• the engine has been switched off and the switched on to work as home safe lighting after remote control key, see page 47, and is used
remote control key is in position 0. the car has been locked. to switch on the car's lighting at a distance.
Passenger compartment lighting is switched 1. Remove the remote control key from the When the function is activated with the remote
off when: ignition switch. control, parking lamps, door mirror lamps,
03
• the engine is started number plate lighting, interior roof lamps and
2. Move the left-hand stalk switch toward the
courtesy lighting are switched on.
• the car is locked. steering wheel to the end position and
The passenger compartment lighting comes release it. The function can be activated in The length of time for which the approach light-
on and remains on for two minutes if one of the the same way as with main beam flash, see ing should be kept on can be set in the menu
doors is open. page 88. system MY CAR under Settings Car
3. Get out of the car and lock the door. settings Light settings Approach light
If any lighting is switched on manually and the
car is locked then it will be switched off auto- duration. For a description of the menu sys-
When the function is activated, dipped beam,
matically after two minutes. tem, see page 145.
parking lamps, door mirror lamps, number
plate lighting, interior roof lamps and courtesy
Comfort lighting lighting are switched on. Adjusting headlamp pattern
When the normal passenger compartment
lighting is switched off and the engine is run- The length of time for which the home safe
ning some of the LEDs illuminate, including one lighting should be kept on can be set in the
in the ceiling lighting, in order to provide a low- menu system MY CAR under Settings Car
light and increase comfort while driving. This settings Light settings Home safe light
lighting goes out for a little while after the nor- duration. For a description of the menu sys-
mal passenger compartment lighting when the tem, see page 145.
car is locked.

G021151
Headlamp pattern, left-hand traffic.

``

93
03 Your driving environment

Lighting

Halogen headlamps • Template D: horizontal line approx.


The headlamp pattern for halogen headlamps 85 mm, vertical line approx. 15 mm
is readjusted by masking the headlamp lens.
The headlamp pattern may not be as good.
Masking the headlamps
1. Copy the A and B templates for left-hand
03
drive cars or the C and D templates for
right-hand drive cars with a scale of 1:1,
see page 96:

G021152
• A = LHD Right (left-hand drive, right
lens)
Headlamp pattern, right-hand traffic. • B = LHD Left (left-hand drive, left lens)
The headlamp pattern must be adjusted to • C = RHD Right (right-hand drive, right
avoid dazzling oncoming motorists and can be lens)
set for right or left-hand traffic. The correct pat- • D = RHD Left (right-hand drive, left lens)
tern will also better illuminate the verge.
2. Transfer the template to a self-adhesive
Active Xenon headlamps* waterproof material and cut it out.
The car must be stationary with the engine run- 3. Position the self-adhesive templates at the
ning when the headlamp pattern is shifted right distance from the edge of the head-
between right and left-hand traffic. lamp lens using the illustration, see
1. Access the menu system MY CAR under page 95, and the dimensions in the fol-
Settings Car settings Light lowing list:
settings. • Template A: horizontal line approx.
2. Select between Temporary RH traffic 80 mm, vertical line approx. 20 mm
and Temporary LH traffic. • Template B: horizontal line approx.
80 mm, vertical line approx. 4 mm
For a description of the menu system, see
page 145 • Template C: horizontal line approx.
120 mm, vertical line approx. 4 mm

94 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


03 Your driving environment

Lighting

Aligning the templates

03

Upper row: left-hand drive cars, templates A and B. Lower row: right-hand drive cars, templates C and D.

``

95
03 Your driving environment

Lighting

Templates for halogen headlamps

03

96
03 Your driving environment

Wipers and washing

Windscreen wipers1 Continuous wiping the rain sensor can be adjusted using the
The wipers sweep at normal speed. thumbwheel.
When the rain sensor is activated a light in the
The wipers sweep at high speed. button the rain sensor symbol is shown
in the right-hand display in the combined
instrument panel. 03
IMPORTANT
Activating and setting the sensitivity
Before activating the wipers during winter - When activating the rain sensor, the car must
ensure that the wiper blades are not frozen be running or the remote control key in position
in and that any snow or ice on the wind-
I or II while the windscreen wiper stalk switch
screen (and rear window) is scraped away.
must be in position 0 or in the position for a
single sweep.
Windscreen wipers and windscreen washers. IMPORTANT Activate the rain sensor by pressing the button
Rain sensor, on/off Use plenty of washer fluid when the wipers . The windscreen wipers make one
are cleaning the windscreen. The wind-
Thumbwheel sensitivity/frequency sweep.
screen must be wet when the windscreen
wipers are operating. Press the stalk switch up for the wipers to make
Windscreen wipers off an extra sweep.
Move the stalk switch to position 0 to
Service position wiper blade Turn the thumbwheel upward for higher sensi-
switch off the windscreen wipers.
For cleaning the windscreen/wiper blades and tivity and downward for lower sensitivity. (An
Single sweep replacement of wiper blades see see extra sweep is made when the thumbwheel is
Raise the stalk switch and release to page 325 and 344. turned upward.)
make one sweep. deactivate
Rain sensor*
The rain sensor automatically starts the wind- Deactivate the rain sensor by pressing the but-
Intermittent wiping
Set the number of sweeps per time screen wipers based on how much water it ton or move the stalk switch down to
unit with the thumbwheel when inter- detects on the windscreen. The sensitivity of another wiper program.
mittent wiping is selected.

1 Replacing the wiper blades see page 325, service position, wiper blade see page 325 and filling washer fluid see page 326.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 97


03 Your driving environment

Wipers and washing

The rain sensor is automatically deactivated Washing the windscreen Wiper and washer, rear window
when the remote control key is removed from Move the stalk switch toward the steering
the ignition switch or five minutes after the wheel to start the windscreen and headlamp
engine has been switched off. washers.
The windscreen wipers will make several more
IMPORTANT sweeps and the headlamps are washed once
03 the stalk switch has been released.
The windscreen wipers could start and be
damaged in an automatic car wash. Deac-
tivate the rain sensor while the car is running Heated washer nozzles*
or the remote control key is in position I or The washer nozzles are heated automatically
II. The symbol in the combined instrument in cold weather to prevent the washer fluid
panel and the lamp in the button go out. freezing solid.

High-pressure headlamp washing*


Washing the headlamps and windows High-pressure headlamp washing consumes a Rear window wiper – intermittent wiping
large quantity of washer fluid. To save fluid, the Rear window wiper – continuous speed
headlamps are washed automatically at every
fifth windscreen wash cycle. Press the stalk switch forward (see the arrow
in the illustration above) to initiate rear window
washing and wiping.

NOTE
The rear window wiper is equipped with
overheating protection which means that
the motor is switched off if it overheats. The
rear window wiper works again after a cool-
ing period (30 seconds or longer, depending
on the heat in the motor and the outside
Washing function. temperature).

98 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


03 Your driving environment

Wipers and washing

Wiper – reversing
Engaging reverse gear while the windscreen
wipers are on initiates intermittent rear window
wiping2. The function stops when reverse gear
is disengaged.
If the rear window wiper is already on at con-
03
tinuous speed, no change is made.

NOTE
On cars with rain sensor, the rear window
wiper is activated with reversing, if the sen-
sor is activated and it is raining.

2 This function (intermittent wiping when reversing) can be deactivated. Visit a workshop. Volvo recommends that you contact an authorised Volvo workshop.

99
03 Your driving environment

Windows, rearview and door mirrors

General Heat-reflecting windscreen* windscreen with no heat-reflecting film (see the


highlighted area in the above illustration).
Laminated glass
The glass is reinforced which pro-
vides better protection against Power windows
break-ins and improved sound insu-
03 lation in the passenger compartment.
The windscreen and other windows* have lami-
nated glass.

Water and dirt-repellent coating*


Windows are treated with a coating
that improves the view in difficult
weather conditions. Maintenance, see
Areas where IR film is not applied.
page 345.

IMPORTANT Dimensions
Driver's door control panel.
Do not use a metal ice scraper to remove ice A 40 mm
from the windows. Use the defroster to Switch for electric child safety locks* and
remove ice from the mirrors, see B 80 mm disengaging rear power window buttons,
page 103. see page 64.
The windscreen is equipped with a heat- Rear window controls
reflecting film (IR) that reduces the solar heat
radiation into the passenger compartment. Front window controls
The positioning of electronic equipment, such
as a transponder, behind a glass surface with WARNING
heat-reflecting film may affect its function and Check that none of the rear seat passengers
performance. is in danger of becoming trapped in any way
For the optimal function of electronic equip- when closing the windows from the driver's
door.
ment, it should be positioned on the part of the

100 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


03 Your driving environment

Windows, rearview and door mirrors

WARNING Operating Closing of the windows is stopped and the


window is opened if anything prevents its
Make sure that children or other passengers movement. It is possible to override the pinch
are not in danger of becoming trapped in protection when closing has been interrupted,
any way when closing the windows, in par-
ticular when the remote control key is used. e.g. if there is ice forming. After two successive
closing interruptions the pinch protection will
be forced and the automatic function deacti- 03
WARNING vated for a short while, now it is possible to
If there are children in the car - remember to close by continually holding the button pulled
always switch off the power supply to the up.
power windows by selecting key position 0
and then take the remote control key with NOTE
you when leaving the car. For information on
key positions - see page 81. One way to reduce the pulsating wind noise
Operating the power windows. when the rear windows are open is to also
Operating without auto open the front windows slightly.

Operating with auto


Operating without auto
All power windows can be operated using the Move one of the controls up/down gently. The
control panel for the driver's door - the control power windows move up/down as long as the
panels for the other doors can only each oper- control is held in position.
ate their respective power window. Only one
control panel can be operated at a time. Operating with auto
Move one of the controls up/down to the end
In order for the power windows to be used the position and release it. The window runs auto-
key position must be at least I - see page 80. matically to its end position.
The power windows can be operated for a few
Operating with the remote control key
minutes after the engine has been switched off
and after the remote control key has been and central locking
removed - although not after a door has been To remotely operate the power windows from
opened. the outside with the remote control key or from
inside with central locking, see pages 48 and
60

101
03 Your driving environment

Windows, rearview and door mirrors

Resetting Door mirrors WARNING


If the battery is disconnected then the function
for automatic opening must be reset so that it The mirror on the driver's side is the wide-
angle type to provide optimal vision.
can work correctly. Objects may appear further away than they
1. Gently raise the front section of the button actually are.
to raise the window to its end position and
03 hold it there for one second. Storing the position1
2. Release the button briefly. The mirror positions are stored in the key mem-
ory when the car has been locked with the
3. Raise the front section of the button again
remote control key. When the car is unlocked
for one second.
with the same remote control key the mirrors
and the driver's seat adopt the stored positions
WARNING when the driver's door is opened.
Door mirror controls.
Resetting must be carried out to ensure that The function can be activated/deactivated in
pinch protection works. Adjusting the menu system MY CAR under Settings
1. Press the L button for the left-hand door
Car settings Car key memory Position
mirror or the R button for the right-hand
door mirror. The light in the button illumi- of door mirrors and driver's seat in key. For
nates. a description of the menu system, see
page 145.
2. Adjust the position with the joystick in the
centre. Angling the door mirror when parking1
The door mirror can be angled down for the
3. Press the L or R button again. The light driver to view the side of the road when parking
should no longer be illuminated. for example.
– Engage reverse gear and press the L or R
button.
When reverse gear is disengaged the mirror
automatically returns to its original position

1 Only in combination with power seat with memory, see page 83.

102
03 Your driving environment

Windows, rearview and door mirrors

after approx. 10 seconds, or sooner by press- Resetting to neutral Home safe and approach lighting
ing the L and R button. Mirrors that have been moved out of position The light on the door mirrors illuminates when
Automatic angling of the door mirror by an external force must be reset electrically approach lighting or home safe lighting is
to the neutral position for electric retracting/ selected, see page 93.
when parking1
extending to work correctly:
When reverse gear is engaged the door mirror
is automatically angled down so that the driver 1. Retract the mirrors with the L and R but- Rear window and door mirror
can see the side of the road when parking for tons. defrosters 03
example. When reverse gear is disengaged the
2. Fold them out again with the L and R but-
mirror automatically returns to its original posi-
tons.
tion after a short time.
3. Repeat the above procedure as necessary.
The function can be activated/deactivated in
the menu system MY CAR under Settings The mirrors are now reset in neutral position.
Car settings Side mirror settings Tilt Retractable power door mirrors*
left mirror or Tilt right mirror. For a descrip- The mirrors can be retracted for parking/driving
tion of the menu system, see page 145. in narrow spaces:
Automatic retraction when locking1 1. Depress the L and R buttons simultane-
When the car is locked/unlocked with the ously (key position must be at least I).
remote control key the door mirrors are auto-
matically retracted/extended. 2. Release them after
approximately 1 second. The mirrors auto- Use the defroster to quickly remove misting
The function can be activated/deactivated in matically stop in the fully retracted posi- and ice from the rear window and the door mir-
the menu system MY CAR under Settings tion. rors.
Car settings Side mirror settings Fold Fold out the mirrors by pressing down the L One press of the button starts the heating. The
mirrors. For a description of the menu system, and R buttons simultaneously. The mirrors light in the button indicates that the function is
see page 145. automatically stop in the fully extended posi- active. Disconnect the heating as soon as the
tion. ice/misting is cleared in order not to load the
battery unnecessarily. However, the heating is
switched off automatically after a certain time.

1 Only in combination with power seat with memory, see page 83.
``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 103


03 Your driving environment

Windows, rearview and door mirrors

The rear window is demisted/defrosted auto- dimming with the dimming control when lights
matically if the car is started in an outside tem- from behind are distracting:
perature lower than +9 °C. Automatic defrost-
1. Use dimming by moving the control in
ing can be selected in the menu system MY
towards the passenger compartment.
CAR under Settings Climate settings
Automatic rear defroster. Select between 2. Return to normal position by moving the
03 On or Off. For a description of the menu sys- control towards the windscreen.
tem, see page 145. Automatic dimming*
Bright light from behind is automatically
Interior rearview mirror dimmed by the rearview mirror. The control is
not available in mirrors with automatic dim-
ming.
The compass* can only be specified for rear-
view mirrors with automatic dimming, see
page 105.

Control for dimming

Manual dimming
Bright light from behind could be reflected in
the rearview mirror and dazzle the driver. Use

104 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


03 Your driving environment

Compass*

Operation should be calibrated if the car is moved across 4. Hold the button on the underside of the
several magnetic zones. rearview mirror depressed
approx. 3 seconds. The number of the cur-
1. Stop the car in a large open area free from
rent magnetic zone is shown.
steel structures and high-voltage power
lines. 5. Press the button repeatedly until the
2. Start the car. required magnetic zone (1–15) is shown.
See the map of magnetic zones for the 03
compass.
NOTE
6. Wait until the display resumes showing the
For optimum calibration - switch off all elec-
character C.
trical equipment (climate control system,
wipers etc.) and make sure that all doors are 7. Drive slowly in a circle at a speed of no
closed. more than 10 km/h until a compass direc-
Rearview mirror with compass. tion is shown in the display, indicating that
The upper right-hand corner of the rearview 3. Hold the button on the underside of the calibration is complete. Then drive a further
mirror has an integrated display that shows the rearview mirror depressed 2 circles to fine-tune calibration.
compass direction in which the front of the car approx. 6 seconds (using a paper clip for 8. Repeat the above procedure as necessary.
is pointing. Eight different directions are shown example) until the character C is shown.
with English abbreviations: N (north), NE (north
east), E (east), SE (south east), S (south), SW
(south west), W (west) and NW (north west).
The compass is activated automatically when
the car is started or in key position II, see
page 80. To deactivate/activate the compass -
press in the button on the underside of the mir-
ror using a paper clip for example.

Calibration

G030295
The earth is divided into 15 magnetic zones.
The compass is set for the geographic area to
which the car was delivered. The compass Magnetic zones.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 105


03 Your driving environment

Power sunroof*

General Open manually by pulling the control back- WARNING


The sunroof controls are located in the roof wards to the point of resistance for manual
opening. The sunroof moves to maximum open If there are children in the car:
panel. The sunroof can be opened vertically at
the rear edge and horizontally. Key position I or position as long as the button is kept Remember to always switch off the power
II is required for the sunroof to be opened. depressed. supply to the sunroof by selecting key posi-
tion 0 and then take the remote control key
Closing with you when leaving the car. For informa-
03 Horizontal opening Close manually by pushing the control for- tion on key positions - see page 81.
wards to the point of resistance for manual
closing. The sunroof moves to closed position
as long as the button is kept depressed. Vertical opening

WARNING
Risk of crushing when sunroof is closed.
The sunroof's pinch-protection function
only operates during automatic closing, not
manual.
G017823

Close automatically by pressing the control to


Horizontal opening, backward/forward. the position for automatic closing and then

G028900
Opening, automatic release it.
The power supply to the sunroof is switched off
Opening, manual Vertical opening, raised at the rear edge.
by selecting key position 0 and removing the
Closing, manual remote control key from the ignition switch. Open by pressing the rear edge of the con-
trol upward.
Closing, automatic
Close by pulling the rear edge of the con-
Opening trol down.
For maximum sunroof opening, move the con-
trol back to the position for automatic opening
and release.

106 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


03 Your driving environment

Power sunroof*

Closing using the remote control key or Pinch protection


central locking button The sunroof's pinch protection function is trig-
gered if it is blocked by an object during auto-
matic closing. If blocked, the sunroof will stop
and automatically open to the previous posi-
tion.
03
Wind deflector

G021345

One long press on the lock button closes the


sunroof and all the windows, see pages 47 and
60. The doors and the tailgate are locked. To
interrupt closing, press the lock button again.

WARNING
If the sunroof is closed using the remote The sunroof has a wind deflector that is folded
control key, check that no one is in danger up when the sunroof is in the open position.
of becoming trapped in any way.

Sunscreen
The sunroof features a manual, sliding interior
sunscreen. The sunscreen slides back auto-
matically when the sunroof is opened. Grip the
handle and slide the screen forward to close it.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 107


03 Your driving environment

Alcoguard*

General information on the alcolock 1. Nozzle for breath test. NOTE


The function of the Alcolock is to prevent the 2. Switch.
Store the Alcolock in its holder. This will
car from being driven by individuals under the 3. Transmission button. keep the built-in battery fully charged and
influence of alcohol. Before the engine can be the Alcolock is activated automatically
4. Lamp for battery status.
started the driver must take a breath test that when the car is opened.
verifies that he/she is not under the influence 5. Lamp for result of breath test.
03 of alcohol. Alcolock calibration takes place in 6. Lamp indicates ready for breath test.
Before starting the engine
accordance with each market's limit value in
The Alcolock is activated automatically and is
force for driving legally.
Operation then ready for use when the car is opened.
WARNING Battery 1. When the indicator lamp (6) is green the
Alcolock indicator lamp (4) shows battery sta- Alcolock is ready for use.
The Alcolock is an aid and does not exempt
the driver from responsibility. It is always the tus: 2. Withdraw the Alcolock from its holder. If
responsibility of the driver to be sober and the Alcolock is outside the car when it is
to drive the car safely. unlocked then it must first be activated
Indicator lamp Battery status
with the switch (2).
(4)
3. Fold up the nozzle (1), take a deep breath
Functions Green flashing Charging in pro- and blow with an even pressure until a
gress "click" is heard after approx. 5 seconds.
The result will be one of the alternatives in
Green Fully charged the following table Result after breath
test.
Yellow Semi-charged
4. If no message is shown then the transmis-
Red Discharged - fit the sion to the car may have failed - in which
charger in the holder case, press the button (3) to transmit the
or connect the result to the car manually.
power supply cable 5. Fold down the nozzle and refit the Alcolock
from the glovebox. in its holder.
6. Start the engine following an approved
breath test within 5 minutes - otherwise it
must be repeated.

108 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


03 Your driving environment

Alcoguard*

Result after breath test To bear in mind tion will then be possible, see page 110 sec-
tion Emergency situation.
Indicator lamp Specification Before the breath test
(5) + Display text In order to obtain correct function and as accu- The message can be cleared by pressing the
rate a measurement result as possible: send button (3) once. Otherwise it goes out on
Green lamp + Alco- Start the engine - no its own after approx. 2 minutes but then reap-
guard Approved alcohol content • Avoid eating or drinking approx. pears each time the engine is started - only
test measured. 5 minutes before the breath test. recalibration at a workshop1 can clear the mes- 03

Yellow lamp + Alco- Engine starting pos-


• Avoid excess windscreen washing - the sage permanently.
alcohol in the washer fluid may result in an
guard Approved sible - measured incorrect measurement result. Cold or hot weather
test alcohol content is The colder the weather the longer it takes
above 0.1 promille Change of driver before the Alcolock is ready for use:
but below the limit In order to ensure that a new breath test is car-
value in forceA. ried out in the event of a change of driver -
Temperature (ºC) Maximum heat-
depress the switch (2) and the send button (3)
Red lamp + Disap- Engine starting not ing time (sec-
simultaneously for approx. 3 seconds. At
proved test Wait 1 possible - measured onds)
which point the car returns to start inhibition
minute alcohol content is mode and a new approved breath test is +10 - +85 10
above the limit value required before starting the engine.
in forceA. -5 - +10 60
A
Calibration and service
Limits vary between countries, so find out what limits apply.
See also the section entitled General information on the The Alcolock must be checked and calibrated -40 - -5 180
Alcolock on page 108
at a workshop1 every 12 months.
At temperatures below -20 ºC or above
NOTE 30 days before recalibration is necessary the
+60 ºC the Alcolock requires additional power
display shows Alcoguard Calibr. required. If
After a completed period of driving, the supply. The display shows Alcoguard insert
calibration is not carried out within these 30
engine can be restarted within 30 minutes power cable. In which case, connect the
without a new breath test. days then normal engine starting will be
power supply cable from the glovebox and wait
blocked - only starting with the Bypass func-
until indicator lamp (6) is green.

1 An authorised Volvo workshop is recommended.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 109


03 Your driving environment

Alcoguard*

In extremely cold weather the heating time can Activating the Bypass function Symbols and display messages
be reduced by taking the Alcolock indoors. • Depress and hold the left-hand stalk In addition to the previously described mes-
switch READ button and the button for sages, the combined instrument panel's dis-
Emergency situation hazard warning flashers simultaneously for play can also show the following:
In the event of an emergency situation, or if the approx. 5 seconds - the display first shows
Alcolock is out of order or has been removed, Bypass activated Wait 1 minute and
it is possible to bypass the Alcolock in order to then Alcoguard Bypass enabled - after Display text Meaning/Action
03
drive the car. which the engine can be started. Alcoguard Restart The engine has been
This function can be activated several times. possible switched off for less
NOTE The error message shown during driving can than 30 minutes -
All Bypass activation is logged and saved in only be cleared at a workshop1. engine starting pos-
memory, see page 8 in the section, Record- Activating the Emergency function sible without new
ing data. test.
• Depress and hold the left-hand stalk
switch READ button and the button for Alcoguard Service Contact a work-
After the Bypass function has been activated hazard warning flashers simultaneously for
required shop1.
the display shows Alcoguard Bypass approx. 5 seconds - the display shows
enabled the whole time while driving and can Alcoguard Bypass enabled and the Alcoguard No sig- Transmission failed -
only be reset by a workshop1. engine can be started. nal send manually with
The Bypass function can be tested without the This function can be used once, after which a button (3) or take a
error message being logged - in which case, reset must be made at a workshop1. new breath test.
carry out all the steps without starting the car. Alcoguard Invalid Test failed - take a
The error message is cleared when the car is test new breath test.
locked.
When the Alcolock is installed, either the Alcoguard Blow Blowing too short -
Bypass or Emergency function is selected as longer blow for longer.
the bypassing option. This setting can be Blowing too hard -
Alcoguard Blow
changed afterwards at a workshop1. softer blow more gently.

1 An authorised Volvo workshop is recommended.

110 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


03 Your driving environment

Alcoguard*

Display text Meaning/Action


Alcoguard Blow Blowing too weak -
harder blow harder.

Alcoguard wait Heating not finished


Preheating - wait for text Alco- 03
guard Blow 5 sec-
onds.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 111


03 Your driving environment

Starting the engine

Petrol and diesel engines 2. Hold the clutch pedal fully depressed1. (For NOTE
cars with automatic gearbox - Depress the
brake pedal.) The idling speed can be noticeably higher
than normal for certain engine types during
3. Press the START/STOP ENGINE button cold starting. This is so that the emissions
and then release it. system can reach normal operating tem-
perature as quickly as possible, which min-
03 The starter motor works until the engine starts imises exhaust emissions and protects the
or until its overheating protection triggers. environment.

IMPORTANT Keyless drive*


If the engine fails to start after 3 attempts - Follow steps 2–3 for starting petrol and diesel
wait for 3 minutes before making a further engines. For more information on Keyless drive
attempt. Starting capacity increases if the - see page 55.
Ignition switch with remote control key extracted/ battery is allowed to recover.
inserted. and START/STOP ENGINE button.
NOTE
IMPORTANT WARNING A prerequisite for the car to start is that one
Always remove the remote control key from of the car's remote control keys with the
Do not press in the remote control key incor- Keyless drive* function is in the passenger
the ignition switch when leaving the car, and
rectly turned - Hold the end with the detach- compartment or cargo area.
make sure that the key position is 0 - in par-
able key blade, see page 50.
ticular if there are children in the car. For
information on how this works - see
page 81. WARNING
1. Insert the remote control key in the ignition
switch and press it in to its end position. Never remove the remote control key from
Note that if the car is equipped with an the car while driving or during towing.
alcolock then a breath test must first be
approved before the engine can be started Stop the engine
- see page 108. To switch off the engine:

1 If the car is moving then it is enough to press the START/STOP ENGINE button to start the car.

112 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


03 Your driving environment

Starting the engine

• Press START/STOP ENGINE - the engine


stops.
• If the car has an automatic gearbox and the
gear selector is not in a position P or if the
car is moving - Press twice or hold the
START/STOP ENGINE button depressed
until the engine stops. 03

Steering lock
A mechanical noise can be perceived when the
steering lock unlocks or locks.
• The steering lock unlocks when the remote
control key is in the ignition switch2 and the
START/STOP ENGINE button is
depressed.
• The steering lock locks when the driver's
door is opened after the engine has been
switched off.

Key positions
For information on the remote control key's dif-
ferent key positions - see page 80

2 Cars with Keyless drive must have a remote control key inside the passenger compartment.

113
03 Your driving environment

Starting the engine – Flexifuel

General information about starting Engine block heater* WARNING


with Flexifuel
The engine block heater is powered by high
The engine is started in the same way as in a voltage. Fault tracing and repair of an elec-
petrol-engined car. tric engine block heater and its electrical
connections must only be carried out by a
workshop - an authorised Volvo workshop
03
In the event of starting difficulties is recommended.
If the engine does not start at the first start
attempt:
NOTE
• Make further attempts to start with the
START/STOP ENGINE button. Points to remember for carrying reserve
fuel:
If the engine still does not start
• In the event of stalling due to an empty
The outside temperature is lower than +5 °C: Electrical input to the engine block heater. fuel tank, bioethanol E85 from a reserve
1. Connect the engine block heater for at When the temperature is expected to be lower fuel can may make the engine difficult
least 1 hour. to start in extreme cold. This is avoided
than –10 °C and the car has been refuelled with
by filling the reserve fuel can with 95
2. Make further attempts to start with the bioethanol E85, an engine block heater should
octane petrol.
START/STOP ENGINE button. be used for about 2 hours to facilitate the quick
starting of the engine.
For more information on Flexifuel's bioethanol
IMPORTANT The lower the temperature, the longer the time
E 85 fuel, see page 275 and 363.
If the engine does not start despite repeated required with the engine block heater. At
start attempts, you are recommended to -20 °C the heater should be used for approx. 3
contact an authorised Volvo workshop. hours.
Cars intended for E85 have an electric engine
block heater*. Starting and driving with a pre-
heated engine involves significantly lower
emissions and reduced fuel consumption. For
this reason you should aim to use the engine
block heater throughout the winter months.

114 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


03 Your driving environment

Starting the engine – Flexifuel

Fuel adaptation
Flexifuel engines can be driven on both 95
octane unleaded petrol and bioethanol E85.
Both fuels are filled in the common fuel tank so
that any variations of mixing ratios between
these two fuels is possible.
03
If the fuel tank is filled with petrol after the car
has been driven on bioethanol E85 (or vice
versa) then the engine may run slightly
unevenly for a time. For this reason it is impor-
tant to allow the engine to accustom itself
(adapt) to the new fuel mixture.
Adaptation takes place automatically when the
car is driven for a short period at an even
speed.

IMPORTANT
After the fuel mixture in the tank has been
changed an adaptation should be made by
driving at an even speed for about 15
minutes.

If the battery has been discharged or discon-


nected then a slightly longer period of driving
is required for the adaptation as the memory
for the electronics has been cleared.

115
03 Your driving environment

Starting the engine – external battery

Jump starting 4. Connect one of the red jump lead's clamps IMPORTANT
to the donor battery's positive terminal (1).
Do not touch the crocodile clips during the
start procedure. There is a risk of sparks
IMPORTANT forming.
Connect the start cable carefully to avoid
short circuits with other components in the 12. Remove the jump leads in reverse order -
03 engine compartment.
first the black and then the red.
> Make sure that none of the black jump
5. Open the clips on the front cover of the lead's clamps comes into contact with
battery in your car and remove the cover, the battery's positive terminal or the
see page 328. clamp connected to the red jump lead!
6. Connect the red jump lead's other clamp
onto the car's positive terminal (2). WARNING
If the battery is flat then the car can be started
with current from another battery. 7. Connect one of the black jump lead's • The battery can generate oxyhydrogen
clamps to the donor battery's negative ter- gas, which is highly explosive. A spark
When jump starting the car, the following steps minal (3). can be formed if a jump lead is con-
are recommended to avoid short circuits or nected incorrectly, and this can be
other damage: 8. Connect the other clamp to a grounding
enough for the battery to explode.
point, e.g. right-hand engine mounting at
1. Insert the remote control key in key posi- the top, the outer screw head (4). • The battery contains sulphuric acid,
tion 0, see page 80. which can cause serious burns.
9. Check that the jump lead clamps are
2. Check that the donor battery has a voltage affixed securely so that there are no sparks • If sulphuric acid comes into contact
of 12 V. with eyes, skin or clothing, flush with
during the starting procedure.
large quantities of water. If acid
3. If the donor battery is installed in another 10. Start the engine of the "donor car" and splashes into the eyes - seek medical
car - switch off the donor car's engine and allow it to run a few minutes at a speed attention immediately.
make sure that the two cars do not touch slightly higher than idle approx. 1500 rpm.
each other.
11. Start the engine in the car with the dis- For more information on the car's battery - see
charged battery. page 327.

116
03 Your driving environment

Gearboxes

Manual gearbox Look at the actual gearshift pattern imprinted Automatic gearbox Geartronic*
on the gear lever.
• Depress the clutch pedal fully during each
gear change.
• Take your foot off the clutch pedal between
gear changes.
03

WARNING
Get into the habit of always applying the
parking brake when parking on a slope - an
engaged gear is not sufficient to hold the car
in all situations.
Gearshift pattern 5-speed gearbox. D: Automatic gear positions. M (+/–): Manual gear
Reverse gear inhibitor positions.
The reverse gear inhibitor hinders the possibil- The information display shows the position of
ity of mistakenly attempting to engage reverse the gear selector using the following indica-
gear during normal forward travel. tions: P, R, N, D, S, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 or 6, see
• Start from neutral position N and only page 73.
engage reverse gear R when the car is sta-
tionary. Gear positions
Parking position (P)
NOTE Select P when starting the engine or when the
car is parked. The brake pedal must be
With the upper variant of the shifting pattern
for 6-speed gearbox (see previous illustra- depressed to disengage the gear selector from
tion) - first press down the gear lever in the the P position.
Gearshift pattern 6-speed gearbox. N position in order to engage reverse gear. The gearbox is mechanically blocked when the
The 6-speed box is available in two versions - P position is engaged. Apply the parking brake
reverse gear position differs between them. as well, as a precaution - see page 133.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 117


03 Your driving environment

Gearboxes

IMPORTANT car engine-brakes when the accelerator pedal NOTE


is released.
The car must be stationary when position f the gearbox has a Sport programme then
P is selected. Manual gearshift mode is obtained by moving the gearbox will only become manual after
the lever to the side from position D to the end the lever has been moved forwards or back-
position at +/–. The information display shifts wards in its (-+/–) position. The information
WARNING the indication from D to one of the figures 1 – display then shifts the indication from S to
03 6, which is equivalent to the gear that is show which of the gears 1-6 is engaged.
Get into the habit of always applying the
parking brake when parking on a slope - the engaged just then, see page 73.
automatic transmission's P position is not Geartronic - Sport mode (S)1
sufficient to hold the car in all situations. • Move the lever forwards towards + (plus)
to change up a gear and release the lever, The Sport programme provides sportier cha-
which returns to its rest position between racteristics and allows higher engine speed for
Reverse (R) + and –. the gears. At the same time it responds more
The car must be stationary when position R is or quickly to acceleration. During active driving,
selected. the use of a lower gear is prioritised, leading to
Neutral position (N)
• Pull the lever back towards – (minus) to a delayed upshift.
change down a gear and release it.
No gear is engaged and the engine can be Sport mode is obtained by moving the lever to
started. Apply the parking brake if the car is The manual gearshift mode (+/–) can be the side from D position to the end position at
stationary with the gear selector in position N. selected at any time while driving. +/–. The information display shifts the indica-
Drive (D) Geartronic automatically shifts down if the tion from D to S.
D is the normal driving position. Shifting up and driver allows the speed to decrease lower than Sport mode can be selected at any time while
down takes place automatically based on the a level suitable for the selected gear, in order driving.
level of acceleration and speed. The car must to avoid jerking and stalling.
be stationary when the gear selector is moved To return to automatic driving mode: Geartronic - Winter mode
to position D from position R. It can be easier to pull away on slippery roads
• Move the lever to the side to the end posi- if 3rd gear is engaged manually.
Geartronic – Manual gear positions (+/-) tion at D.
1. Depress the brake pedal and move the
The driver can also change gear manually
gear lever from the D position to the end
using the Geartronic automatic gearbox. The
position at +/– - the instrument panel dis-

1 Only models D5 and T6.

118
03 Your driving environment

Gearboxes

play shifts the indication from D to the fig- happens if the driver still tries to shift down in Automatic gear selector inhibitor
ure 1. this way at high engine speed – the original The automatic gearbox has special safety sys-
2. Scroll up to gear 3 by pushing the lever gear remains engaged. tems:
forward towards + (plus) twice - the display When kick-down is activated the car can Parking position (P)
shifts the indication from 1 to 3. change one or more gears at a time depending Stationary car with engine running:
3. Release the brake and accelerate carefully. on engine speed. The car changes up when the
engine reaches its maximum speed in order to Keep your foot on the brake pedal when mov- 03
The gearbox "winter mode" means that the car ing the gear selector to another position.
moves off with a lower engine speed and prevent damage to the engine.
reduced engine power on the drive wheels. Electric gear inhibitor – Shiftlock Parking
Mechanical gear selector inhibitor position (P)
Kick-down To be able to move the gear selector from P to
When the accelerator pedal is pressed all the other gear positions, the brake pedal must be
way to the floor (beyond the position normally depressed and the remote control key must be
regarded as full acceleration) a lower gear is in position II, see page 80.
immediately engaged. This is known as kick- Shiftlock – Neutral (N)
down.
If the gear selector is in the N position and the
If the accelerator is released from the kick- car has been stationary for at least 3 seconds
down position, the gearbox automatically (irrespective of whether the engine is running)
changes up. then the gear selector is locked.

G021351
Kick-down is used when maximum accelera- To be able to move the gear selector from N to
tion is needed, such as for overtaking. other gear positions, the brake pedal must be
depressed and the remote control key must be
Safety function The gear selector can be moved forward and
in position II, see page 80.
To prevent overrevving the engine, the gearbox back freely between N and D. Other positions
control program has a protective downshift are locked with a latch that is released with the
inhibitor which prevents the kick-down func- inhibitor button on the gear selector.
tion. With the inhibitor button depressed the lever
Geartronic does not permit downshifting/kick- can be moved forwards or backwards between
down which would result in an engine speed P, R, N and D.
high enough to damage the engine. Nothing

``

119
03 Your driving environment

Gearboxes

Deactivate automatic gear selector Automatic gearbox Powershift* bonnet - see page 352. The designa-
inhibitor tion ”MPS6” means that it is Powershift trans-
mission - otherwise it is Geartronic automatic
transmission.

HSA
03
The HSA (Hill Start Assist) function means that
the pressure in the brake system remains for
several seconds while the foot is moved from
the brake pedal to the accelerator pedal before
setting off or reversing uphill.
The temporary braking effect releases after
several seconds or when the driver acceler-
D: Automatic gear positions. M (+/–): Manual gear ates.
positions.
If the car cannot be driven, e.g. due to a flat To bear in mind
battery, the gear selector must be moved from Powershift is a six-stage automatic gearbox
The transmission's double clutch has overload
the P position so that the car can be moved. that has double mechanical clutch discs in
protection that is activated if it becomes too
contrast to a conventional automatic gearbox.
Lift the rubber mat in the compartment hot, e.g. if the car is held stationary with the
A conventional automatic gearbox has a
behind the centre console and open the accelerator pedal on an uphill gradient for a
hydraulic torque converter instead that trans-
hatch. long time.
fers power from engine to gearbox.
Fully insert the key blade. Press the key Overheated transmission causes the car to
Powershift transmission operates in the same
blade down and hold (For information on shake and vibrate, and the warning symbol illu-
way and has similar controls and functions as
the key blade, see page 50.) minates and the information display shows a
the Geartronic automatic transmission, descri-
message. The transmission can also overheat
Move the gear selector from the P position. bed in the previous section.
during slow driving in queues (10 km/h or
Powershift or Geartronic? slower) on an uphill gradient, or with a trailer
In the event of uncertainty as to whether or not hitched. The transmission cools down when
the car is equipped with Powershift transmis- the car is stationary, with foot brake depressed
sion, this can be verified by checking the des- and the engine running at idling speed.
ignation on the decal number (5) under the

120 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


03 Your driving environment

Gearboxes

Overheating during slow driving in queues can IMPORTANT For important information regarding Powershift
be avoided by driving in stages: Stop the car transmission and towing - see page 289.
and wait with your foot on the brake pedal until Use the foot brake to hold the car stationary
there is a moderate distance to the traffic on an uphill gradient - do not hold the car Text message and action
with the accelerator pedal. The gearbox In some situations the display may show a
ahead, drive forward a short distance, and then could then overheat.
wait another moment with your foot on the message at the same time as a symbol is illu-
brake pedal. minated. 03

Symbol Display Driving characteristics Action


Transm. overheat brake to hold Difficulty in maintaining even speed at con- Transmission overheated. Keep the car
stant engine speed. stationary using the foot brake.A

Transm. overheat park safely Significant pulling in the car's traction. Transmission overheated. Park the car
immediately in a safe manner.A

Transm. cooling let engine run No drive due to overheated gearbox. Transmission overheated. For fastest cool-
ing: Run the engine at idling speed with the
gear lever in the N or P position until the
message clears.
A For fastest cooling: run the engine at idling speed with the gear lever in the N or P position, until the message clears.

The table shows three steps with an increased NOTE WARNING


degree of seriousness should the transmission
become too hot. In parallel with the display text The table's examples are no indication that If a warning symbol combined with the text
the driver is also advised that the car's elec- the car is defective but instead show that a Transm. overheat park safely is ignored
safety function has been activated inten- then the heat in the gearbox may become
tronics are temporarily changing the driving tionally to prevent damage to one of the so high that the power transmission
characteristics. Follow the instructions on the car's components. between engine and gearbox is temporarily
information display where appropriate.

``

121
03 Your driving environment

Gearboxes

halted in order to prevent the clutch from


malfunctioning - the car then loses drive and
is stationary until gearbox temperature has
cooled to an acceptable level.

For more possible display messages with their


03 respective proposals for solutions concerning
automatic transmission, see page 142.
A display text clears automatically after the
action has been carried out or after one press
on the indicator stalk READ button.

122
03 Your driving environment

Eco Start/Stop DRIVe*

Quieter and cleaner General information on Start/Stop Function and operation

03

Environmental care is one of Volvo Car Corpo-


ration's core values and it influences all of our
operations. This target-orientation has resulted The engine is switched off - it becomes quieter and
in the DRIVe vehicle series whose concept cleaner.... Start/Stop On/Off.
consists of an interaction between several sep-
arate energy-saving functions, all with the Some combinations of engine and gearbox are Illuminates briefly on activation and for text
common purpose of reducing fuel consump- equipped with a Start and Stop function which messages.
tion, which in turn contributes to reduced engages in the event of e.g. stationary traffic or
waiting at traffic lights - the engine is then The engine is auto-stopped.
exhaust emissions.
switched off temporarily and restarts automat- Start/StopThe function is activated
ically when the journey is due to continue. automatically when the engine is
The Start/Stop function gives the driver the started with the key. The driver is alerted to the
opportunity for a more active environmentally function by means of this symbol on the instru-
conscious way of driving the car by means of ment panel illuminating briefly, the display text
being able to allow the engine to stop auto- Auto Start-Stop ON is shown and the green
matically, whenever appropriate. lamp for the On/Off button illuminates.

Manual or Automatic
Note that there are differences in the
Start/Stop function depending on whether the
gearbox is manual or automatic.

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 123


03 Your driving environment

Eco Start/Stop DRIVe*

NOTE Conditions M/AA Auto-starting the engine


After starting with the key and each auto- Conditions M/AA
Declutch, set the gear lever in M
stop the car must first reach 5 km/h before
the automatic Start/Stop function is re-acti- neutral position and release the With the gear lever in neutral posi- M
vated - following which certain conditions clutch pedal - the engine is tion: Depress the clutch pedal -
must also be fulfilled, refer to these under switched off. the engine starts. Engage a suit-
03 the heading "The engine does not auto- able gear and continue the jour-
stop". Stop the car with the foot brake A ney.
and then keep your foot on the
pedal - the engine stops automat- With the gear lever in neutral posi- M
All of the car's normal systems such as lighting,
ically. tion: Depress the accelerator
radio, etc. work as normal even with an engine
that has stopped automatically, except that A
pedal - the engine starts. Engage
M = Only manual gearbox, A = Only automatic gearbox and
some equipment may have the function tem- model D3. a suitable gear and continue the
porarily reduced, e.g. the climate control sys- journey.
The AUTO START symbol on
tem's fan speed or extremely high volume on The following option is also avail- M
the information display illumi-
the audio system. able on a downhill gradient:
nates as verification and
reminder that the engine is Release the foot brake and let the
Auto-stopping the engine
has stopped automatically. car move off - the engine starts
In order that the engine should stop automati-
automatically when the speed
cally the car must be completely stationary:
exceeds normal walking pace.

Release the foot pressure on the A


foot brake - the engine starts
automatically and the journey can
continue.
A M = Only manual gearbox, A = Only automatic gearbox and
model D3.

124 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


03 Your driving environment

Eco Start/Stop DRIVe*

Start assistance HSA An essential detail in connection with environ- The Start/Stop function is disengaged until it is
The foot brake can also be released on an uphill mental driving is to drive in the right gear and reactivated with the button or until the next
gradient to start the engine automatically - the change gear in time. time the engine is started with the key.
HSA function means that the car does not roll The driver is assisted by an indicator which
backwards. notifies the driver when it is most advanta- Limitations
HSA (Hill Start Assist) means that the pressure geous to engage the next higher or lower gear
in the brake system remains temporarily avail- - GSI (Gear Shift Indicator). The engine does not auto-stop 03
able while the driver moves his/her foot from Even if the Start/Stop function is activated, the
Indication is made with an up or down arrow in engine does not stop automatically if:
the brake pedal to the accelerator pedal for the combined instrument panel's right-hand
driving off with the engine having stopped display.
automatically. The temporary braking effect
Conditions M/AA
releases after a couple of seconds or when the Deactivating the Start/Stop function the driver has opened the seat- A
driver accelerates. In certain situations, it may belt's buckle.
There is more information available on HSA on advisable to temporarily
switch off the automatic the car does not stop completely.
page 120.
Start/Stop function - this is
the capacity of the battery is
Gear indicator1 carried out by pressing this
below the minimum permissible
button once, at which point
level.
the button's lamp goes out.
Disengaged Start/Stop func- the engine does not have normal
tion is indicated by the infor- operating temperature.
mation display's symbol
outside temperature is below
going out and the message
freezing point or above
Auto Start-Stop OFF being approx. 30 °C.
displayed for
about 5 seconds - while the
button's lamp goes out at the
same time.

1 Only manual gearbox for the DRIVe model.


``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 125


03 Your driving environment

Eco Start/Stop DRIVe*

Conditions M/AA Conditions M/AA Conditions M/AA


the environment in the passenger if the road is very steep. A The environment in the passen-
compartment differs from the ger compartment deviates from
preset values - indicated by the the atmospheric air pressure is A the preset values.
ventilation fan running at a high less than equivalent to
03 speed. approx. 1500 metres above sea level The outside temperature falls
- the current air pressure varies below freezing point or exceeds
the car is reversed. with the prevailing weather con- approx. 30 °C.
ditions.
battery temperature is below There is a temporarily high cur-
A M = Only manual gearbox, A = Only automatic gearbox and
freezing point or above rent take-off or battery capacity
model D3.
approx. 55 °C. drops below the lowest permissi-
The engine auto-starts without driver ble level.
the driver makes sudden steering
intervention
wheel movements. Repeated pumping of the brake
An engine that has stopped automatically may
pedal.
the exhaust system's particulate restart in some cases without the driver having
filter is full - the temporarily dis- decided that the journey should continue. In The car starts to roll - faster than M
engaged Start/Stop function is the following cases the engine also starts auto- the equivalent normal walking
reactivated once an automatic matically if the driver has not depressed the pace.
cleaning cycle has been per- clutch pedal (manual gearbox) or takes his/her
formed (see page 276). foot off the brake pedal (automatic gearbox): The gear selector is moved from A
the D position to "+/-" or R.
Queue Assistant is activated - see A Conditions M/AA A M = Only manual gearbox, A = Only automatic gearbox and
also the section "Adaptive cruise model D3.
control" page 175. The driver's seatbelt buckle is
opened.

Misting forms on the windows.

126 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


03 Your driving environment

Eco Start/Stop DRIVe*

WARNING 1. Depress the clutch pedal again - the engine The MY CAR menu system in the car includes
starts automatically after the gear lever has instructions which explain parts of the DRIVe
Do not open the bonnet when the engine been set in neutral position. Prior to this the concept along with several possible settings
has stopped automatically - the engine may information display showed the text Put and options - see page 145.
suddenly start automatically. First switch off gear in neutral.
the engine as normal using the START/ Text message
STOP ENGINE button before opening the Trailer
bonnet. In combination with this indicator 03
• The Start/Stop function is deactivated if a lamp the Start/Stop function may dis-
trailer is electrically connected to the car's play text messages on the information display
The engine does not auto-start2 electrical system. for certain situations. For some of them there
In the following cases the engine does not is a recommended action that should be per-
auto-start after having auto-stopped: More information and settings
formed. The following table shows some
examples.
Conditions
A gear is engaged without declutching - a
display text prompts the driver to set the
gear lever in neutral position in order to ena-
ble automatic starting.

Involuntary engine stop2


In the event that a start-up fails and the engine
stops, proceed as follows:

2 Only manual gearbox.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 127


03 Your driving environment

Eco Start/Stop DRIVe*

Symbol Message Info/Action M/AA


Auto Start-Stop ON Illuminates for about 5 seconds after Start/Stop has been
activated.

Auto Start-Stop OFF Illuminates for about 5 seconds after Start/Stop has been
03 switched off.

Auto Start-Stop serv. required Start/Stop is not operational. A workshop should be contac-
ted - in which case an authorised Volvo workshop is recom-
mended.

Emission management Start/Stop is temporarily disengaged. The function is reacti-


vated after an automatic system check.

AUTO- Engine in Auto Start The engine is ready to start automatically - waiting for the A
STOP brake pedal to be released.

Select P or N to start Start/Stop has been deactivated - move the gear selector to A
N or P position and start the engine as normal with the
START/STOP ENGINE button.

Press Start button The engine will not start automatically - start the engine as A
normal with the START/STOP ENGINE button and the gear
selector in P or N.

AUTO- Engine in Auto Start The engine is ready to start automatically - waiting for the M
STOP brake or clutch pedal to be depressed.

Press Start button The engine will not start automatically - start the engine as M
normal with the START/STOP ENGINE button.

Depress clutch pedal to start The engine is ready to auto-start - waiting for the clutch pedal M
to be depressed.

128 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


03 Your driving environment

Eco Start/Stop DRIVe*

Symbol Message Info/Action M/AA


Depress the foot brake to start The engine is ready to auto-start - waiting for the brake pedal M
to be depressed.

Press brake and clutch to start The engine is ready to auto-start - waiting for the brake or M
clutch pedal to be depressed. 03
Put gear in neutral Gear is engaged without declutching - disengage and set the M
gear lever in neutral position.
A M = Only manual gearbox, A = Only automatic gearbox and model D3.

If a message does not go out following com-


pletion of the action then a workshop should
be contacted - an authorised Volvo workshop
is recommended.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 129


03 Your driving environment

All-wheel drive – AWD*

All Wheel Drive is always available

03

All Wheel Drive means that the car is driving all


four wheels at the same time.
The power is automatically distributed
between the front and rear wheels. An elec-
tronically controlled clutch system distributes
the power to the wheels that have the best grip
on the current road surface. This provides the
best traction and prevents wheel spin. Under
normal driving conditions, the majority of
power is transmitted to the front wheels.
All Wheel Drive improves driving safety in rain,
snow and icy conditions.

130 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


03 Your driving environment

Foot brake

General may be felt in the brake pedal when this is Cleaning the brake discs
The car is equipped with two brake circuits. If engaged and this is normal. Coatings of dirt and water on the brake discs
one brake circuit is damaged then this will A short test of the ABS system is made auto- may result in delayed brake function. This delay
mean that the brakes engage at a deeper level matically after the engine has been started is minimised by cleaning the brake linings.
and harder pressure on the pedal is needed to when the driver releases the brake pedal. A Manual cleaning is advisable with wet road sur-
produce the normal braking effect. further automatic test of the ABS system may faces, prior to long-stay parking and after the
be made when the car reaches 10 km/h. The car has been washed. Carry this out by braking 03
The driver's brake pedal pressure is assisted
by a brake servo. test may be experienced as pulses in the brake gently during a short period while en route.
pedal.
Emergency Brake Assistance
WARNING Emergency brake lights and automatic Emergency Brake Assistance EBA (Emergency
The brake servo only works when the engine hazard warning flashers Brake Assist) helps to increase brake force and
is running. Emergency brake lights are activated to alert so reduce braking distance. EBA detects the
vehicles behind about sudden braking. The driver's braking style and increases brake force
If the brake is used when the engine is switched function means that the brake light flashes as necessary. The brake force can be rein-
off then the pedal will feel stiff and more force instead of - as in normal braking - shining with forced up to the level when the ABS system is
must be used to brake the car. a constant glow. engaged. The EBA function is interrupted when
the pressure on the brake pedal is reduced.
In very hilly terrain or when driving with a heavy Emergency brake lights are activated at
load the brakes can be relieved by using engine speeds above 50 km/h if the ABS system is
braking. Engine braking is most efficiently used working and/or in the event of sudden braking. NOTE
if the same gear is used downhill as up. After the car's speed has been slowed below When EBA is activated the brake pedal low-
10 km/h the brake light returns from flashing to ers slightly more than usual, depress (hold)
For more general information on heavy loads the normal constant glow - while at the same the brake pedal as long as necessary. If the
on the car, see page 359. time the hazard warning flashers are activated, brake pedal is released then all braking
and they flash until the driver changes engine ceases.
Anti-lock braking system
The car is equipped with ABS (Anti-lock speed with the accelerator pedal or they are
Braking System) which prevents the wheels deactivated with their button, see page 91.
from locking during braking. This means the
ability to steer is maintained and it is easier to
swerve to avoid a hazard for example. Vibration

131
03 Your driving environment

Foot brake

Symbols in the combined instrument


panel
Symbol Specification
Constant glow – Check the
brake fluid level. If the level is
03 low, fill with brake fluid and
check for the cause of the brake
fluid loss.

Constant glow for 2 seconds


when the engine is started –
There was a fault in the brake
system's ABS function when
the engine was last running.

WARNING
If and illuminate at the same
time, there may be a fault in the brake sys-
tem.
If the level in the brake fluid reservoir is nor-
mal at this stage, drive carefully to the near-
est workshop and have the brake system
checked - an authorised Volvo workshop is
recommended.
If the brake fluid is under the MIN level in the
brake fluid reservoir, do not drive further
before topping up the brake fluid.
The reason for the loss of brake fluid must
be investigated.

132
03 Your driving environment

Parking brake

General Applying the parking brake the accelerator pedal is depressed the braking
is interrupted.

NOTE
In the event of emergency braking at speeds
above 10 km/h a signal sounds during the
braking procedure. 03

Parking on a hill
If the car is parked facing uphill:
• Turn the wheels away from the kerb.
If the car is parked facing downhill:
Parking brake control - apply.
Function • Turn the wheels towards the kerb.
1. Press the foot brake pedal down firmly.
A faint electric motor noise can be heard when
the electrical parking brake is being applied. 2. Press the control. WARNING
The noise can also be heard during the auto- > The combined instrument panel symbol Get into the habit of always applying the
matic function checking of the parking brake. starts flashing - once there is a parking brake when parking on a slope -
If the car is stationary when the parking brake constant glow it is applied. leaving the car in gear, or in P if it has auto-
matic transmission, is not sufficient to hold
is applied then it only acts on the rear wheels. 3. Release the foot brake pedal and make the car in all situation.
If it is applied when the car is moving then the sure that the car is at a standstill position.
normal foot brake is used, i.e. the brake acts
on all four wheels. Brake function changes over • When parking the vehicle, always engage
to the rear wheels when the car is almost sta- 1st gear (for manual gearbox) or put the
tionary. gear selector in position P (for automatic
gearbox).
Low battery voltage In an emergency the parking brake can be
If the battery voltage is too low then the parking applied when the vehicle is moving by depress-
brake can neither be released nor applied. ing the control. When the control is released or
Connect a donor battery if the battery voltage
is too low, see page 116.

133
03 Your driving environment

Parking brake

Disengaging the parking brake NOTE Releasing automatically


1. Put the seatbelt on.
The parking brake can also be released
manually by depressing the clutch pedal 2. Start the engine.
instead of the brake pedal. Volvo recom-
mends the use of the brake pedal. 3. Press the foot brake pedal down firmly.
4. Move the gear selector to position D or R
03 and depress the accelerator.
Releasing automatically
1. Start the engine. > The parking brake releases and the
combined instrument panel symbol
2. Engage 1st gear or reverse gear.
goes out.
3. Ease up the clutch and depress the accel-
erator.
NOTE
Parking brake control - release. > The parking brake releases and the
combined instrument panel symbol For safety reasons, the parking brake is only
Cars with manual gearbox released automatically if the engine is run-
goes out. ning and the driver is wearing a seatbelt. The
Releasing manually parking brake is released immediately on
1. Insert the remote control key in the ignition Cars with automatic gearbox cars with automatic gearbox when the
switch.1 Releasing manually accelerator pedal is depressed and the gear
selector is in position D or R.
2. Press the foot brake pedal down firmly. 1. Insert the remote control key in the ignition
switch1.
3. Pull the control. Heavy load uphill
2. Press the foot brake pedal down firmly.
> The parking brake releases and the A heavy load, such as a trailer, can cause the
combined instrument panel symbol 3. Pull the control. car to roll backward when the parking brake is
goes out. > The parking brake releases and the released automatically on a steep incline.
combined instrument panel symbol Avoid this by depressing the control while driv-
ing off. Release the control when the engine
goes out.
achieves traction.

1 For a car with the Keyless system: Press START/STOP ENGINE.

134
03 Your driving environment

Parking brake

Replacing the brake linings parking brake - an authorised Volvo workshop


The rear brake linings must be replaced at a is recommended.
workshop due to the design of the electric

Symbols and messages in the display


03
Symbol Message Meaning/Action
"Message" Read the message on the information display.

A flashing symbol indicates that the parking brake is applied.


If the symbol flashes in any other situation then this means that a fault has arisen. Read the message
on the information display.

Park brake not fully A fault is preventing the parking brake from being released - Try to apply and release the brake.
released If the fault persists after a few attempts: Visit a workshop - an authorised Volvo workshop is recom-
mended.
Note: A warning signal sounds if the journey is continued with this error message.

``

135
03 Your driving environment

Parking brake

Symbol Message Meaning/Action


Parking brake not applied A fault is preventing the parking brake from being applied - Try to release and apply the brake.
If the fault persists after a few attempts: Visit a workshop - an authorised Volvo workshop is recom-
mended.
03 The message is also illuminated on cars with manual gearbox when the car is driven at low speed
with the door open in order to alert the driver that the parking brake may have been unintentionally
disengaged.

Parking brake Service A fault has arisen - Try to apply and release the brake.
required If the fault persists after a few attempts: Visit a workshop - an authorised Volvo workshop is recom-
mended.

• If the car has to be parked before the fault


has been rectified then the wheels must be
turned as if parking on a hill and 1st gear
engaged (manual gearbox) or the gear
selector must be in position P (automatic
gearbox).

136
03 Your driving environment

HomeLinkŸ *

General NOTE WARNING


HomeLinkŸ is designed not to work if the car If HomeLinkŸ is used to operate a garage
is locked from the outside. door or gate, ensure that nobody is in the
vicinity of the door or gate while it is in
Save the original remote controls for future
motion.
programming (e.g. when switching to
another car). Do not use the HomeLinkŸ remote control 03
Delete the button programming when the for any garage door that does not have
car is to be sold. safety stop and safety reverse. The garage
door must react immediately when it
Metallic sun visors should not be used in detects that something is preventing its
cars fitted with HomeLinkŸ. This may have movement, and stop directly and reverse. A
an adverse effect on its function. garage door without these characteristics
could cause personal injury. For further
information - contact the supplier via the
HomeLinkŸ is a programmable remote control Operation Internet: www.homelink.com.
which can control up to three different devices When HomeLinkŸ is fully programmed it can be
(e.g. garage door, alarm system, outdoor light- used in place of the separate original remote
controls.
Programming for the first time
ing and indoor lighting etc.) and in doing so The first step erases the memory in
replace their remote controls. HomeLinkŸ is Depress the programmed button to activate HomeLinkŸ and must not be carried out when
supplied built into the left-hand sun visor. the garage door, alarm system etc. The indi- only one individual button is being reprogram-
cator lamp illuminates for the time that the but- med.
The HomeLinkŸ panel consists of three pro-
ton is kept depressed.
grammable buttons and one indicator lamp. 1. Depress the two outer buttons and do not
NOTE release until the indicator lamp starts to
flash after approx. 20 seconds. The flash-
If the ignition is not activated, HomeLinkŸ
will work for 30 minutes after the driver's ing indicates that HomeLinkŸ is set in
door has been opened. "learn mode" and is ready to be pro-
grammed.
The original remote controls can of course be 2. Position the original remote control
used in parallel with HomeLinkŸ. 5-30 cm from HomeLinkŸ. Monitor the indi-
cator lamp.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 137


03 Your driving environment

HomeLinkŸ *

The particular distance that is required ess is repeated for approx. 20 seconds Programming individual buttons
between the original remote control and and indicates that the device has a "roll- To reprogram an individual button, proceed in
HomeLinkŸ depends on the programming ing code". The garage door, gate or sim- accordance with the following:
of the device in question. Perhaps several ilar is not activated when the pro-
grammed HomeLinkŸ button is 1. Depress the required button on
attempts will be required at different dis-
depressed. Continue the programming HomeLinkŸ and do not release until step 3
tances. Maintain each position for approx.
in accordance with the following. has been completed.
03 15 seconds before trying a new one.
5. Locate the "programming button1" on the 2. When the indicator lamp on HomeLinkŸ
3. Depress the button for the original remote
control and the button to be programmed receiver for the garage door for example, starts to flash, after approx. 20 seconds,
normally located close to the antenna's position the original remote control
on HomeLinkŸ simultaneously. Do not
release the buttons until the indicator lamp bracket on the receiver. If you have diffi- 5-30 cm from HomeLinkŸ. Monitor the indi-
has changed over from slow to rapid flash- culty in finding the button - consult the cator lamp.
ing. The rapid flashing indicates successful supplier's manual, or contact the supplier The particular distance that is required
programming. via the Internet: www.homelink.com. between the original remote control and
4. Test the programming by depressing the 6. Depress and release the "programming HomeLink depends on the programming of
button". The button flashes for the device in question. Perhaps several
programmed button on HomeLinkŸ and
approx. 30 seconds and the next step must attempts will be required at different dis-
watching the indicator lamp:
be carried out within this period. tances. Maintain each position for approx.
• Constant glow: The indicator lamp illu- 15 seconds before trying a new one.
minates with a constant glow when the 7. Depress the programmed button on
button is kept depressed, this indicates HomeLinkŸ, while the "programming but- 3. Depress the button on the original remote
that the programming is complete. The ton" is still flashing, keep it depressed for control. The indicator lamp will start to
garage door, gate or similar should now approx. 3 seconds and then release. flash. When the flashing has changed over
be activated when the programmed Repeat the press/hold/release sequence from a slow to a rapid flashing - release
HomeLinkŸ button is depressed. up to 3 times to conclude the program- both buttons. The rapid flashing indicates
ming. successful programming.
• Glow not constant: The indicator lamp
flashes quickly for approx. 2 seconds 4. Test the programming by depressing the
and then changes over to a constant programmed button on HomeLink and
glow for approx. 3 seconds. This proc- watching the indicator lamp:

1 Button designation and colour vary depending on manufacturer.

138 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


03 Your driving environment

HomeLinkŸ *

• Constant glow: The indicator lamp illu- 7. Depress the programmed button on
minates with a constant glow when the HomeLinkŸ, while the "programming but-
button is kept depressed, this indicates ton" is still flashing, keep it depressed for
that the programming is complete. The approx. 3 seconds and then release.
garage door, gate or similar should now Repeat the press/hold/release sequence
be activated when the programmed up to 3 times to conclude the program-
HomeLinkŸ button is depressed. ming. 03
• Glow not constant: The indicator lamp
flashes quickly for approx. 2 seconds Erasing programming
and then changes over to a constant It is only possible to erase the programming for
glow for approx. 3 seconds. This proc- all the buttons on HomeLinkŸ, not for individual
ess is repeated for approx. 20 seconds buttons.
and indicates that the device has a "roll-
– Depress the two outer buttons and do not
ing code". The garage door, gate or sim-
release until the indicator lamp starts to
ilar is not activated when the pro-
flash after approx. 20 seconds.
grammed HomeLinkŸ button is
depressed. Continue the programming > HomeLinkŸ is now set in so-called
in accordance with the following. "learn mode" and is ready to be pro-
grammed once more, see page 137.
5. Locate the "programming button2" on the
receiver for the garage door for example,
normally located close to the antenna's
bracket on the receiver. If you have diffi-
culty in finding the button - consult the
supplier's manual, or contact the supplier
via the Internet: www.homelink.com.
6. Depress and release the "programming
button". The button flashes for approx. 30
seconds and the next step must be carried
out within this period.

2 Button designation and colour vary depending on manufacturer.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 139


Menus and messages........................................................................... 142
Menu source MY CAR.......................................................................... 144
Climate control...................................................................................... 152
Fuel-driven engine block heater
and passenger compartment heater*................................................... 162
Additional heater*.................................................................................. 165
Trip computer........................................................................................ 166
DSTC – Stability and traction control system....................................... 168
Adapting driving characteristics........................................................... 170
Cruise control*...................................................................................... 171
Speed limiter*........................................................................................ 173
Adaptive cruise control*........................................................................ 175
Distance Warning*................................................................................. 185
City Safety™......................................................................................... 188
Collision Warning with Auto Brake & Pedestrian Protection*............... 192
Driver Alert System – DAC*................................................................... 199
Driver Alert System - LDW*................................................................... 202
Park assist syst*.................................................................................... 205
Park assist camera*.............................................................................. 208
BLIS* – Blind Spot Information System................................................ 211
Comfort inside the passenger compartment........................................ 215

140 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


COMFORT AND DRIVING PLEASURE
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Menus and messages

Combined instrument panel be acknowledged with READ for the menus to Message
be shown.

Menu overview
Some of the following menu options require the
function and hardware to be installed in the car.
---- km to empty tank
--.- l/100km average
--.- l/100km instantaneous
04 --- km/h average speed
--- km/h current speed1
Information display and controls for menus. Engine oil level Wait...* Text message in the information display.
READ – access to message list and mes- When a warning, information or indicator sym-
Tyre pressure Calibration*
sage confirmation. bol illuminates, a corresponding message
Thumbwheel – browse between menu Park heat timer --:-- ---*2 appears on the information display. An error
options. Direct start Park heat ON*3 message is stored in a memory list until the
fault has been rectified.
RESET – reset the active function. Used in Additional heat auto ON*
certain cases to select/activate a function, Press READ to acknowledge and browse
see the explanation under each respective Lane Depart Warn * between the messages.
function. Driver Alert *
The menus shown on the information displays
in the combined instrument panel are con-
trolled with the left-hand stalk switch. The
menus shown depend on key position, see
page 80. If a message appears then this must

1 Only certain markets.


2 Programming is only possible when the engine is switched off.
3 Cannot be selected when the additional heater is operating.

142 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Menus and messages

NOTE Message Specification Message Specification


If a warning message appears while you are Time for regular Time for regular service Transmission Drive more smoothly or
using the trip computer, the message must
be read (press READ) before the previous maintenance - contact a workshopB. hot Reduce stop the car in a safe
activity can be resumed. The timing is deter- speed manner. Disengage the
mined by the number of gear and run the engine
kilometres driven, num- at idling speed until the
Message Specification ber of months since the message clearsC.
last service, engine run-
Stop safelyA Stop and switch off the ning time and oil grade. Transmission Critical fault. Stop the
engine. Serious risk of hot Stop safely car immediately in a
damage - consult a Maintenance If the service intervals safe manner and con- 04
workshopB. overdue are not followed then tact a workshopB.
the warranty does not
Stop engineA Stop and switch off the cover any damaged Temporarily A function has been
engine. Serious risk of parts - contact a work- OFFA temporarily switched
damage - consult a shopB. off and is reset auto-
workshopB. matically while driving
Transmission Contact a workshopB to or after starting again.
Service urgentA Contact a workshopB to oil Change nee- check the car as soon
check the car immedi- ded as possible. Low battery The audio system is
ately. Power save switched off to save
Transmission The gearbox cannot mode energy. Charge the bat-
Service Contact a workshopB to performance handle full capacity. tery.
requiredA check the car as soon low Drive carefully until the A Part of message, shown together with information on where
as possible. message clearsC. the problem has arisen.
B An authorised Volvo workshop is recommended.
See manualA Read the owner's man- If shown repeatedly - C For more messages concerning automatic transmission, see
page 121.
ual. contact a workshopB.
Book time for Time to book regular
maintenance service - contact a
workshopB.

143
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Menu source MY CAR

General information about MY CAR Operation Short and long presses also produce varying
Many of the car's features are handled results.
Centre console controls
in this menu source, e.g. setting the • Short EXIT presses go back one step in the
clock, door mirrors and locks. current menu structure.
Navigation in the menus is carried out using • One long EXIT press leads to the MY
buttons in the centre console or with the steer- CAR source menu.
ing wheel's right-hand keypad. • One long EXIT press while in the MY
Certain functions are standard, others are CAR source menu, leads out of MY CAR
optional - the range also varies depending on to the menu system's main menu (Parent
the market. view), from where all the car's functions/
04 menu sources can be accessed, see
page 224.

Centre console controls for menu navigation.


Press MY CAR to open the menus under
MY CAR.
Press OK MENU to select/tick in the high-
lighted menu option or to store the
selected function in the memory.
Turn the TUNE knob to scroll up/down
among the menu options.
EXIT

EXIT functions
Use EXIT to go back in the menu structure or
to undo the most recent selection. Depending
on the menu level the cursor is on, with a press
on EXIT, the cursor is moved different
"lengths".

144
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Menu source MY CAR

Steering wheel keypad* The following is an example of how a function MY CAR


can be accessed and adjusted using the steer- The following options are available in menu
ing wheel keypad: source MY CAR:
1. Press the centre console button MY CAR.
2. Scroll to the desired menu, e.g. Settings,
with the thumbwheel (1) and then press the
thumbwheel - a submenu opens.
3. Scroll to the desired menu, e.g. Car
settings and press the thumbwheel - a
submenu opens. 04

4. Scroll to Lock settings and press the


The keypad may vary depending on market. thumbwheel - a new submenu opens.
Turn the thumbwheel to scroll up/down 5. Scroll to Doors unlock and press the
among the menu options. thumbwheel - a submenu of selectable
Press the thumbwheel to select/tick in the functions opens. • My V60
highlighted menu option or to store the • DRIVe*
6. Choose between the options All doors
selected function in the memory. • Support systems (Support systems)
and Driver door, then all and press the
EXIT (see heading "EXIT functions" page thumbwheel - a cross is marked in the • Settings (Settings)
144). option's empty box.
Search paths 7. Exit the programming by backing out of the
Current menu level is shown at the top right of menus incrementally with short presses on
the centre console display screen. Search EXIT (2) or with one long press.
paths to the menu system functions are descri- The procedure is the same as with the centre
bed in this manual in the following form: console's buttons - see page 144: OK MENU
Settings Car settings Lock settings (2), EXIT (4) and the TUNE knob (3).
Doors unlock Driver door, then all.

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 145


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Menu source MY CAR

My V60 Driver support system Off: Empty square.


• Select On/Off with OK - then back out of
the menu with EXIT.
Car settings

Car key memory p. 83


and
On
102
Off
04
Lock settings p. 48,
57 and
Doors automatic lock
61
MY CAR My V60 MY CAR Support systems On
The display screen shows a grouping of all of (MY CAR > Support systems) Off
the car's driver support systems - these can be
The display screen shows a summary of the Doors unlock
activated or deactivated here.
current status of the car's driver support sys-
tems. All doors
My DRIVe*
Parts of Volvo's DRIVe concept are described Driver door, then
Setup - menus all
here, amongst other things.
Shown here are the 4 first menu levels under
• Start/Stop MY CAR Settings. Some menus have fur- Keyless entry
• ECO driving guide ther submenus - these are then described in All doors
For more information - see page 123. detail in their respective sections.
Any door
When selecting whether a function should be
Doors on same
activated/On or deactivated/Off a square is
side
displayed:
Both front doors
On: Selected square.

146 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Menu source MY CAR

Reduced Guard p. 62 p. 93 p. 88
Home safe light duration Auxiliary lights
and 66
Activate once
30 sec On
Ask on exit
60 sec Off

Side mirror settings p. 102 90 sec


Tyre pressure system* p. 303
Fold mirrors p. 91 Warns if tyre pressure is
Triple turn signal
Tilt left mirror too low
On
Tilt right mirror Calibrate tyre pressure
Off 04
Light settings p. 46 Steering wheel force p. 170
p. 93
Lock confirmation light Temporary LH traffic Low
On On Medium
Off Off High
Unlock confirmation light or
Reset car settings
On Temporary RH traffic
All menus in Car settings are
Off On given original factory settings.
Off Driving support systems
p. 48
Approach light duration
and 93
Off p. 89
Active bending lights
30 sec On
60 sec Off
90 sec

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 147


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Menu source MY CAR

Collision Warning p. 192 DSTC p. 168 Time format p. 78


Collision Warning On 12h
On Off 24h
Off
City Safety p. 9 Screen saver p. 144
Warning distance and
On On
Long 188
Off Off
Normal
The TV screen's current content
04 Short BLIS p. 211 fades out after a period of inac-
Warning sound On tivity and is replaced by a blank
screen if this option is selected.
On Off
The current screen content
Off returns if any of the TV screen's
Distance Alert p. 185
buttons or controls are actuated.
Lane Departure Warning p. 202 On
Language
Lane Departure Warning Off
Selects language for menu texts.
On
Driver Alert p. 199
Off Show help text
On
On at start up On
Off
On Off

Off System options Explanatory text for the display


screen's current content is shown
Increased sensitivity with this option selected.
Time p. 78
On
The instrument panel clock is set
Off here.

148
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Menu source MY CAR

Distance and fuel unit p. 166 Voice tutorial Voice command list
MPG (UK) This menu option + OK provides Phone commands
spoken information about how
MPG (US) Phone
the system works.
km/l Phone call con-
tact
l/100km
Phone dial num-
Temperature unit ber
Celsius Navigation commands
04
Fahrenheit Navigation
Selects the unit for the display of Navigation
outside temperature and setting repeat instruc-
of the climate control system. tion
Navigation go to
Volumes
address
Voice output volume
General commands
Park assist front volume
Help
Park assist rear volume
Cancel
Phone ringing volume
Voice tutorial
Reset system options The menu options under Phone
commands show several exam-
All menus in System options are
ples of available voice commands
given original factory settings.
- only with a BluetoothŸ-enabled
Voice settings mobile phone installed. For more

``

149
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Menu source MY CAR

and detailed information - see Voice training Voice POI list


page 251.
User 1 Edit list
The menu options under Naviga-
tion commands show several User 2 The number of facilities is exten-
examples of available voice com- sive and varies depending on
With Voice training the voice
mands - only with Volvo's navi- market. Maximum 30 favourite
recognition system is taught to
gation system RTI* installed. facilities can be stored in this list.
recognise the driver's voice and
pronunciation. A number of phra- Menu option Voice POI list is
Voice user setting
ses are presented on the screen only shown if Volvo's navigation
Default setting for the driver to read aloud. When system RTI* is installed. For more
04 the system has learnt how the information on Facilities and
User 1
driver talks, the presentation of Voice recognition - see the Navi-
User 2 the phrases stops. Following gation system's owner's manual.
Here there is the option to create which e.g. User 1 can be
selected in Voice user setting in Audio settings p. 220
a second user profile - an advant-
age if more than one person shall order that the system shall listen
to the right user. Climate settings
use the car/system regularly.
Default setting gives factory set-
Voice output volume
tings.
• A volume control appears on
the screen - at which point,
proceed as follows:
1. Adjust the volume with the
thumbwheel.
2. Test-listen using OK.
3. Use EXIT to store the setting
and the menu is switched off.

150 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Menu source MY CAR

Automatic blower adjust p. 152 Number of keys p. 46


Normal
VIN number p. 352
High
Low DivX® VOD code p. 239
Recirculation timer
Bluetooth software version in p. 245
On car
Off
Map and software version*
Automatic rear defroster 04
Only in cars with Volvo GPS nav-
On
igator - see separate manual.
Off
Interior air quality system
On
Off
Reset climate settings
All menus in Climate settings
are given original factory settings.

Favourites (FAV) p. 226

Volvo On Call
Described in a separate manual.

Information

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 151


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Climate control

General Sensor location Temporary shut-off of the air


• The sun sensor1 is located on the top side conditioning
Climate control of the dashboard. When the engine requires full power, e.g. for full
The car is equipped with electronic climate acceleration or driving uphill with a trailer, the
control. The climate control system cools or • The temperature sensor for the passenger
compartment is located below the climate air conditioning can be temporarily switched
heats as well as dehumidifies the air in the pas- off. There may then be a temporary increase in
control panel.
senger compartment. temperature in the passenger compartment.
• The outside temperature sensor is located
on the door mirror.
NOTE Condensation
• The humidity sensor* is located by the inte- In warm weather, condensation from the air
The air conditioning system (AC) can be rior rearview mirror.
switched off, but to ensure the best possible conditioning may drip under the car. This is
04 normal.
climate comfort in the passenger compart-
ment and to prevent the windows from mist- NOTE
ing, it should always be on. Ice and snow
Do not cover or block the sensors with
Remove ice and snow from the climate control
clothing or other objects.
system air intake (the grille between the bonnet
Actual temperature and the windscreen).
The temperature you select corresponds to the Side windows and sunroof*
physical experience with reference to factors To ensure that the air conditioning works opti- Fault tracing and repair
such as air speed, humidity and solar radiation mally, the side windows, and sunroof* if speci- Engage a workshop that has authorisation for
etc. in and around the car. fied, should be closed. the fault tracing and repair of the climate con-
The system includes a sun sensor1 which trol system. Volvo recommends that you con-
Misting windows tact an authorised Volvo workshop.
detects on which side the sun is shining into
Remove misting on the insides of the windows
the passenger compartment. This means that Refrigerant
by primarily using the defroster function.
the temperature can differ between the right The air conditioning system contains a refrig-
and left-hand air vents despite the controls To reduce the risk of misting, keep the win-
erant. This refrigerant contains no chlorine,
being set for the same temperature on both dows clean and use window cleaner.
which means that it is harmless to the ozone
sides. layer. Engage a workshop that has authorisa-
tion for filling/changing refrigerant to carry out

1 Only applies to ECC.

152 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Climate control

the work. Volvo recommends that you contact the remote control key. The fan fills the and easy to remove and clean. Use cleaning
an authorised Volvo workshop. passenger compartment with fresh air. The agents and car care products recommended
function starts when required and is dis- by Volvo, see page 346.
Total airing function engaged automatically after a time or when
The function opens/closes all side windows one of the passenger compartment doors Menu settings
simultaneously and can be used for example to is opened. The amount of time the fan runs It is possible to activate/deactivate or change
quickly air the car during hot weather, see is reduced gradually due to reduced need the default settings for four of the climate con-
page 60. up until the car is 4 years old. trol system's functions via the centre console.
• The air quality system IAQS is a fully auto- For general information about menu naviga-
Passenger compartment filter matic system that cleans the air in the pas- tion, see page 145:
All air entering the car's passenger compart- senger compartment from contaminants
ment is cleaned with a filter. This must be • Fan speed in automatic mode*, see 04
such as particles, hydrocarbons, nitrous page 158.
replaced at regular intervals. Follow the Volvo oxides and ground-level ozone.
Service Programme for the recommended • Recirculation timer for passenger com-
replacement intervals. If the car is used in a partment air, see page 159.
NOTE
severely contaminated environment, it may be • Automatic rear window defrosting, see
necessary to replace the filter more often. To keep the CZIP standard in cars with CZIP page 103.
the IAQS filter must be changed after
15 000 km or once per year depending on • Air quality system IAQS*, see page 159
NOTE whichever occurs first. However, up to The climate control system's functions can be
There are different types of passenger com- 75 000 km over 5 years. In cars without CZIP reset to the default settings via the menu sys-
partment filter. Make sure that the correct and where the customer does not want to tem in MY CAR and this is carried out under:
filter is fitted. keep the CZIP standard the IAQS filter must
be changed at a regular service. Settings Climate settings Reset
climate settings.
Clean Zone Interior Package (CZIP)*
This option keeps the passenger compartment Use of tested materials in the interior
clear of allergy and asthma inducing sub- equipment.
stances. For more information on CZIP, see the The materials have been developed in order to
brochure included with the purchase of the car. minimise the quantity of dust in the passenger
compartment and they contribute to making
The following is included: the passenger compartment easier to keep
• An enhanced fan function that means that clean. The carpets in both the passenger com-
the fan starts when the car is opened with partment and the cargo area are removable

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 153


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Climate control

Air distribution Air vents in the dashboard Air vents in the door pillars

04

The incoming air is divided between a number Open Closed


of different vents in the passenger compart- Closed Open
ment.
Lateral airflow Lateral airflow
Air distribution is fully automatic in AUTO
mode*. Vertical airflow Vertical airflow
If necessary it can be controlled manually, see Aim the outer vents at the side windows to Aim the vents at the windows to remove mist-
page 161. remove misting. ing in cold weather.
Aim the vents into the passenger compartment
to maintain a comfortable climate in the rear
seat in hot weather.

NOTE
Remember that small children may be sen-
sitive to air flows and draughts.

154 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Climate control

Electronic climate control, ECC*

04

Temperature control, left-hand side Air distribution - air vent instrument panel Temperature control, right-hand side
Electrically heated front seat, left-hand Air distribution - defroster windscreen Recirculation
side
Rear window and door mirror defrosters, AUTO
Max. defroster see page 103
AC – – Air conditioning on/off
Fan Electrically heated front seat, right-hand
side
Air distribution - ventilation floor

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 155


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Climate control

Electronic Temperature Control, ETC

04

Fan Recirculation
Electrically heated front seat, left-hand Electrically heated front seat, right-hand
side side
AC – – Air conditioning on/off Temperature control
Max. defroster
Air distribution - ventilation floor
Air distribution - air vent instrument panel
Air distribution - defroster windscreen
Rear window and door mirror defrosters,
see page 103

156
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Climate control

Operating the controls Press the button three times for the lowest heat Press the button once for the highest heat level
level – one orange lamp illuminates in the TV – three lamps illuminate.
Heated seats* screen.
Press the button twice for a lower heat level –
Front seats Press the button four times to switch off the two lamps illuminate.
heat – no lamps illuminate.
Press the button three times for the lowest heat
level – one lamp illuminates.
WARNING
Press the button four times to switch off the
The heated seat should not be used by peo- heat – no lamps illuminate.
ple who find it difficult to perceive tempera-
ture increase because of sensory loss or for Fan
any reason have difficulty in managing to 04
use the control of the heated seat. Other-
wise, burn injuries may arise. NOTE
If the fan is fully switched off then the air
Rear seat2 conditioning is not engaged - which can
cause a risk of misting on the windows.
Current heat level is shown in the centre console
TV screen.
Fan knob for ECC*
One press on the button gives Turn the knob to increase or
the highest heat level - three decrease fan speed. If AUTO
orange lamps illuminate in the is selected then fan speed is
centre console TV screen (see regulated automatically. The
figure above). previously set fan speed is
Press the button twice for a disengaged.
lower heat level – two orange lamps illuminate
in the TV screen.

2 Not included if 2-stage booster cushion is selected.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 157


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Climate control

Fan knob for ETC figure shows the air distribution that is when AUTO is pressed. The TV screen shows
Turn the knob to increase or selected. For more information on air distribu- AUTO CLIMATE.
decrease fan speed. tion, see page 161.
Fan speed in automatic mode can be set in the
menu system MY CAR under: Settings
Climate settings Automatic blower
adjust. Choose between Low, Normal or
High:
Air distribution
• Low - Automatic fan control. Low airflow
is prioritised.
04 • Normal - Automatic fan control.
• High - Automatic fan control. A more
intense airflow is prioritised.
For a description of the menu system, see
The selected air distribution is shown in the centre page 145.
console TV screen.
Temperature control
AUTO1 The temperature can be
The Auto function automati- adjusted with the knob. For
cally regulates temperature, ECC* the temperature for the
air conditioning, fan speed, driver's side and the passen-
Air distribution - defroster windscreen
recirculation, and air distribu- ger side can be set sepa-
Air distribution - air vent instrument panel tion. rately.

Air distribution - ventilation floor When the car is started, the most recent setting
If you select one or more manual functions, the is resumed.
The figure consists of three buttons. When
other functions continue to be controlled auto-
pressing the buttons the corresponding figure
matically. All manual settings are disengaged
is illuminated in the TV screen (see figure
below) and an arrow in front of each part of the

1 Only applies to ECC.

158 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Climate control

NOTE The following also takes place in order to pro- IMPORTANT


vide maximum dehumidification in the passen-
Heating or cooling cannot be hastened by ger compartment: If the air in the car recirculates for too long,
selecting a higher/lower temperature than there is a risk of misting on the insides of the
the actual temperature required. • the air conditioning is automatically windows.
engaged
AC – Air conditioning on/off • recirculation and the air quality system are Timer
When the lamp in the AC but- automatically disengaged. With the timer function activated the system
ton illuminates, the air condi- will exit manually activated recirculation mode
tioning is controlled by the NOTE according to a time that depends on the out-
system's automatic function. The noise level increases as the fan is oper- side temperature. This reduces the risk of ice,
This way, incoming air is misting and bad air. Activate/deactivate the 04
ating at max.
cooled and dehumidified. function in the menu system MY CAR under
When the lamp in the AC button is switched off When the defroster is switched off the climate Settings Climate settings
the air conditioning is disconnected. Other control returns to the previous settings. Recirculation timer. For a description of the
functions are still controlled automatically. menu system, see page 145.
When the max. defroster function is activated Recirculation
the air conditioning is switched on automati- Recirculation NOTE
cally, so that the air is dehumidified at the maxi- When recirculation is When max. defroster is selected, recircula-
mum setting. engaged the orange lamp in tion is always deactivated.
the button illuminates. The
Max. defroster function is selected to shut
Used to quickly remove mist- Air quality system IAQS*
out bad air, exhaust gases
ing and ice from the wind- The air quality system separates gases and
etc. from the passenger com-
screen and side windows. Air particles to reduce the levels of odours and
partment. The air in the pas-
flowing to the windows. The pollution in the passenger compartment. If the
senger compartment is recirculated, i.e. no
light in the defroster button outside air is contaminated then the air intake
outside air is taken into the car when this func-
illuminates when the function is closed and the air is recirculated.
tion is activated.
is active. Activate/deactivate the function in the menu
system MY CAR under Settings Climate

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 159


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Climate control

settings Interior air quality system. For a Cars with Eco Start/Stop DRIVe*
description of the menu system, see With an auto-stopped engine certain equip-
page 145. ment has its function temporarily reduced, e.g.
climate control fan speed. For more informa-
NOTE tion, see page 123.

The air quality sensor should always be


engaged in order to obtain the best air in the
passenger compartment.
Recirculation is limited in cold weather to
avoid misting.
04
If the insides of the windows start misting
up, disengage the air quality sensor, and the
defroster functions for the windscreen, the
side and the rear windows should also be
used to demist the windows.

160 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Climate control

Air distribution table


Air distribution Use Air distribution Use
Air to windows. Some air to remove ice and misting Air to the floor and win- to ensure comfortable
flows from the air vents. quickly. dows. Some air flows conditions and good
The air is not recirculated. from the dashboard air demisting in cold or
Air conditioning is always vents. humid weather.
engaged.

Air to windscreen, via to prevent misting and Air to floor and from in sunny weather with
defroster vent, and side icing in a cold and humid dashboard air vents. cool outside tempera- 04
windows. Some air flows climate, (not at too low tures.
from the air vents. fan speed to enable this).

Airflow to windows and to ensure good comfort in Air to floor. Some air to direct heat or cold to
from dashboard air vents. warm, dry weather. flows to the dashboard the floor.
air vents and windows.

Airflow to the head and to ensure efficient cooling Airflow to windows, to provide cooler air
chest from the dashboard in warm weather. from dashboard air along the floor or warmer
air vents. vents and to the floor. air higher up in cold
weather or hot, dry
weather.

161
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Fuel-driven engine block heater and passenger compartment heater*

Fuel-driven heater Refuelling Battery and fuel


If the battery has insufficient charge or the fuel
General information about the parking level is too low, the parking heater will be
heater switched off automatically and a message
The parking heater heats the engine and pas- appears on the information display. Acknowl-
senger compartment and can be started edge the message by pressing the indicator
directly or with the timer. stalk READ button once, see page 163.
Two different times can be selected using the
timer. Here, time refers to the time when the car IMPORTANT
is heated and ready. The car's electronic sys- Repeated use of the parking heater com-
04 tem calculates when heating should be started bined with short journeys may discharge the
based on the outside temperature. battery and impair starting.
The heater cannot start if the outside tempera- Warning label on fuel filler flap. The car should be driven for the same time
ture exceeds 15 °C. At –5 °C or lower the as the heater is used to ensure that the car's
maximum running time of the parking heater is battery is recharged adequately to replace
WARNING the energy consumed by the heater when it
50 minutes.
Fuel which spills out can be ignited. Switch is used on a regular basis.
WARNING off the fuel-driven heater before starting to
refuel.
The car must be outdoors when the parking
Check the information display to see that
heater is used.
the parking heater is switched off. When it
is running, the information display shows
NOTE Park heat ON.

When the parking heater is active there may


be smoke from the right-hand wheel hous- Parking on a hill
ing, which is perfectly normal. If the car is parked on a steep hill, the front of
the car should point downhill to ensure that
there is a supply of fuel to the parking heater.

162 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Fuel-driven engine block heater and passenger compartment heater*

Operation NOTE Sym- Display Specification


bol
Heater The heater has

G025102
- Figure 2 in the symbol means the been stopped by
stopped
second climate control system in the car,

G025102
Low bat- the car's electron-
where the normal climate control system is
the first. The figure 2 has nothing to do with tery ics in order to facil-
TIMER 1 or TIMER 2. itate starting the
engine.

Sym- Display Specification Heater Setting the heater


unavail. is not possible due 04
bol

G025102
Low fuel to fuel level being
Fuel The heater is level too low
READ button heater switched on and (approx. 7 litres) -

G025102
ON running. this is in order to
Thumbwheel
facilitate starting
RESET - resets/selects Timer is The heater's timer the engine as well
set for is activated after as approx. 50 km
For more information on the information dis-
G025102

Fuel the remote control driving.


play and READ, see page 142. heater key has been
removed from the Park Heater not work-
Symbols and display messages ignition switch and heater ing. Contact a

G025102
leaving the car - Service workshop for
When one of the timer's settings or
the engine and required repair. Volvo rec-
Direct start is activated, the infor-
passenger com- ommends that you
mation symbol in the combined instrument
partment are contact an author-
panel illuminates while the information display
heated at the set ised Volvo work-
shows an explanatory text and a further illumi-
time. shop.
nated symbol. The table shows symbols and
display texts that appear.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 163


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Fuel-driven engine block heater and passenger compartment heater*

A display text clears automatically after a time Setting the timer Set the alternative time in the same way as
or after one press on the indicator stalk The time when the car shall be used and heated Park heat timer 1.
READ button. is specified with the timer.
Deactivating a timer-started heater
Select between TIMER 1 and TIMER 2. A timer-started heater can be switched off
Direct start and immediate stop manually before the set time has elapsed. Pro-
1. Scroll with the thumbwheel to Direct start NOTE ceed as follows:
Park heat.
The timer can only be programmed when 1. Press READ.
2. Press RESET to select between ON and the remote control key is in key position I,
see page 80 - programming must therefore 2. Use the thumbwheel to scroll to the text
OFF.
be carried out before starting the engine. Park heat timer 1 or 2.
04 ON: Parking heater switched on manually or > The text ON flashes on the display.
with programmed timer.
1. Scroll with the thumbwheel to Park heat 3. Press RESET.
OFF: Parking heater switched off. timer 1. > The text OFF is shown with a constant
Following the direct start of the heater it will be 2. Briefly press RESET to move to the flash- glow and the heater is switched OFF.
activated for 50 minutes. ing hours setting. A timer-started heater can be switched off in
Heating of the passenger compartment will 3. Select the required hour using the thumb- accordance with the instructions in the section
begin as soon as the engine coolant has wheel. "Direct start and immediate stop", see
reached the correct temperature. page 164.
4. Briefly press RESET to move to the flash-
ing minutes setting. Clock/timer
NOTE
5. Select the required minute using the The heater's time is connected to the car's
The car can be started and driven while the clock.
parking heater is running. thumbwheel.
6. Briefly press RESET to confirm the setting.
NOTE
7. Press RESET to activate the timer.
All timer programming will be cleared if the
After setting Park heat timer 1 a second start car's clock is reset.
time can be programmed with Park heat timer
2 by scrolling to it with the thumbwheel.

164 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Additional heater*

General information about the Passenger compartment heater*


additional heater If the additional heater is supplemented with
In cold climate zones1 an additional heater may timer function then it can be used as a fuel-
be required to obtain the correct operating driven passenger compartment heater, see
temperature in the engine and to obtain suffi- page 162.
cient heating in the passenger compartment.
Electric additional heater
Fuel-driven additional heater Cars with certain petrol engines2 have an elec-
A fuel-driven additional heater is fitted in cars tric additional heater integrated into the car's
with diesel engines. climate control system.
04
The heater starts automatically when extra In a semi-cold1 climate zone diesel-driven cars
heat is required when the engine is running. READ button have an electric additional heater instead of a
fuel-driven version.
The heater is switched off automatically when Thumbwheel
the correct temperature is reached or when the The heater cannot be controlled manually but
engine is switched off. RESET button is instead activated automatically after the
engine has been started in outside tempera-
1. Before starting the engine: Select key posi-
NOTE tures below 14 °C and is switched off after the
tion I, see page 80.
set passenger compartment temperature has
When the additional heater is active there 2. Scroll with the thumbwheel to Additional been reached.
may be smoke from the right-hand wheel heat auto.
housing which is perfectly normal.
3. Press RESET to select between ON and
OFF.
Auto mode or shutdown
The additional heater's automatic start
sequence can be switched off if required. NOTE
The menu options are only visible in key
position I - any adjustments must therefore
be made before starting the engine.

1 An authorised Volvo dealer has information regarding the geographical areas concerned.
2 An authorised Volvo dealer has information regarding the engines concerned.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 165


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Trip computer

General Functions NOTE


There may be a slight error in the reading if
NOTE a fuel-driven supplementary and/or parking
If a warning message appears when the trip heater* has been used.
computer is used then the message must
first be acknowledged before the trip com-
puter can be reactivated. Acknowledge the Km to empty tank
warning message by pressing READ. The calculation is based on the average fuel
consumption over the last 30 km and the
remaining driveable fuel quantity. The display
To change unit for distance and speed - go to shows the approximate distance that can be
04 MY CAR Settings System options driven with the fuel quantity remaining in the
Distance and fuel unit, see page 144. tank.
Information display and controls. Average speed An economic driving style generally results in a
READ - confirms. Average speed is calculated from the last longer driving distance. For more information
resetting. Reset using RESET. on how fuel consumption can be influenced,
Thumbwheel – browse between menus see page 11.
and options in the trip computer list. Instantaneous
No guaranteed range remains when the display
RESET – resets. Current fuel consumption is calculated every
shows "---- km to empty tank". Refuel as
second. The information on the display is
The trip computer's menu is in a variable loop. soon as possible.
updated every couple of seconds. When the
One of the menu options is a blank display - it car is stationary, "----" appears on the display.
also marks the beginning/end of the loop. NOTE
Average There may be a slight error in the reading if
Average fuel consumption is calculated from the driving style has been changed.
the last resetting. Reset using RESET.
Resetting
1. Select --- km/h average speed or --.- l/
100km average.

166 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Trip computer

2. Press and hold RESET for


approx. 1 second to reset the selected
function. If RESET is kept depressed for at
least 3 three seconds then Average speed
and Average are reset simultaneously.

Current speed*1
The instrument panel display changes to show
current speed in mph (miles per hour) if the
speedometer is graduated in km/h. If the
speedometer is graduated in mph then the dis-
play changes to km/h. 04

1 Only certain markets.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 167


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

DSTC – Stability and traction control system

General information on DSTC Involuntary wheel locking while driving can, However, the driver can select the Sport mode,
The stability and traction control system, DSTC amongst other things, impair the driver's ability which allows for a more active driving experi-
(Dynamic Stability & Traction Control) helps the to steer the car. ence. In Sport mode the system detects
driver to avoid skidding and improves the car's whether the accelerator pedal, steering wheel
Corner Traction Control – CTC movements and cornering are more active than
traction.
CTC compensates for understeer and allows in normal driving and then allows controlled
The activation of the system during braking higher than normal acceleration in a bend with- skidding with the rear section up to a certain
may be noticed as a throbbing sound. The car out wheelspin on the inner wheel, e.g. on an level before it intervenes and stabilises the car.
may accelerate slower than expected when the arcing motorway entrance road to quickly
accelerator pedal is depressed. reach the prevailing traffic speed. If the driver stops a controlled skid by releasing
the accelerator pedal then the DSTC system
04 Active Yaw Control Trailer Stability Assist* - TSA intervenes and stabilises the car.
The function limits the driving and brake force The function serves to stabilise the car and With Sport mode, maximum traction is
of the wheels individually in order to stabilise trailer combination if it begins to snake, see obtained if the car has become stuck, or when
the car. page 288. driving on a loose surface - e.g. sand or deep
Spin Control snow.
NOTE
The function prevents the driving wheels from Proceed as follows to select Sport mode:
spinning against the road surface during accel- The function is deactivated if the driver
selects Sport mode. 1. Press the centre console button MY CAR
eration.
and search in the display screen's menu
Traction control system system and locate My V60 DSTC. (For
The function is active at low speed and trans- Operation information on the menu system, see
fers power from the driving wheel that is spin- page 144).
ning to the one that is not. Selection of level - Sport mode
The DSTC system is always activated - it can- 2. Uncheck the box and back out of the menu
Engine drag control - EDC not be deactivated. system with EXIT.
EDC (Engine Drag Control) prevents involun- > The system then allows a more sporty
tary wheel locking, e.g. after shifting down or driving style.
engine braking when driving in low gears on The Sport mode is active until the driver dese-
slippery road surfaces. lects it or until the engine is switched off - after
the engine is started the next time the DSTC
system is back in its normal mode again.

168 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

DSTC – Stability and traction control system

Symbols and messages in the display


Symbol Message Specification
DSTC Temporarily OFF DSTC system temporarily reduced due to excessive brake disc temperature. - The function is reac-
tivated automatically when the brakes have cooled.

DSTC Service required DSTC system disengaged.


• Stop the car in a safe place, switch off the engine and start it again.
• Visit a workshop if the message remains - an authorised Volvo workshop is recommended.
"Message" There is a message on the speedometer's display - Read it! 04

and

Constant glow for System check when the engine is started.


2 seconds.

Flashing light. DSTC system is being activated.

Sport mode is activated.

169
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Adapting driving characteristics

Active chassis - Four-C* Operation Steering wheel force and select Low,
Active chassis, Four-C (Continously Controlled Medium or High.
Chassis Concept), regulates the characteris-
For a description of the menu system, see
tics of the shock absorbers so that the car's
page 144. This menu cannot be accessed
driving characteristics can be adjusted. There
while the car is in motion.
are three settings: Comfort, Sport and
Advanced.

Comfort
This setting means that the car is perceived as
being more comfortable on rough and uneven
04
road surfaces. Shock absorption is soft and the
movement of the body is smooth and gentle.
Chassis settings.
Sport
This setting means that the car is perceived as Use the buttons in the centre console to
being more sporty and is recommended for change setting. The setting in use when the
more active driving. Steering response is faster engine is switched off is activated next time the
than in the Comfort mode. Shock absorption is engine is started.
harder and the body follows the road in order
to reduce rolling during cornering. Speed related power steering*
Advanced Steering force increases with the speed of the
This setting is only recommended on very even car to give the driver enhanced sensitivity. The
and smooth road surfaces. steering is firmer and more immediate on
motorways. Steering is light and requires no
The shock absorbers are optimised for maxi- extra effort when parking and at low speed.
mum roadholding and rolling in bends is further
minimised. The driver can choose between three different
levels of steering force for road responsiveness
or steering sensitivity. Go to the menu system
MY CAR and locate Settings Car settings

170 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Cruise control*

Operation The cruise control is then activated with or Temporary deactivation - standby mode
, after which the current speed is stored in Press to temporarily disengage the cruise
the memory - the display text (---) km/h control and set it in standby mode - set speed
changes to show the selected speed, e.g. 100 is shown in brackets in the display (5), e.g.
km/h. (100) km/h.

Automatic standby mode


NOTE Cruise control is temporarily disengaged and
Cruise control cannot be engaged at set in standby mode if:
speeds below 30 km/h.
• wheels lose traction
• the foot brake is used 04
Changing the speed
In active mode the speed is adjusted with long • speed falls below approx. 30 km/h
Steering wheel keypad and display. or short presses on or - the last press is • the clutch pedal is depressed
Cruise control - On/Off. stored in the memory. • the gear selector is moved to neutral posi-
A temporary increase in speed with the accel- tion (automatic gearbox)
Standby mode ceases and the stored
speed is resumed. erator pedal, e.g. during overtaking, does not • the driver maintains a speed higher than
affect the cruise control setting - the car returns the set speed for longer than 1 minute.
Standby mode to the set speed when the accelerator pedal is The driver must then regulate the speed.
Activate and adjust the speed. released.
Resume set speed
Selected speed (in brackets = Standby NOTE Cruise control in standby mode is re-activated
mode). with one press on the steering wheel button
If any cruise control button is held
depressed for more than approx. 1 minute - the speed is then set to the last stored
Activating and setting the speed
then cruise control is disengaged. The speed.
Switch on the cruise control with one press on
engine must be switched off in order to reset
the steering wheel button - the symbol cruise control. NOTE
is illuminated in the display (5) and the brackets
around (---) km/h show that the cruise control A significant increase in speed may arise
is set in standby mode. after the speed has been resumed with .

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 171


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Cruise control*

Deactivate
The cruise control is switched off with the
steering wheel button or by switching off
the engine - the set speed is deleted from the
memory and cannot be resumed with the
button.

04

172 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Speed limiter*

General information on the speed Activate and adjust the maximum speed When stationary
limiter (each press gives +/-5 km/h). 1. Press the steering wheel button to
A speed limiter (Speed Limiter) can be regar- Stored maximum speed (in brackets = switch on the speed limiter.
ded as a reverse cruise control - the driver reg- Standby mode).
2. Scroll with the button until the instru-
ulates the speed using the accelerator pedal
but is prevented from accidentally exceeding a Switch on and activate ment panel display shows the desired
pre-selected/set speed by the speed limiter. When the speed limiter is maximum speed.
active the display will show its > The speed limiter is then active and the
symbol in combination with display (5) shows the maximum speed
Operation the set maximum speed. selected and the maximum speed
Selection and storage of the stored in the memory.
04
highest possible speed in the Temporary deactivation - standby mode
memory can be made both during a journey To temporarily deactivate the speed limiter and
and while stationary. set it in standby mode:
While driving – Press .
1. When the car is moving at the desired high-
est possible speed: Press the steering > The display shows the stored maximum
wheel button to switch on the speed speed in brackets (5) and the driver can
temporarily exceed the set maximum
limiter.
speed.
> The symbol for the speed limiter is illu-
minated on the instrument panel dis- The speed limiter is re-activated by one
Steering wheel keypad and display. press on at which the display's
play.
Speed limiter - On/Off. brackets disappear and the car's maxi-
2. Press one of the steering wheel buttons
Standby mode ceases and stored speed mum speed is again limited.
or until the instrument panel display
resumes - each extra press gives +1 km/h. shows the desired maximum speed. Temporary deactivation with the
Standby mode. > The speed limiter is then active and the accelerator pedal
display (5) shows the maximum speed The speed limiter can also be set in standby
selected and the maximum speed mode with the accelerator pedal, e.g. for rap-
stored in the memory. idly accelerating the car out of a situation:

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 173


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Speed limiter*

– Depress the accelerator pedal fully. – Press the steering wheel button .
> The display shows the stored maximum > The display's symbol for the speed lim-
speed in brackets (5) and the driver can iter and the set speed (5) are cleared.
temporarily exceed the set maximum The selected and stored speed are thus
speed. deleted from the memory and cannot be
The speed limiter is automatically re- resumed with the button.
activated after the release of the accel- The driver can then use the accelerator
erator pedal and the car's speed is pedal to choose a speed without limita-
slowed down to below the selected/ tion.
stored maximum speed - the display's
04 brackets disappear and the car's maxi-
mum speed is again limited.

Alarm for speed exceeded


On steep roads the engine braking effect may
be inadequate and the selected maximum
speed exceeded. The driver is alerted about
this with an acoustic signal.
The signal is active until the driver has slowed
to below the selected maximum speed.

NOTE
The alarm is only activated after 5 seconds
if the speed has been exceeded by at least
3 km/h provided that none of the buttons
or has been depressed during the last
half minute.

Deactivate
To deactivate the speed limiter:

174 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Adaptive cruise control*

General information on ACC WARNING Function


The adaptive cruise control (ACC – Adaptive
The driver must always be observant with
Cruise Control) helps the driver maintain a safe regard to the traffic conditions and intervene
distance from the vehicle ahead. The cruise when the adaptive cruise control is not
control provides a more relaxing driving expe- maintaining a suitable speed or suitable dis-
rience on long journeys on motorways and long tance.
straight main roads in smooth traffic flows. The adaptive cruise control cannot handle
The driver sets the desired speed and time all traffic, weather and road conditions.
interval to the car in front. When the radar Read the whole of this section for informa-
detector detects a slower vehicle in front of the tion on the limitations of the adaptive cruise
car, the speed is automatically adapted to that. control. The driver must be familiar with this 04
When the road is clear again the car returns to information before using the adaptive cruise
the selected speed. control.
The driver always bears responsibility for Function overview1.
If the adaptive cruise control is switched off or maintaining the correct distance and speed, Warning lamp, braking by driver required
set to the standby mode and the car comes too even when the adaptive cruise control is
close to a vehicle in front, then the driver is being used. Steering wheel keypad
warned by Distance Warning (see page 185)
about the short distance. Radar sensor
IMPORTANT Adaptive cruise control consists of a cruise
Maintenance of adaptive cruise control control system and a coordinated spacing sys-
components must only be performed at a tem.
workshop - an authorised Volvo workshop
is recommended.

Automatic gearbox
Cars with automatic gearbox have enhanced
functionality with the adaptive cruise control's
Queue Assistant, see page 179.

1 NOTE: The illustration is schematic - details may vary depending on car model.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 175


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Adaptive cruise control*

WARNING The adaptive cruise control aims to follow the If the car needs to be braked more heavily than
vehicle ahead in the same lane at a time interval cruise control capacity and the driver does not
Adaptive cruise control is not a collision set by the driver. If the radar sensor cannot see brake, then the cruise control uses the collision
avoidance system. The driver must inter- any vehicle in front then the car will instead warning system's warning lamp and warning
vene if the system does not detect a vehicle
in front. maintain the cruise control's set speed. This sound (see page 193) to alert the driver that
also happens if the speed of the vehicle in front immediate intervention is required.
The adaptive cruise control does not brake exceeds the cruise control's set speed.
for humans or animals, and not for small
vehicles such as bicycles and motorcycles. The cruise control aims to control the speed in NOTE
Nor for oncoming, slow or stationary vehi- a smooth way. In situations that demand sud- The warning lamp may be difficult to notice
cles and objects. den braking the driver must brake himself/her- in strong sunlight or when sunglasses are
04 Do not use the adaptive cruise control, for self. This applies with large differences in being worn.
example, in city traffic, in dense traffic, at speed, or if the vehicle in front brakes heavily.
junctions, on slippery surfaces, with a lot of Due to limitations in the radar sensor, braking
water or slush on the road, in heavy rain/ may come unexpectedly or not at all, see
WARNING
snow, in poor visibility, on winding roads or page 181. Cruise control only warns of vehicles
on slip roads. detected by the radar sensor. Consequently
The adaptive cruise control can be activated to there may be no warning or it may be sub-
follow another vehicle at speeds from ject to a delay. Do not wait for a warning but
The distance to the vehicle ahead is mainly
measured by a radar sensor. Cruise control 30 km/h2 up to 200 km/h. If the speed falls brake when it is necessary.
regulates the speed with acceleration and below 30 km/h or if the engine speed becomes
braking. It is normal for the brakes to emit a low too low, the cruise control is set in standby Steep roads and/or heavy load
sound when they are being used by cruise con- mode at which automatic braking ceases - the
Bear in mind that the adaptive cruise control is
trol. driver must then take over himself/herself to
primarily intended for use when driving on level
maintain a safe distance to the vehicle ahead.
road surfaces. The cruise control may have dif-
WARNING Warning lamp - braking by driver ficultly in keeping the correct distance from the
vehicle ahead when driving on steep roads,
The brake pedal moves when the cruise required
with a heavy load or with a trailer - in which
control brakes. Do not rest your foot under Adaptive cruise control has a braking capacity
the brake pedal as it could become trapped. case, be extra attentive and ready to slow
that is equivalent to more than 40% of the car's
down.
braking capacity.

2 Queue Assistant (in cars with automatic gearbox) can operate in the range of 0-200 km/h, see page 179.

176 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Adaptive cruise control*

Operation Time interval4 - On, during adjustment. Time interval6 - On, during adjustment.
Time interval4 - On, after adjustment. Time interval6 - On, after adjustment.

Activating and setting the speed


Switch on cruise control with one press on the
steering wheel button - the symbol is
illuminated in the display. The brackets (6) at
(---) mean that cruise control is set in standby
mode.
The cruise control is then activated with or 04
, after which the current speed is stored in
the memory - the display text (---) changes to
Steering wheel keypad3 and display.
show the selected speed, e.g. 100 without
Cruise control - On/Off. brackets.
Steering wheel keypad5 and display.
Standby mode ceases and stored speed Standby mode ceases and the stored When the symbol changes
resumes - each extra press gives +1 km/h. speed is resumed. to the radar sensor has
Standby mode Cruise control - On/Off or Standby mode. detected a vehicle.
Time interval - Increase/decrease. Time interval - Increase/decrease. Only when the symbol
(with car) is illuminated, is the
Activate and adjust the speed (each press Activate and adjust the speed. distance to the vehicle in front
gives +/-5 km/h).
Selected speed (in brackets = Standby regulated by the cruise control.
Selected speed (in brackets = Standby
mode).
mode).

3 Cars with Speed limiter.


4 The display shows either "dash" symbol [7] or [8] - they are never shown simultaneously.
5 Cars without Speed limiter. A Volvo dealer has updated information about what applies in each respective market.
6 The display shows either "dash" symbol [6] or [7] - they are never shown simultaneously.
``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 177


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Adaptive cruise control*

Changing the speed The time interval is increased or decreased NOTE


In active mode the speed is adjusted 5 km/h with the steering wheel keypad's thumbwheel
(or the buttons / for cars without Speed Only use the time interval that is allowed in
with each press on or . In active mode accordance with local traffic regulations.
the button has the same function as but limiter).
If cruise control does not seem to react to
results in a lower increase in speed. The last At low speed, when the distances are short, the activation the reason may be that the time
press is stored in the memory. adaptive cruise control increases the time interval to the closest vehicle prevents an
interval slightly. increase in speed.
NOTE The adaptive cruise control allows the time The higher the speed, the longer the calcu-
If any cruise control button is held interval to vary noticeably in certain situations lated distance in metres for a specific time
depressed for more than approx. 1 minute in order to allow the car to follow the vehicle in interval.
04 then cruise control is disengaged. The front smoothly and comfortably.
engine must be switched off in order to reset Temporary deactivation - standby mode
cruise control. Note that a short time interval only allows the
driver a short time to react and take action if Press the steering wheel button to tempo-
In certain situations, cruise control cannot rarily disengage the cruise control and set it in
be activated. Then the display shows any unforeseen traffic problem should arise.
standby mode - set speed is shown in brackets
Cruise control Unavailable, see The number of lines for the
page 183. in the display, e.g. (100).
selected time interval is
shown during the setting itself Keypad without Speed limiter*
Set time interval and for several seconds after- Press the steering wheel button to tempo-
Different time intervals to the wards. Then a smaller scale rarily disengage cruise control and set it in
vehicle in front can be version of the symbol is standby mode.
selected and shown in the shown to the right of the dis-
display as 1-5 horizontal lines play. The same symbol is also shown when Standby mode due to driver intervention
- the more lines the longer the Distance Warning is activated, see page 185. Cruise control is temporarily disengaged and
time distance. One line corre- set in standby mode if:
sponds to approximately • the foot brake is used
1 second, 5 lines approximately 2.5 seconds.
• the clutch pedal is depressed for longer
than 1 minute7

7 Disengaging and selecting a higher or lower gear does not involve standby mode.

178 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Adaptive cruise control*

• the gear selector is moved to N position • the radar sensor is covered e.g. by wet Queue Assistant
(automatic gearbox) snow or heavy rain (radar waves blocked). In cars with automatic gearbox the adaptive
• the driver maintains a speed higher than Resume set speed cruise control has the Queue Assistant function
the set speed for longer than 1 minute (sometimes also referred to as "Queue
Cruise control in standby mode is re-activated
The driver must then regulate the speed. Assist").
with one press on the steering wheel button
A temporary increase in speed with the accel- - the speed is then set to the last stored Queue Assistant has the following functions:
erator pedal, e.g. during overtaking, does not speed. • Extended speed range
affect the cruise control setting - the car returns
to the last stored speed when the accelerator
• Change of target
NOTE
pedal is released. • Automatic braking ceases when stationary
A significant increase in speed may arise 04
after the speed has been resumed with .
• Automatic activation parking brake.
Automatic standby mode
Note that the lowest programmable speed for
Adaptive cruise control is dependent on other
the cruise control is 30 km/h - even though the
systems e.g. stability and traction control Deactivate cruise control is capable of following another
(DSTC). If any of these systems stop working The cruise control is switched off with the vehicle down to a standstill, a lower speed
then cruise control is automatically deacti-
steering wheel button . The set speed is cannot be selected.
vated.
cleared and cannot be resumed with the
In the event of automatic deactivation a signal button.
Extended speed range
will sound and the message Cruise control
Cancelled is shown in the display. The driver Keypad without Speed limiter NOTE
must then intervene and adapt the speed and The cruise control is switched off with a short
In order to activate the cruise control the
distance to the vehicle ahead. press on the steering wheel button in
driver's door must be closed and the driver
standby mode - or with one long press in active must be wearing the seatbelt.
An automatic deactivation can be due to:
mode. The set speed is cleared and cannot be
• engine speed is too low/high resumed with the button.
• With the automatic gearbox the cruise con-
• speed falls below 30 km/h8 trol can follow another vehicle within the
• wheels lose traction range of 0-200 km/h - right down to sta-
tionary and up to 200 km/h.
• brake temperature is high

8 Does not apply to a car with Queue Assistant - it manages right down to stationary.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 179


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Adaptive cruise control*

NOTE Change of target Automatic standby mode with change of


target
Activation of the cruise control below
30 km/h requires a vehicle in front within a Cruise control is disengaged and set in
reasonable distance. standby mode:
• when the speed is below 15 km/h and
For shorter stops in connection with inching in cruise control is not sure whether the target
slow traffic or at traffic lights driving is auto- object is a stationary vehicle or some other
matically resumed if the stops do not exceed object, e.g. a speed bump.
about 3 seconds - if it takes longer before the • when the speed is below 15 km/h and the
car in front starts moving again then the cruise vehicle in front turns off so the cruise con-
04 If the target vehicle in front suddenly turns then
control is set in standby mode. The driver must there may be stationary traffic in front.
trol no longer has a vehicle to follow.
then re-activate the cruise control in one of the
following ways: When the cruise control is following another Automatic braking ceases when
vehicle at speeds below 30 km/h and changes stationary
• Press the steering wheel button . target from a moving to a stationary vehicle, the In certain situations the cruise control inter-
or cruise control will slow down for the stationary rupts braking when stationary. This means that
vehicle. the foot brake is released and the driver must
• Press the accelerator pedal and accelerate brake himself/herself.
up to at least about 4 km/h (normal walking
pace).
WARNING Cruise control releases the foot brake and is
The cruise control will then resume following When the cruise control is following another set in standby mode when:
vehicle at speeds in excess of 30 km/h and
the vehicle in front.
the target is changed from a moving vehicle • the driver puts his/her foot on the brake
to a stationary vehicle, the cruise control will pedal
NOTE ignore the stationary vehicle and instead • the parking brake is applied
select the stored speed.
The cruise control can hold the car station- • the gear selector is moved to P, N or R
ary for a maximum of 2 minutes - then the • The driver must intervene him/herself position
parking brake is applied and the cruise con- and brake.
trol is disengaged.
• the driver sets the cruise control in standby
mode.
• The driver has to release the parking
brake before the cruise control can be
reactivated.

180 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Adaptive cruise control*

Automatic activation parking brake WARNING WARNING


In some situations the cruise control applies
the parking brake in order to keep a stationary The driver must always be observant with Adaptive cruise control is not a collision
regard to the traffic conditions and intervene avoidance system. The driver must inter-
car remaining stationary. when the adaptive cruise control is not vene if the system does not detect a vehicle
This takes place if: maintaining a suitable speed or suitable dis- in front.
tance.
• the driver opens the door or takes off his/ The adaptive cruise control does not brake
her seatbelt The adaptive cruise control cannot handle for humans or animals, and not for small
all traffic, weather and road conditions. vehicles such as bicycles and motorcycles.
• DSTC is changed from Normal to Sport Nor for oncoming, slow or stationary vehi-
mode Read the whole of this section for informa-
cles and objects.
tion on the limitations of the adaptive cruise
• cruise control has held the car stationary control. The driver must be familiar with this Do not use the adaptive cruise control, for 04
for more than 2 minutes information before using the adaptive cruise example, in city traffic, in dense traffic, at
• the engine is switched off control. junctions, on slippery surfaces, with a lot of
water or slush on the road, in heavy rain/
• the brakes have overheated. The driver always bears responsibility for
snow, in poor visibility, on winding roads or
maintaining the correct distance and speed,
on slip roads.
even when the adaptive cruise control is
The radar sensor and its limitations being used.
Apart from the adaptive cruise control, the The capacity of the radar sensor to detect vehi-
radar sensor is also used by the Collision cles in front is reduced significantly:
WARNING
Warning with Auto Brake function (see • if the radar sensor becomes blocked and
page 192) and the Distance Warning function Accessories or other objects such as auxil- cannot detect other vehicles e.g. in heavy
(see page 185). The function of the radar sen- iary lamps must not be installed in front of
rain or slush, or if other objects have col-
sor is to detect cars or larger vehicles in the the grille.
lected in front of the radar sensor.
same direction, in the same lane.
Modification of the radar sensor could result in NOTE
it being illegal to use. Keep the surface in front of the radar sensor
clean.

• if the speed of vehicles in front is signifi-


cantly different from your own speed.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 181


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Adaptive cruise control*

Examples where the cruise control does Sometimes the radar sensor is late at
not work optimally detecting vehicles at close distances, e.g.
The radar sensor has a limited field of vision. In a vehicle that drives in between the car and
some situations another vehicle is not vehicles in front.
detected, or the detection is made later than Small vehicles, such as motorcycles, or
expected. vehicles not driving in the centre of the lane
can remain undetected.
In bends the radar sensor may detect the
wrong vehicle or lose a detected vehicle
from view.
04
Fault tracing and action
If the display shows the message Radar
blocked See manual this means that the
radar signals from the radar sensor are blocked
and that vehicles in front of the car could not
be detected.
In turn this means that the Adaptive Cruise
Control, Distance Warning and Collision Warn-
ing with Auto Brake functions are not operating
either.
The following table presents possible causes
for a message being shown along with the
appropriate action.

ACC field of vision.

182 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Adaptive cruise control*

Cause Action
The radar surface in the grille is dirty or covered with ice or snow. Clean the radar surface in the grille from dirt, ice and snow.

Heavy rain or snow blocking the radar signals. No action. Sometimes the radar does not work during heavy rain or
snowfall.

Water or snow from the road surface swirls up and blocks the radar sig- No action. Sometimes the radar does not work on a very wet or snowy
nals. road surface.

The radar surface has been cleaned but the message remains. Wait. It could take several minutes for the radar to sense that it is no
longer blocked.
04

Symbols and messages in the display


Symbol Message Specification
Standby mode or active mode without detected vehicle.

Active mode with detected vehicle to which cruise control adapts the speed.

Time interval activated, during adjustment.

Time interval activated, after adjustment.

DSTC Normal to enable Cruise control cannot be activated until the Stability and Traction Control system (DSTC) has been
Cruise set in Normal mode - see page 168.

Cruise control Cancelled The cruise control has been deactivated - the driver has to regulate the speed.

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 183


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Adaptive cruise control*

Symbol Message Specification


Cruise control Unavailable Cruise control cannot be activated.
This could be due to:
• brake temperature is high
• the radar sensor is blocked by e.g. wet snow or rain.
Radar blocked See manual Cruise control temporarily disengaged.
• The radar sensor is blocked and cannot detect other vehicles. For example, in the event that heavy
04 rain or if slush has collected in front of the radar sensor.
Read about the limitations of the radar sensor, see page 181.

Cruise control Service Cruise control disengaged.


required
• Contact a workshop - an authorised Volvo workshop is recommended.

Press Brake To hold + The car is stationary and the cruise control will release the foot brake to allow the parking brake to
acoustic alarm take over and hold the car, but a fault in the parking brake means the car will shortly begin to roll.
(Only with Queue Assistant) • The driver must brake himself/herself. The message remains and the alarm sounds until the driver
depresses the brake pedal or uses the accelerator pedal.

Below 30 km/h Only fol- Shown with attempts to activate the cruise control at speeds below 30 km/h without a vehicle in front
lowing within the activation distance (approx. 30 metres).
(Only with Queue Assistant)

184 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Distance Warning*

General NOTE Some combinations of the selected equipment


Distance Warning (Distance Alert) is a function leave no vacant space for a button in the centre
Distance warning is deactivated during the console - in which case the function is handled
that informs the driver about the time interval time the adaptive cruise control is active.
to vehicles in front. by the car's menu system MY CAR under
Settings Car settings Warning
Distance Warning is active at speeds above
WARNING distance. For a description of the menu sys-
30 km/h and only reacts to vehicles driving in
tem - see page 144.)
front of the car, in the same direction. No dis- Distance warning only reacts if the distance
tance information is provided for oncoming, to the vehicle ahead is shorter than the pre-
set value - the speed of the driver's vehicle
Set time interval
slow or stationary vehicles.
is not affected.
04
Operation

Controls and display for time interval.


Orange warning lamp1. Time interval - Increase/decrease. Press
An orange warning lamp in the windscreen illu- up to increase, down to decrease.
minates with a constant glow if the distance to Time interval2 - On (during adjustment).
the vehicle in front is shorter than the set time Press the button in the centre console to switch
interval. Time interval2 - On (after adjustment).
the function on or off. The function is switched
on if one lamp is illuminated in the button.

1 NOTE: The illustration is schematic - details may vary depending on car model.
2 The display shows either "dash" symbol [2] or [3] - they are never shown simultaneously.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 185


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Distance Warning*

Different time intervals to the NOTE ing system. For more information on the radar
vehicle in front can be sensor and its limitations, see page 181.
selected and shown in the The higher the speed, the longer the calcu-
display as 1-5 horizontal lines lated distance in metres for a specific time
interval. NOTE
- the more lines the longer the
time interval. One line corre- The set time interval is also used by the Strong sunlight, reflections or strong varia-
adaptive cruise control function, see tions in light intensity, as well as wearing
sponds to approximately sunglasses, could mean that the warning
page 177.
1 second to the vehicle in front, 5 lines approx- light in the windscreen cannot be seen.
imately 2.5 seconds. Only use the time interval that is allowed in
accordance with local traffic regulations. Poor weather or winding roads could affect
The number of lines for the the radar sensor's capacity to detect vehi-
04 selected time interval is cles in front.
shown during the setting itself Limitations The size of other vehicles could also affect
and for several seconds after- The function uses the same radar sensor as detection capacity, e.g. motorcycles. This
wards. Then a smaller scale adaptive cruise control and the collision warn- could mean that the warning lamp illumi-
version of the symbol is nates at a shorter distance than the setting
shown to the right of the dis- or that the warning is temporarily absent.
play. The same symbol is also shown when Extremely high speeds can also cause the
adaptive cruise control is activated. lamp to illuminate at a shorter distance than
that set due to limitations in sensor range.

Symbols and messages in the display


Symbol Message Specification
Set time interval, during adjustment.

Set time interval, after adjustment.

186 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Distance Warning*

Symbol Message Specification


Radar blocked See manual Distance Warning temporarily disengaged.
The radar sensor is blocked and cannot detect other vehicles, e.g. in the event of heavy rain or if slush
has collected in front of the radar sensor.
Read about the limitations of the radar sensor, see page 181.

Collision warn. Service Distance Warning and Collision Warning with Auto Brake fully or partially disengaged.
required Visit a workshop if the message remains - an authorised Volvo workshop is recommended.
04

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 187


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

City Safety™

General If the car is also equipped with a Collision Function


City Safety™ is a function for helping the driver Warning function with Auto Brake*, these two
to avoid a collision when driving in queues, systems complement each other. For more
amongst other things, when changes in the information on Collision Warning function with
traffic ahead, combined with a lapse in atten- Auto Brake, see page 192.
tion, could lead to an incident.
IMPORTANT
The function is active at speeds below
30 km/h and it helps the driver by automatically Maintenance and replacement of City
braking the car in the event of imminent risk of Safety™ components must only be per-
collision with vehicles in front, should the driver formed by a workshop - an authorised Volvo
04 workshop is recommended.
not react in time by braking and/or steering
away.
City Safety™ is activated in situations where WARNING
Laser sensor transmitter and receiver window1.
the driver should have started braking earlier, City Safety™ does not engage in all driving
which is why it cannot help the driver in every situations or traffic, weather or road condi- City Safety™ detects the traffic in front of the
situation. tions. car with a laser sensor fitted in the top edge of
the windscreen. If there is an imminent risk of
City Safety™ is designed to be activated as City Safety™ does not react to vehicles collision, City Safety™ will automatically brake
late as possible in order to avoid unnecessary driving in a different direction from the car,
to small vehicles, motorcycles and bicycles the car, which may be experienced as sudden
intervention. braking.
or to humans and animals.
City Safety™ must not be used as an excuse City Safety™ can prevent collision at a If the speed difference is 4-15 km/h in relation
for the driver to change his/her driving style. If speed difference of less than 15 km/h - at a to the vehicle in front then City Safety™ can
the driver solely relies on City Safety™ to do higher speed difference, it is only possible completely prevent a collision.
the braking, there will be a collision sooner or to reduce collision speed. In order to obtain
later. full brake function, the driver must depress City Safety™ activates a short, sharp braking
the brake pedal. and stops the car in normal circumstances, just
The driver or passengers normally only notice behind the vehicle in front. For most drivers this
City Safety™ if a situation arises where the car Never wait for City Safety™ to engage. The
driver always bears responsibility for main- is well outside normal driving style and may be
is extremely close to being in a collision. experienced as being uncomfortable.
taining the proper distance and speed.

1 NOTE: The illustration is schematic - details may vary depending on car model.

188 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

City Safety™

If the difference in speed between the vehicles Using MY CAR on the centre console display Low-hanging objects, e.g. a flag/pennant for
is greater than 15 km/h then City Safety™ may screen with its menu system, search and locate projecting load, or accessories such as auxili-
not prevent the collision on its own. To obtain Settings Car settings Driving support ary lamps and bull bars that are higher than the
full brake force, the driver must depress the systems City Safety. Select the Off option. bonnet limit the function.
brake pedal. This could then make it possible For more information on the menu system MY The infrared light from the sensor in City
to prevent a collision, even at speed differen-
CAR, see page 144). Safety™ measures how the light is reflected.
ces above 15 km/h.
The sensor cannot detect objects with low
However, the function will be enabled the next
When the function is activated and brakes, the reflection capacity. The rear sections of the
time the engine is started, regardless of
instrument panel display shows a message to vehicle generally reflect the light sufficiently
whether the system was enabled or disabled
the effect that the function is/has been active. thanks to the number plate and rear light reflec-
when the engine was switched off.
tors. 04
NOTE WARNING On slippery road surfaces the braking distance
The brake lights come on when City is extended, which may reduce the capacity of
The laser sensor also transmits laser light
Safety™ brakes the car. City Safety™ to avoid a collision. In such sit-
when City Safety™ is disabled manually.
uations the ABS and DSTC systems will pro-
vide best possible braking force with main-
Operation To enable City Safety™ again: tained stability.
• Follow the same procedure as for disa- When the car is reversing City Safety™ cannot
NOTE bling, but select the On option. be activated.
The City Safety™ function is always ena- City Safety™ is not activated at low speeds -
bled after the engine has been started via Limitations
key position I and II (see page 80 on key under 4 km/h, which is why the system does
positions). The sensor in City Safety™ is designed to not intervene in situations where a vehicle in
detect cars and other large vehicles in front of front is being approached very slowly, e.g.
the car irrespective of whether it is day or night. when parking.
On and Off
In certain situations, it may advisable to disable However, the sensor has limitations and has Driver commands are always prioritised, which
City Safety™, e.g. where leafy branches could poorer functionality in e.g. heavy snowfall or is why City Safety™ does not intervene in sit-
sweep over the bonnet and/or windscreen. rain, dense fog, dust storms or snow flurries. uations where the driver is steering, braking or
Mist, dirt, ice or snow on the windscreen may accelerating in a clear manner, even if a colli-
After starting the engine City Safety™ can be disrupt the function. sion is unavoidable.
deactivated as follows:

189
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

City Safety™

When City Safety™ has prevented a collision The Windscreen Sensors blocked message IMPORTANT
with a stationary object the car remains sta- is not shown for all situations in which the laser
tionary for a maximum of 1.5 seconds. If the car sensor is blocked. The driver must therefore be If there are cracks, scratches or stone chips
is braked for a vehicle in front that is moving, in the windscreen in front of either of the
diligent about keeping the windscreen and
laser sensor's "windows" and they cover a
then speed is reduced to the same speed as area in front of the laser sensor clean. surface of approx. 0.5 x 3.0 mm (or larger),
that maintained by the vehicle in front. then a workshop must be contacted for
The following table presents possible causes
On a car with manual gearbox the engine stops for the message being shown, along with sug- repair or replacement of the windscreen
(see the illustration for sensor location, page
when City Safety™ has stopped the car, unless gestions for appropriate action.
188) - an authorised Volvo workshop is rec-
the driver manages to depress the clutch pedal ommended.
beforehand. Cause Action Failure to take action may result in reduced
04
performance for City Safety™.
NOTE The windscreen sur- Clean the wind-
face in front of the screen surface in To avoid the risk of reducing City Safety™
• Keep the windscreen surface in front of laser sensor is dirty front of the sensor performance the following also applies:
the laser sensor free from ice, snow and or covered with ice from dirt, ice and
dirt (see the illustration for sensor loca- • The same type or a Volvo-approved
or snow. snow. windscreen must be fitted during
tion, page 188).
replacement
• Do not affix or mount anything on the The laser sensor Remove the block-
windscreen in front of the laser sensor field of vision is ing object. • The same type or Volvo-approved
blocked. windscreen wipers must be fitted during
• Remove ice and snow from the bonnet replacement.
- snow and ice must not exceed a height
of 5 cm.
Laser sensor
Fault tracing and action The City Safety™ function includes a sensor
If the message Windscreen Sensors which transmits laser light. Contact a qualified
blocked is shown on the instrument panel dis- workshop in the event of a fault or if the laser
play, it indicates that the laser sensor is sensor needs servicing - an authorised Volvo
blocked and cannot detect vehicles in front of workshop is recommended.
the car. This means that City Safety™ is not
operational.

190
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

City Safety™

WARNING For more information on the laser sensor, see A text message can be acknowledged by
page 9. briefly pressing the READ button on the direc-
Never look into the laser sensor (which tion indicator stalk.
emits spreading invisible laser radiation) at
a distance of 100 mm or closer with magni- Symbols and messages in the display
fying optics such as a magnifying glass, In conjunction with automatic braking by the
microscope, lens or similar optical instru- City Safety™ system, one or more symbols
ments - this would involve a risk of eye injury
(the illustration on page 188 shows sensor
may illuminate on the instrument panel and a
location). message may appear on its display.

04
Symbol Message Meaning/Action
Auto braking by City Safety City Safety™ is braking or has automatically braked.

Windscreen Sensors The laser sensor is temporarily non-operational because something is blocking it.
blocked
• Remove the object blocking the sensor and/or clean the windscreen in front of the sensor.
Read about the limitations of the laser sensor, see page 189.

City Safety Service City Safety™ is not operational.


required
• Visit a workshop if the message remains - an authorised Volvo workshop is recommended.

191
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Collision Warning with Auto Brake & Pedestrian Protection*

General sion Warning with Auto Brake to do the brak- WARNING


Collision Warning with Auto Brake and Pedes- ing, there will be a collision sooner or later.
The collision warning system does not
trian Detection is designed to assist the driver The collision warning system and City engage in all driving situations or traffic,
when there is a risk of colliding with a pedes- Safety™ complement each other. For more weather or road conditions. The collision
trian or vehicles in front that are stationary or information on City Safety™, see page 188. warning system does not react to vehicles
moving in the same direction. driving in another direction to the car or to
animals.
The collision warning system has the following IMPORTANT
three functions. Warning only activated in the event of a high
Maintenance of collision warning system risk for collision. The Function section and
• Collision Warning – Warns the driver of a components must only be performed at a the section after advise about limitations of
potentially imminent collision. workshop - an authorised Volvo workshop which the driver should be aware before
04 is recommended. using Collision Warning with Auto Brake.
• Brake Support – Assists the driver to
brake effectively in a critical situation. Warnings and brake interventions for
WARNING pedestrians are switched off at vehicle
• Auto Brake - Brakes the car automatically speeds exceeding 80 km/h.
in the event of an imminent risk of collision No automatic system can guarantee
with a pedestrian or vehicle in front, if the 100 % correct function in all situations. Warnings and brake interventions for
driver does not himself/herself react in time Therefore, never try out the Auto brake sys- pedestrians do not work in darkness and
by braking and/or steering away. The Auto tem by driving towards people - this may tunnels - not even when streetlights are lit.
Brake function can prevent a collision or cause serious injuries or risk death. The auto-brake function can prevent a col-
reduce collision speed. lision or reduce collision speed. To ensure
The collision warning system is activated in sit- full brake performance, the driver should
always depress the brake pedal - even when
uations where the driver should have started
the car auto-brakes.
braking a lot earlier, which is why the function
cannot help the driver in every situation. Never wait for a collision warning. The driver
is always responsible that the correct dis-
Collision Warning with Auto Brake is designed tance and speed are maintained - even
to be activated as late as possible in order to when the collision warning system with
avoid unnecessary intervention. auto-brake is used.
The collision warning system must not be used
as an excuse for the driver to change his/her
driving style. If the driver solely relies on Colli-

192 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Collision Warning with Auto Brake & Pedestrian Protection*

Function Brake support Operation


If the risk of collision still increases after the Settings are made from MY CAR via the centre
collision warning then the brake support is acti- console display screen and menu system. For
vated. The brake support prepares the brake information on how the menu system is used,
system for rapid braking and the brakes are see page 144.
applied gently, which may be noticed as a
slight jerk. NOTE
If the brake pedal is depressed sufficiently The Brake Support and Auto Brake func-
quickly then full brake function is implemented. tions are always enabled - they cannot be
Brake support also reinforces the driver's brak- deactivated.
ing if the system considers that the braking is 04
not sufficient to avoid a collision. On and Off
Function overview1. To select whether the collision warning system
Auto Brake should be switched on or off: Search with the
Audio-visual warning signal in the event of If in this situation the driver has not yet started menu system MY CAR via the centre console
a collision risk. to take evasive action and the risk of collision display screen and locate Settings Car
Radar sensor is imminent then the automatic braking func-
tion is deployed, irrespective of whether or not settings Driving support systems
Camera sensor the driver brakes. Braking then takes place with Collision Warning. For information on the
full brake force in order to reduce collision menu system, see page 144.
Collision warning speed, or with limited brake force if it is suffi- An activated function is tested at each engine
Together with a camera sensor, the radar sen- cient to avoid collision. start by briefly illuminating the warning lamp's
sor detects pedestrians, stationary vehicles as separate points of light.
well as vehicles driving in the same direction in
front of the car. When starting the engine, the setting that was
selected when the engine was switched off is
In the event of there being a risk of collision with obtained automatically.
a pedestrian or such a vehicle your attention is
drawn with a red flashing warning signal and a
warning sound.

1 NOTE: The illustration is schematic - details may vary depending on car model.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 193


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Collision Warning with Auto Brake & Pedestrian Protection*

Activating/deactivating warning signals NOTE Limitations


The warning lamp is activated automatically The collision warning system is active from and
when the engine is started if the system is When the adaptive cruise control is in use
the warning lamp and warning sound will be including approx. 4 km/h.
switched on. used by the cruise control even if the colli- The visual warning signal may be difficult to
The warning sound can be activated/deacti- sion warning system is switched off. notice in the event of strong sunlight, reflec-
vated separately using the options for On or The collision warning system warns the tions, when sunglasses are being worn or if the
Off in the menu system MY CAR under driver in the event of a risk of a collision, but driver is not looking straight ahead. The warn-
Settings Car settings Driving support the function cannot shorten driver reaction ing sound should therefore always be acti-
time. vated.
systems Warning sound if risk of
collision. In order for the collision warning system to
On slippery road surfaces the braking distance
04 be effective, always drive with the Distance
Alert set at time interval 4 – 5. see is extended, which may reduce the capacity to
Set warning distance avoid a collision. In such situations the ABS
page 185.
The warning distance regulates the distance at and DSTC systems will provide best possible
which the visual and acoustic warnings are braking force with maintained stability.
deployed. Select one of the options from NOTE
Long, Normal or Short in the menu system
Even if the warning distance has been set to NOTE
MY CAR under Settings Car settings Long warnings could be perceived as being
Driving support systems Collision The visual warning signal can be temporarily
late in certain situations, e.g. when there are
disengaged in the event of high passenger
Warning Warning distance. large differences in speed or if vehicles in
compartment temperature caused by
front brake heavily.
strong sunlight for example. If this occurs
The warning distance determines the system's
then the warning sound is activated even if
sensitivity. Warning distance Long provides an it is deactivated in the menu system.
Checking settings
earlier warning. First test with Long and if this
The settings required can be controlled on the • Warnings may not appear if the dis-
setting produces too many warnings, which
centre console display screen. Search with the tance to the vehicle in front is small or if
could be perceived as irritating in certain sit-
menu system MY CAR under Settings Car steering wheel and pedal movements
uations, then change to warning distance
settings Driving support systems are large, e.g. a very active driving style.
Normal.
Collision Warning, see page 144.
Only use warning distance Short in excep-
tional cases, e.g. for dynamic driving.

194 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Collision Warning with Auto Brake & Pedestrian Protection*

WARNING why the system does not intervene in situations NOTE


where the car is approaching a vehicle in front
Warnings and brake interventions could be very slowly, e.g. when parking. Keep the windscreen surface in front of the
implemented late or not at all if the traffic camera sensor clean from ice, snow, mist
situation or external influences mean that Driver commands are always prioritised, which and dirt.
the radar or camera sensor cannot detect a is why Collision Warning with Auto Brake does Do not attach or fit anything to the wind-
pedestrian or a vehicle in front correctly. not intervene in situations where the driver is screen in front of the camera sensor, as this
The sensor system has a limited range for steering, braking or accelerating in a clear could reduce or prevent the function of one
pedestrians and the system therefore pro- manner, even if a collision is unavoidable. or more camera-dependent systems.
vides effective warnings and brake inter-
ventions at vehicle speeds up to 50 km/h. When Auto Brake has prevented a collision
For stationary or slow-moving vehicles, with a stationary object the car remains sta- The camera sensors have limitations similar to
tionary for a maximum of 1.5 seconds. If the car the human eye, i.e. they "see" worse in dark- 04
warnings and brake interventions are effec-
tive at vehicle speeds up to 70 km/h. is braked for a vehicle in front that is moving, ness, heavy snowfall or rain and in thick fog for
then speed is reduced to the same speed as example. Under such conditions the functions
Warnings for stationary or slow-moving
vehicles could be disengaged due to dark- that maintained by the vehicle in front. of camera-dependent systems could be sig-
ness or poor visibility. nificantly reduced or temporarily disengaged.
On a car with manual gearbox the engine stops
when Auto Brake has stopped the car, unless Strong oncoming light, reflections in the car-
The collision warning system uses the same the driver manages to depress the clutch pedal riageway, snow or ice on the road surface, dirty
radar sensors as adaptive cruise control. For beforehand. road surfaces or unclear lane markings could
more information on the radar sensor and its also significantly reduce camera sensor func-
limitations, see page 181. Camera sensor limitations tion when it is used to scan the carriageway
The car's camera sensor is used by the three and detect pedestrians and other vehicles.
If warnings are perceived as being too frequent functions - Collision Warning with Auto Brake,
or disturbing then the warning distance can be During very high temperatures the camera is
Driver Alert Control, see page 199 and Lane
reduced. This would lead to the system warn- temporarily switched off for about 15 minutes
Departure Warning, see page 202.
ing at a later stage, which reduces the total after the engine is started in order to protect
number of warnings. camera functionality.
When the car is reversing Collision Warning
with Auto Brake cannot be activated.
Collision Warning with Auto Brake is not acti-
vated at low speeds - under 4 km/h, which is

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 195


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Collision Warning with Auto Brake & Pedestrian Protection*

Detection of pedestrians • In order for a pedestrian to be detected he/ In turn this means that the Collision Warning
she must appear full-length and have a with Auto Brake, Lane Departure Warning and
height of at least 80 cm. Driver Alert Control functions are not operating
• The system cannot detect a pedestrian with full functionality.
carrying larger items. The following table presents possible causes
• The camera sensor's ability to see pedes- for a message being shown along with the
trians at dusk and dawn is limited - just like appropriate action.
the human eye.
• The camera sensor's capacity to detect Cause Action
pedestrians is deactivated when driving in
04 darkness and tunnels - even when street- The windscreen sur- Clean the wind-
lights are lit. face in front of the screen surface in
camera is dirty or front of the camera
Optimal examples of what the system regards as WARNING covered with ice or from dirt, ice and
pedestrians with clear body contours.
Collision Warning with Auto Brake & Pedes- snow. snow.
Optimal performance of the system requires trian Detection is a means of assistance.
that the system function that detects pedes- Thick fog, heavy rain No action. At times
It cannot detect all pedestrians in all situa-
trians receives as unambiguous information as or snow means that the camera does not
tions and it cannot see e.g. partially
possible about the contours of the body - this obscured pedestrians, people in clothing the camera does not work during heavy
implies the opportunity to identify the head, that hides the contours of the body or work sufficiently rain or snowfall.
arms, shoulders, legs, upper and lower body pedestrians shorter than 80 cm. well.
combined with a normal human pattern of • The driver is always responsible that the
movement. vehicle is driven properly and with a
If large parts of the body are not visible to the safety distance adapted to the speed.
camera then the system cannot detect a
pedestrian. Fault tracing and action
If the display shows the message Windscreen
Sensors blocked then this means that the
camera sensor is blocked and cannot detect
pedestrians, vehicles or road markings in front
of the car.

196 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Collision Warning with Auto Brake & Pedestrian Protection*

Cause Action Cause Action Cause Action


The windscreen sur- Wait. It may take cleaned but the the camera to meas- Dirt has appeared Visit a workshop to
face in front of the several minutes for message remains. ure the visibility. between the inside have the windscreen
camera has been of the windscreen inside the camera
and the camera. cover cleaned - an
authorised Volvo
workshop is recom-
mended.

04
Symbols and messages in the display
Symbol Message Specification
Collis'n Collision warning system switched off.
warning Shown when the engine is started.
OFF
The message clears after about 5 seconds or after one press of the READ button.

Collision The collision warning system cannot be activated.


warn. Shown when the driver attempts to activate the function.
Unavaila-
ble The message clears after about 5 seconds or after one press of the READ button.

Auto brak- Auto Brake has been active.


ing was The message clears after one press of the READ button.
activated

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 197


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Collision Warning with Auto Brake & Pedestrian Protection*

Symbol Message Specification


Wind- The camera sensor is temporarily disengaged.
screen Shown in the event of snow, ice or dirt on the windscreen for example.
Sensors
blocked • Clean the windscreen surface in front of the camera sensor.
Read about the limitations of the camera sensor, see page 195.

Radar Collision Warning with Auto Brake is temporarily disengaged.


blocked The radar sensor is blocked and cannot detect other vehicles. For example, in the event of heavy rain or if slush has
See man- collected in front of the radar sensor.
04
ual
Read about the limitations of the radar sensor, see page 181.

Collision Collision Warning with Auto Brake is fully or partially disengaged.


warn.
• Visit a workshop if the message remains - an authorised Volvo workshop is recommended.
Service
required

198 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Driver Alert System – DAC*

General information on Driver Alert General information on Driver Alert The objective for DAC is to detect slowly dete-
System Control - DAC riorating driving ability and it is primarily
The Driver Alert System is intended to assist intended for major roads. The function is not
drivers whose driving ability is deteriorating or intended for city traffic.
who are inadvertently leaving the lane they are In some cases driving ability is not affected
driving on. despite driver fatigue. In which case there may
The Driver Alert System consists of two differ- not be any warning issued for the driver. For
ent functions, which can either be switched on this reason it is always important to stop and
at the same time or individually: take a break in the event of any signs of driver
fatigue, irrespective of whether or not DAC
• Driver Alert Control (DAC) issues a warning. 04
• Lane Departure Warning (LDW), see
page 202. NOTE
A switched-on function is set in standby mode The function must not be used to extend a
and is not activated automatically until speed The function is intended to attract the driver's driving stint. Always plan breaks at regular
exceeds 65 km/h. attention when he/she starts to drive less con- intervals and ensure that you are fully
sistently, e.g. if he/she becomes distracted or rested.
The function is deactivated again when speed
decreases to below 60 km/h. starts to fall asleep.
A camera detects the side markings painted on Limitation
Both functions use a camera which is depend-
the carriageway and compares the section of In some cases the system may issue a warning
ent on the lane having side markings painted
the road with the driver's steering wheel move- despite driving ability not deteriorating, for
on each side.
ments. The driver is alerted if the vehicle does example:
WARNING not follow the carriageway evenly. • if the driver tests the LDW function.
The Driver Alert System does not work in all • in strong side winds.
NOTE
situations but is instead only intended to be • on rutted road surfaces.
of supplementary assistance. The camera sensor has certain limitations,
The driver always has ultimate responsibility see page 195.
that the car is driven safely.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 199


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Driver Alert System – DAC*

Operation On/Off WARNING


Some settings are made from the centre con- To set Driver Alert in standby mode:
An alarm should be taken very seriously, as
sole display screen and its menu system. For • Search on the centre console's display a sleepy driver is often not aware of his/her
information on how the menu system is used, screen with its MY CAR menu system and own condition.
see page 144. locate Car settings Driving support In the event of an alarm or a feeling of tired-
The current status of Driver Alert can be systems Driver Alert and tick the box. ness; stop the car in a safe manner as soon
checked on the trip computer display with the as possible and rest.
• No tick in the box: Function disengaged.
thumbwheel on the left-hand stalk switch. Studies have shown that it is equally as dan-
Function gerous to drive while tired as it is under the
Driver Alert is activated when speed influence of alcohol.
04 exceeds 65 km/h and remains active
as long as the speed is over
60 km/h.
The display shows a level mark with 1-5 bars,
where a low number of bars indicates incon-
sistent driving style. Many bars indicates stable
driving.
If the vehicle is driven inconsistently then the
driver is alerted by an acoustic signal as well as
the text message Driver Alert Time for a
Thumbwheel. Turn until the display shows break. The warning is repeated after a time if
Driver driving ability does not improve.
Alert . On the second row the options Dri
ver Alert Standby <65 km/h, Driver Alert
Unavailable or level mark can be
shown.
READ confirms or clears a warning in the
memory.

200 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Driver Alert System – DAC*

Symbols and messages in the display


Symbol Message Specification
Driver Alert OFF The function is disengaged.

Driver Alert Standby <65 The function is set in standby mode due to speed being lower than 65 km/h.
km/h

Driver Alert Unavailable The carriageway does not have clear side markings or the camera sensor is temporarily disengaged.
Read about the limitations of the camera sensor, see page 195.

Driver Alert The function analyses the driver's driving style. 04


The number of bars can vary in the range 1-5, where a low number of bars indicates inconsistent
driving ability. A high number of bars indicates stable driving.

Driver Alert Time for a The vehicle has been driven inconsistently - the driver is alerted by an acoustic warning signal + text.
break

Windscreen Sensors The camera sensor is temporarily disengaged.


blocked Shown in the event of snow, ice or dirt on the windscreen for example.
• Clean the windscreen surface in front of the camera sensor.
Read about the limitations of the camera sensor, see page 195.

Driver Alert Sys Service The system is disengaged.


required
• Visit a workshop if the message remains - an authorised Volvo workshop is recommended.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 201


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Driver Alert System - LDW*

General information on Lane Departure Operation and function If the camera can no longer detect the carria-
Warning - LDW geway's side markings the display shows
Lane Depart Warn Unavailable.
If speed decreases to below 60 km/h then the
function resumes standby mode and the dis-
play shows Lane Depart Warn Standby <65
km/h.
If the vehicle crosses the left or right-hand side
marking of the carriageway without due cause
then the driver is alerted by an acoustic signal.
04
No warning is given in the following situations:
• Direction indicators activated
The function is switched on or off by means of • The driver has his/her foot on the brake
The function is intended to reduce the risk for a switch on the centre console. An indicator pedal1
single-vehicle accidents – accidents where, in lamp in the button illuminates when the func-
certain situations, the vehicle leaves the car- tion is switched on.
• In the event of the accelerator pedal being
depressed rapidly1
riageway and is in danger of driving either into
The trip computer display shows Lane Depart • In the event of rapid steering wheel move-
a ditch or into oncoming traffic.
Warn Standby <65 km/h when the function is ments1
LDW consists of a camera that detects the side in standby mode due to speed being below 65
markings painted on the carriageway. The km/h. • In the event of a sudden turn so that the car
rolls.
driver is alerted by an acoustic signal if the
The LDW function is activated automatically The camera sensor also has certain limitations.
vehicle crosses a side marking.
from standby mode after the camera has scan- For more information, see page 195.
ned in the carriageway's side markings and
speed exceeds 65 km/h. The trip computer
display then shows Lane Depart Warn
Available.

1 A warning is still given when Increased sensitivity is selected, see page 204.

202 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Driver Alert System - LDW*

NOTE wheels cross a line. So there is no acoustic


alarm when there is a line between the car's
The driver is only warned once each time the wheels.

Symbols and messages in the display


Symbol Message Specification
Lane departure warning The function is switched on/off.
ON/Lane departure warn- Shown at switch-on/off.
ing OFF 04
The text disappears after 5 seconds.

Lane Depart Warn Standby The function is set in standby mode due to speed being lower than 65 km/h.
<65 km/h

Lane Depart Warn Unavail- The carriageway does not have clear side markings or the camera sensor is temporarily disengaged.
able Read about the limitations of the camera sensor, see page 195.

Lane Depart Warn Availa- The function scans the carriageway's side markings.
ble

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 203


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Driver Alert System - LDW*

Symbol Message Specification


Windscreen Sensors The camera sensor is temporarily disengaged.
blocked Shown in the event of snow, ice or dirt on the windscreen for example.
• Clean the windscreen surface in front of the camera sensor.
Read about the limitations of the camera sensor, see page 195.

Driver Alert Sys Service The system is disengaged.


required
• Visit a workshop if the message remains - an authorised Volvo workshop is recommended.
04

Personal preferences when the engine was switched off is


Settings are made from the centre console's obtained.
display screen via the menu system in MY • Increased sensitivity – This option
CAR. From there, search and locate Settings increases sensitivity, an alarm is triggered
Car settings Driving support systems earlier and fewer limitations apply.
Lane Departure Warning. For information
on how the menu system is used - see
page 144.
Select from the options:
• On at start up - This option sets the func-
tion in standby mode each time the engine
is started. Otherwise the same value as

204 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Park assist syst*

General Function
Parking assistance is used as an aid to parking.
An acoustic signal as well as symbols on the
centre console's display screen indicate the
distance to the detected obstacle.
Parking assistance sound level can be
adjusted during the ongoing acoustic signal
using the centre console's VOL knob or in the
car's menu system MY CAR - see page 144.
Parking assistance is available in two variants:
04
• Rear only Display screen view - showing an obstacle left
• Both front and rear. front and right rear.
The system is automatically activated when the
The centre console's display screen shows an
WARNING engine is started - the switch's On/Off lamp is
overview of the relationship between the car
illuminated. If parking assistance is switched
• Parking assistance does not relinquish and detected obstacle.
off with the button, the lamp goes out.
the driver's own responsibility during Marked sectors show which of the four sen-
parking. sor(s) detected an obstacle. The closer to the
• The sensors have blind spots where car symbol a selected sector box is, the shorter
obstacles cannot be detected. the distance between the car and a detected
• Be aware of e.g. people or animals near obstacle.
the car. The frequency of the signal increases the
shorter the distance to an obstacle, in front of
or behind the car. Other sound from the audio
system is muted automatically.
When the distance is within 30 cm the tone is
constant and the active sensor's field nearest
the car is filled in. If the detected obstacle is
within the distance for the constant tone both

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 205


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Park assist syst*

behind and in front of the car, then the tone Rear parking assistance Front parking assistance
sounds alternately from the loudspeakers.

IMPORTANT
Certain objects e.g. chains, thin glossy
poles or low barriers may be in the "signal
shadow" and are then temporarily not
detected by the sensors - the pulsating tone
may then unexpectedly stop instead of
changing over to the expected constant
tone.
04 • In which case, pay extra attention and
manoeuvre/reposition the car particu-
larly slowly or stop the current parking
manoeuvre - there may be a high risk of The distance covered to the rear of the car is The distance covered in front of the car is about
damage to vehicles or other objects about 1.5 metres. The acoustic signal for 0.8 metres. The acoustic signal for obstacles in
since the sensors are unable to function obstacles behind comes from one of the rear front comes from one of the front loudspeak-
optimally. loudspeakers. ers.
Rear parking assistance is activated when Front parking assistance is active up to
reverse gear is engaged. 15 km/h. The lamp in the button is illuminated
in order to indicate that the system is activated.
The system must be deactivated when revers-
When the speed is below 10 km/h the system
ing with a trailer or bike carrier on the towbar
is reactivated.
or similar - otherwise they would trigger the
sensors.
NOTE
NOTE Front parking assistance is deactivated
when the parking brake is applied or P mode
Rear parking assistance is deactivated is selected in a car with an automatic gear-
automatically when towing a trailer if Volvo box.
genuine trailer wiring is used.

206 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Park assist syst*

IMPORTANT Cleaning the sensors NOTE


When fitting auxiliary lamps: Remember that Dirt, ice and snow covering the sensors may
they must not obscure the sensors – the cause incorrect warning signals.
auxiliary lamps could then be detected as
obstacles.

Fault indicator
If the information symbol illuminates
with constant glow and the informa-
tion display shows Park assist syst Service 04
required then parking assistance is disen-
gaged.
Sensor location, front.
IMPORTANT
In certain conditions the parking assistance
system may produce incorrect warning sig-
nals that are caused by external audio
sources that emit the same ultrasonic fre-
quencies that the system works with.
Examples of such sources include horns,
wet tyres on asphalt, pneumatic brakes and
exhaust noises from motorcycles etc.

Sensor location, rear.


The sensors must be cleaned regularly to
ensure that they work properly. Clean them
with water and car shampoo.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 207


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Park assist camera*

General When reverse gear is engaged two unbroken


The parking camera is an assist system and is lines are shown graphically which illustrate
activated when reverse gear is engaged (can where the car's rear wheels will roll with the
be changed in the settings menu, see current steering wheel angle, this facilitates
page 144). tight parking, reversing into tight spaces and
for hitching a trailer. The car's approximate
The camera image is shown on the centre con- exterior dimensions are also illustrated by two
sole's screen. dashed lines, the park assist lines can be deac-
tivated in the settings menu.
WARNING
If the car is also equipped with parking assis-
04 • The parking camera serves as an aid. It tance sensors* then their information is dis-
does not relieve the driver of responsi- played graphically as coloured fields in order to
bility when reversing. CAM button location. illustrate the distance to detected obstacles,
• The camera has blind spots, where The camera shows what is behind the car and see page 205.
obstacles cannot be detected. if something appears from the sides.
The camera is active approx. 5 seconds after
• Be aware of people and animals in the The camera shows a wide area behind the car reverse gear has been disengaged or until the
vicinity of the car. and part of the bumper and any towbar. car's speed exceeds 10 km/h.
Objects on the screen may appear to tilt slightly
- this is normal.

NOTE
Objects on the display screen may be closer
to the car than they appear to be on the
screen.

If another view is active the parking camera


system takes over automatically and the cam-
era image is displayed on the screen.
Camera location next to the opening handle.

208 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Park assist camera*

Light conditions which shows the driver the path the car will Boundary lines
The camera image is adjusted automatically take, even when turning.
according to prevailing light conditions.
Because of this, the image may vary slightly in NOTE
brightness and quality. Poor light conditions
can result in a slightly reduced image quality. • When reversing with a trailer which is
not connected electrically to the car, the
lines on the display show the route the
NOTE car will take - not the trailer.
Keep camera lenses clear of dirt, snow and • The screen shows no lines when a trailer
ice to ensure the best possible function. is connected electrically to the car's
This is particularly important in poor light. electrical system. 04
• The parking camera is deactivated
Park assist lines automatically when towing a trailer if a The system's lines.
Volvo genuine trailer cable is used.
Boundary line, 30 cm zone backwards
from the car
IMPORTANT Boundary line, free reversing zone
Bear in mind that the screen only shows the
area behind the car - pay attention to the "Wheel tracks"
sides and front of the car when manoeuvring The unbroken line (1) frames in a zone that is
during reversing.
within about 30 cm from the bumper.
The dashed line (2) frames in a zone up to
about 1.5 m back from the bumper. It is also
the limit of the car's most protruding parts,
such as door mirrors and corners - also during
Examples of how the park assist lines can be dis-
played for the driver. turning.
The lines on the screen are projected as if they The wide "wheel tracks" (3) between the side
were at ground level behind the car and are lines indicate where the wheels will roll and can
directly related to steering wheel movement, extend about 3.2 m back from the bumper if no
obstacle is in the way.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 209


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Park assist camera*

Cars with reversing sensors* Colour / paint Distance Limitations


(metres)
NOTE
Yellow 1.5–
A bike carrier or other accessory mounted
Orange 0.3–1.5 on the rear of the car could obscure the
camera's view.
Red 0–0.3
Pay attention to the possibility that, even if it
Settings only looks like a relatively small part of the
Press OK/MENU when a camera view is image is obscured, it could be a relatively large
04 shown. Make the settings as desired. sector that is hidden from view. Obstacles
could thereby go undetected until they are very
Miscellaneous close to the car.
Coloured areas (x 4, one per sensor) show dis- • The default setting is that the camera is
tance. activated when reverse gear is engaged. To bear in mind
If the car is also equipped with parking assis- • One press on CAM activates the camera • Keep the camera lens free from dirt, ice
tance sensors (see page 205) the distance indi- even if reverse gear is not engaged. and snow.
cation will be more precise and the coloured • Clean the camera lens regularly with luke-
areas show which of the 4 sensors is/are reg-
• Change between normal and zoomed
image by turning TUNE or by pressing warm water and car shampoo - take care
istering an obstacle. CAM. not to scratch the lens.
The colour of the areas changes with decreas- • If the car has more cameras* installed then
ing distance to the obstacle - from yellow to the camera in use is changed by turning
orange to red. TUNE.

210 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

BLIS* – Blind Spot Information System

General information on BLIS WARNING If necessary, the system can be switched off
temporarily, see the section "Activate/deacti-
The system is a supplement to, not a vate".
replacement for, a safe driving style and use
of the rearview mirrors. It can never replace
the driver's attention and responsibility. The Blind spots
responsibility for changing lanes safely
always rests with the driver.

The system is designed to work most effec-


tively when driving in dense traffic on multi-lane
highways. 04
G021426
When a camera (1) has detected a vehicle
inside the blind spot zone the indicator lamp (2)
BLIS camera1 illuminates with a constant glow.
Indicator lamp
NOTE
BLIS symbol
The lamp illuminates on the side of the car A = approx. 9.5 m and B = approx. 3.0 m.
BLIS is an information system based on cam- where the system has detected the vehicle.
era technology that under certain conditions If the car is overtaken on both sides at the
can help the driver to notice vehicles moving in same time then both lamps illuminate.
the same direction as the host vehicle in the so-
called "blind spot". BLIS advises the driver with a message if a fault
arises in the system. If for example the sys-
tem's cameras are obscured then the BLIS
indicator lamp flashes and a message is shown
on the information display. In such cases,
check and clean the lenses.

1 NOTE: The illustration is schematic - details may vary depending on car model.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 211


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

BLIS* – Blind Spot Information System

Activate/deactivate When BLIS is deactivated, the lamp in the but- Daylight and darkness
ton goes out and a message is shown in the In daylight the system reacts to the shape of
instrument panel display. the surrounding vehicles. The system is
When BLIS is activated the light in the button designed to detect motor vehicles such as
illuminates, a new text message is shown on cars, trucks, buses and motorcycles.
the display and the indicator lamps in the door In darkness the system reacts to the head-
panels flash 3 times. Press the READ button to lamps of surrounding vehicles. If the head-
delete the text message. (For a description of lamps of surrounding vehicles are not switched
messages - see page 142). on then the system does not detect the vehi-
cles. This means for example that the system
04 When BLIS operates does not react to a trailer without headlamps
which is towed behind a car or truck.
The system operates when the car is driven at
Button for activating/deactivating. a speed above 10 km/h.
WARNING
BLIS is activated when the engine is started. Overtaking The system does not react to cyclists or
The indicator lamps in the door panels flash The system is designed to react if: moped riders.
three times when BLIS is activated.
• you overtake another vehicle at a speed of The BLIS cameras have limitations similar to
The system can be deactivated/activated after up to 10 km/h faster than the other vehicle those of the human eye, i.e. they do not
starting the engine with one press on the "see" as well e.g. in heavy snowfall, against
• you are overtaken by a vehicle travelling up strong light or in thick fog.
BLIS button. to 70 km/h faster than you are travelling.
Some combinations of the selected equipment
leave no vacant space for a button in the centre WARNING
console - in which case the function is handled BLIS does not work in sharp bends.
by the car's menu system MY CAR under
Settings Car settings BLIS. (For a BLIS does not work when the car is revers-
ing.
description of the menu system - see
page 144). A wide trailer coupled to the car can conceal
other vehicles in adjacent lanes. It can pre-
vent the vehicle in the screened area from
being detected by BLIS.

212 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

BLIS* – Blind Spot Information System

Cleaning Message Specification Limitations


In order to work most effectively the BLIS cam- In some situations the BLIS indicator lamp may
era lenses must be clean. The lenses can be Blind spot syst. Reduced function in illuminate despite there being no other vehicle
cleaned with a soft cloth or damp sponge. Reduced function the data transmis- within the blind spot.
Clean the lenses carefully so that they are not sion between the
scratched. BLIS system's cam- NOTE
era and the car's
electrical system. If the BLIS indicator lamp illuminates on iso-
IMPORTANT lated occasions despite there being no
The lenses are electrically heated to melt ice The camera resets other vehicle within the blind spot then this
or snow. If necessary, brush snow away itself when the data does not mean that a fault has arisen in the
from the lenses. transmission system. 04
between the BLIS In the event of a fault in the BLIS system the
system's camera display shows the text Blind spot syst.
Messages on the display and the car's electri- Service required.
cal system returns to
Message Specification normal. The following illustrations show examples of
Blind-spot info The BLIS system is situations where the BLIS indicator lamp may
Blind-spot info The BLIS system is
system ON activated. illuminate even if there is no other vehicle within
system OFF deactivated.
the blind spot.
Blind spot syst. Blind spot syst. dis-
Service required engaged - contact a IMPORTANT
workshop.
Repair of the BLIS system components
Blind spot syst. The BLIS camera is must only be performed by a workshop - an
Camera blocked blocked by dirt, authorised Volvo workshop is recom-
snow or ice - clean mended.
the lenses.

Reflection from shiny wet road surface.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 213


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

BLIS* – Blind Spot Information System

Own shadow on large light smooth surface, e.g.


noise barrier or concrete road surface.
04

Low stationary sunlight shining into the camera.

214 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Comfort inside the passenger compartment

Storage spaces

04

``

215
04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Comfort inside the passenger compartment

Storage compartment in door panel Tunnel console Glovebox


Storage pocket* on front edge of front seat
cushions
Ticket clip
Glovebox
Storage compartment
Jacket holder

04 Storage compartment, cup holder


Cup holder* in armrest, rear seat
Storage pocket Storage compartment (e.g. for CDs) and The owner's manual and maps can be kept
USB*/AUX input under the armrest. here for example. There are also holders for
Jacket holder Includes cup holder for driver and passen- pens on the inside of the lid. The glovebox can
The jacket holder is only designed for light ger. (If ashtray and cigarette lighter are be locked with the key blade, see page 50.
clothing. specified then there is a cigarette lighter in
the 12 V socket for the front seat, see Inlay mats*
WARNING page 217, and a detachable ashtray in the
Volvo supplies specially manufactured inlay
Keep loose objects such as mobile phones, cup holder.)
mats.
cameras, remote controls for accessories,
etc. in the glove compartment or other com- Cigarette lighter and ashtray*
partments. Otherwise they may injure peo- The ashtray in the tunnel console is detached WARNING
ple in the car in the event of sudden braking by lifting the tray straight up. Before setting off check that the inlaid mat
or a collision. in the driver area is firmly affixed and
Activate the lighter by pushing in the button.
The button pops out when the lighter is hot. Pull secured in the pins in order to avoid getting
caught adjacent to and under the pedals.
out the lighter and light a cigarette on the
heated coils.

216 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


04 Comfort and driving pleasure

Comfort inside the passenger compartment

Vanity mirror 12 V socket WARNING


Always leave the plug in the socket when
the socket is not in use.

NOTE
Optional equipment and accessories - e.g.
TV screens, music players and mobile
phones - which are connected to one of the
passenger compartment's 12V electrical
sockets, could be activated by the climate
04
G021438
control system, even when the remote con-
trol key has been removed or when the car
is locked, for example, when the parking
Vanity mirror with lighting. 12 V socket in tunnel console, front seat. heater is activated at a preset time.
The light illuminates automatically when the The electrical socket can be used for various For this reason remove the plugs from the
cover is lifted. accessories designed for 12 V, e.g. TV screens, electrical sockets for optional equipment or
music players and mobile phones. For the accessories when not in use because the
socket to supply current, the remote control battery could be drained in the event of such
key must be in at least key position I, see an occurrence!
page 80.
Electrical socket in cargo area*
IMPORTANT For more information, see page 279.
Max. socket is 10 A (120 W) if one socket is
used at a time. If both sockets are used
simultaneously, 7.5 A (90 W) per socket is
applicable.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 217


General information on infotainment..................................................... 220
Quick start............................................................................................. 222
General infotainment functions............................................................. 226
Radio..................................................................................................... 229
Media player......................................................................................... 236
External audio source via AUX/USB* input........................................... 240
Media BluetoothŸ* ................................................................................ 243
TV*......................................................................................................... 246
Remote control* ................................................................................... 249
BluetoothŸ handsfree*.......................................................................... 251
Voice recognition* mobile phone.......................................................... 259
Menu navigation, Infotainment.............................................................. 263

218 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


INFOTAINMENT SYSTEM
05 Infotainment system

General information on infotainment

General • AM/FM radio Made under license from Dolby Laboratories.


The infotainment system in your car has one of • CD/DVD Dolby, Pro Logic and the double-D symbol are
the following four levels: trademarks of Dolby Laboratories.
• AUX and USB input (for e.g. iPodŸ)
Audyssey MultEQ1
Performance • BluetoothŸ handsfree/streaming audio
• 5" TV screen TFT • 8 speakers
• Steering wheel keypad* without thumb- • 4x40W amplifier
wheel
• AM/FM radio Premium Sound Multimedia
• 7" TV screen TFT
• CD
• Steering wheel keypad* with thumbwheel
• AUX input
• AM/FM radio
• 6 speakers
• CD/DVD
• 4x20W amplifier
The Audyssey MultEQ system has been used
• AUX and USB input (for e.g. iPodŸ)
05 High Performance in the development and tuning of the sound to
• BluetoothŸ handsfree/streaming audio
ensure a world-class sound experience.
• 5" TV screen TFT
• 12 speakers
• Steering wheel keypad* with thumbwheel
• 5x130W amplifier Other
• AM/FM radio
• CD Dolby, Pro Logic If the Infotainment System is active when the
• AUX and USB input (for e.g. iPodŸ) engine is switched off then it is automatically
activated the next time the key is inserted into
• BluetoothŸ handsfree/streaming audio
position I or higher, and it continues with the
• 8 speakers same source (e.g. radio) as before the engine
• 4x40W amplifier was switched off (the driver's door must be
closed on cars with Keyless systems*).
High Performance Multimedia
The infotainment system can be used for 15
• 7" TV screen TFT minutes at a time without the remote control
• Steering wheel keypad* with thumbwheel
1 Only applies to Premium Sound Multimedia.

220 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


05 Infotainment system

General information on infotainment

key being in the ignition switch by pressing the


On/Off button.
While the engine is being started the infotain-
ment system is switched off temporarily and
continues once the engine has started.

NOTE
Avoid using the Infotainment system when
the engine is switched off as this loads the
battery.

05

221
05 Infotainment system

Quick start

Overview, Infotainment Operating the system Source buttons

AUX and USB1 inputs for external audio Short press starts the system and long Control panel with buttons for source selection.
sources (e.g. iPodŸ) press switches off. Briefly press to mute RADIO - Select, for example, AM, FM1,
05
the sound (MUTE) or restore the sound if it FM2, DAB1*, DAB2*
Steering wheel keypad*
had been switched off. MEDIA - Select, for example, Disc, USB*,
TV screen. The TV screen is available in Select a source by pressing one of the but- iPod, AUX, Bluetooth*, TV*.
two sizes, 5" (applies to Performance and tons (e.g. RADIO, MEDIA etc.). Press
High Performance) and 7" (applies to High TEL - BluetoothŸ handsfree*
repeatedly in order to scroll down among
Performance Multimedia and Premium the options on the TV screen (e.g. FM1), MY CAR - See page 144.
Sound Multimedia). The manual shows the release and wait a second and the selec-
7" TV screen. tion is accepted automatically. Alterna-
Centre console control panel tively, it is possible to turn TUNE and con-
firm with OK/MENU.
TUNE - turn to fast-scroll among disc
tracks/folders, radio and TV* stations,
phone contacts* or navigate through
options on the TV screen (e.g. FM1, Disc).

1 USB only applies to High Performance, High Performance Multimedia and Premium Sound Multimedia.

222 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


05 Infotainment system

Quick start

Basic functions, Infotainment OK/MENU - accepts selections in menus. The views have different appearances depend-
Lead to submenus in selected source (e.g. ing on the source, in-car equipment, settings,
RADIO or MEDIA). etc.
EXIT - leads up in the menu system, inter-
rupts the current function, rejects calls and
deletes input characters. One long press
leads to the highest menu level (parent
view), see page 224.
INFO - press the button to see more infor-
mation about a function, song, etc. For
more information, see page 226
FAV - shortcut to a favourite setting. The
Centre console with controls for basic functions. button can be programmed for a com-
monly used function in AM, FM, etc. For
SOUND - leads to the audio settings menu more information, see page 226. 05
(bass, treble, etc.). For more information, Example of normal view (Radio).
see page 226.
Views in the TV screen
VOL - turn to raise or lower the volume.
General information about views in the
- short press starts the system and
TV screen
long press switches off. Briefly press to
The system contains four different types of
mute the sound (MUTE) or restore the
views. A top-level menu, so-called Parent view,
sound if it had been switched off.
common to all sources, see page 224. For
Preset buttons, input of numbers and let- each source there are three different basic
ters. types of views:
TUNE - turn to fast-scroll among disc • Normal view - normal mode for the source
tracks/folders, radio and TV* stations,
phone contacts* or navigate through • Quick view - fast mode when TUNE is
turned, e.g. for changing disc tracks, radio Example of menu view (BluetoothŸ handsfree).
options on the TV screen.
station, etc.
• Menu view - for menu navigation
``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 223


05 Infotainment system

Quick start

Parent view • Select source (1) by turning the thumb- Steering wheel keypad*
wheel on the steering wheel keypad*, press The keypad is available in three different ver-
the thumbwheel to confirm the selection. sions depending on the options and the equip-
• Turn the thumbwheel to one of the options ment level of the car.
(2) on the TV screen (e.g. FM1), press the
thumbwheel to confirm the selection. Keypad without thumbwheel
This then leads to the desired source (e.g.
RADIO/FM1).
A long press on EXIT leads back.

NAV - Volvo's navigation system


(RTI)*
Example of parent view (Radio).
Sources (e.g. RADIO, MEDIA, etc.), see RADIO – Radio
05 table.
Source menu, e.g. (FM1, DISC, etc.). MEDIA – Media
A long press on EXIT on the steering wheel Short presses scroll between disc tracks
keypad* leads to the highest menu level, called or scan for the next available radio sta-
parent view (see illustration above). The func- TEL – BluetoothŸ handsfree*
tion2. Long presses are used to fast for-
tion is a quick way to choose or change the ward and rewind disc tracks.
source (e.g. RADIO, MEDIA etc.) directly from
MY CAR - Car settings Volume
the steering wheel keypad* without taking your
hands off the steering wheel. The function is
also available from the control panel buttons in
CAM - Park Assist Camera*
the centre console.

2 Does not apply to DAB.

224 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


05 Infotainment system

Quick start

Keypad with thumbwheel tion (OK) in the menu system, and accepts press leads to the highest menu level
phone calls. (parent view), see page 224.
MUTE - switches off the sound Thumbwheel - turn up/down to scroll up
and down in the menu system. One press
Keypad with thumbwheel, for voice on the thumbwheel leads to the menu
recognition3 (equivalent to MENU), or confirms a selec-
tion (OK) in the menu system, and accepts
phone calls.
Voice recognition (for BluetoothŸ-con-
nected mobile phone and navigation sys-
tem*)

Short presses scroll between disc tracks


or preset radio stations2. Long presses
05
are used to fast forward and rewind disc
tracks.
Volume
Short presses scroll between disc tracks
EXIT – leads up in the menu system. Inter-
or preset radio stations2. Long presses
rupt current function, end/refuse phone
are used to fast forward and rewind disc
calls, clear entered characters. One long
tracks.
press leads to the highest menu level
(parent view), see page 224. Volume
Thumbwheel - turn up/down to scroll up EXIT – leads up in the menu system. Inter-
and down in the menu system. One press rupt current function, end/refuse phone
on the thumbwheel leads to the menu calls, clear entered characters. One long
(equivalent to MENU), or confirms a selec-

2 Does not apply to DAB.


3 Only cars with navigation.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 225


05 Infotainment system

General infotainment functions

FAV - store a preset • Bluetooth* INFO - shows additional information


• AUX
• TV*
It is also possible to select and store a favourite
for TEL*, MY CAR, CAM* and NAV*. Favour-
ites can also be selected and stored under MY
CAR. For more information on the menu sys-
tem MY CAR, see page 144.
To store a function in the FAV button:
1. Select an infotainment source (e.g.
RADIO, MEDIA etc.).
2. Select a wavelength or source (AM, Disc,
The FAV button can be used to store functions etc.). In some cases there is more information avail-
05 that are used frequently so that the function able (on a radio station, song, artist, etc.) than
can be started simply by pressing FAV. You 3. Press and hold the FAV button until the can be shown in the TV screen. To see more
can select a favourite (e.g. Equalizer) for each "favourites menu" is shown. information, press the INFO button.
function as follows: 4. Turn TUNE to select an option from the list
In RADIO mode: and press OK/MENU to save. General audio settings
> When the source (e.g. RADIO, MEDIA Press SOUND to access the audio settings
• AM etc.) is active the stored function is menu (Bass, Treble, etc.). Scroll forward with
• FM1/FM2 available by means of a short press on SOUND or OK/MENU to your selection (e.g.
• DAB1*/DAB2* FAV. Treble).
In MEDIA mode: Adjust the setting by turning TUNE and save
• DISC the setting with OK/MENU.
• USB* Continue pressing SOUND or OK/MENU to
• iPod* access other options:

226 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


05 Infotainment system

General infotainment functions

• Surround1 - Can be set to the On/Off posi- Advanced audio settings For general information on menu navigation
tion. When On is selected, the system and menu structures, see page 263.
selects the setting for optimal sound repro- Equalizer3
duction. Normally DPLII and then The volume level can be adjusted separately Audio volume and automatic volume
appear in the TV screen. If the recording is for different wavelengths. control
made with Dolby Digital technology then The audio system compensates for disrupting
1. Press OK/MENU to access Audio
playback will take place with this setting, noises in the passenger compartment by
settings and select Equalizer.
then appears in the TV screen. increasing the volume in relation to the speed
When Off is selected, 3-channel stereo is 2. Select wavelength by turning TUNE and of the car. The compensation level can be set
available. confirm with OK/MENU. to low, medium, high or off. Select the level
under Audio settings Volume
• Bass - Bass level. 3. Adjust the volume level by turning TUNE
and confirm with OK/MENU. Continue in compensation.
• Treble - Treble level.
the same way with other wavelengths. For general information on menu navigation
• Fader – Balance between the front and and menu structures, see page 263.
rear speakers. 4. When you are finished with the settings,
turn TUNE OK and confirm by pressing 05
• Balance – Balance between the left and OK/MENU or EXIT.
External audio source audio volume
right-hand speakers. If an external audio source (e.g. an MP3 player
• DPL II center level3 channel center For general information on menu navigation or iPodŸ) is connected to the AUX input then
level1 - Volume for centre speaker. and menu structures, see page 263. the audio source that is connected can have a
different volume than the audio system's inter-
• DPL II surround level1, 2 – Level for sur- Sound stage1
round. nal volume (e.g. radio). Correct this by adjust-
The sound experience can be optimised for the ing the volume of the input:
driver's seat, both front seats or the rear seat.
If there are passengers in both the front and 1. Press the MEDIA button and turn TUNE to
rear seats then the option recommended is; AUX and wait a few seconds or press OK/
both front seats. The options can be selected MENU.
under Audio settings Sound stage.

1 Only Premium Sound Multimedia.


2 Only when Surround is activated.
3 Not Performance.
``

227
05 Infotainment system

General infotainment functions

2. Press OK/MENU and then turn TUNE to able to adapt the sound reproduction accord-
AUX input volume. Confirm with OK/ ing to personal taste.
MENU.
3. Turn TUNE to adjust the volume for the
AUX input.

NOTE
If the external audio source's volume is too
high or too low, the quality of the sound may
deteriorate. The audio quality may also be
impaired if the player is charged while the
infotainment system is in AUX mode. In
which case, avoid charging the player via
the 12 V socket.
05
Optimum sound reproduction
The audio system is pre-calibrated for opti-
mum sound reproduction by means of digital
signal processing.
This calibration takes into account loudspeak-
ers, amplifiers, passenger compartment
acoustics, listener position etc. for each com-
bination of car model and audio system.
There is a also a dynamic calibration that takes
into account the position of the volume control,
radio reception and vehicle speed.
The controls explained in these operating
instructions, e.g. Bass, Treble and
Equalizer, are only intended for the user to be

228
05 Infotainment system

Radio

Radio functions, general NOTE Station list1


The radio automatically compiles a list of the
If the car is equipped with a steering wheel
strongest FM stations whose signals it is cur-
keypad* and/or remote control* then in
many cases these can be used instead of rently receiving. This enables you to find a sta-
the buttons in the centre console. For a tion when you drive into an area where you do
description of the buttons in the steering not know the radio stations and their frequen-
wheel, see page 224. For a description of cies.
the remote control, see page 249.
To go to the list and select a station:

Menus 1. Select the desired wavelength (FM1 or


The menus inRADIO are controlled from the FM2).
centre console and the steering wheel key- 2. Turn TUNE one step in either direction.
pad*. For general information on menu naviga- This displays the list of all stations in the
Centre console, controls for radio functions. tion and menu structures, see page 263. area. The currently tuned station is indi-
RADIO button for selecting the wavelength cated with enlarged text in the list.
05
(AM, FM1, FM2, DAB1*, DAB2*). Radio AM/FM 3. Turn TUNE again in either direction to
Station presets (0-9) select a station from the list.
Tuning
Select the desired frequency/station or
Automatic tuning
navigate in the radio menu by turning
1. Repeatedly press on the RADIO button
TUNE.
until the desired wavelength (AM, FM1
Confirm your selection or go to the radio etc.) is shown, release and wait a second
menu by pressing OK/MENU. or press OK/MENU.
Hold in the button for next/previous avail- 2. Hold in / in the centre console (or
able station. Short press for preset.
in the steering wheel keypad*). The radio
searches for the next/previous available
station.

1 Only applies to FM1/FM2.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 229


05 Infotainment system

Radio

NOTE in the area when you turn TUNE (see the sec- NOTE
tion "Station list", page 229). When the station
• The list only shows the frequencies of list is shown, press the button in the cen- The preset from the factory is that the radio
stations that are currently being automatically searches for the stations in
tre console to change to manual tuning. This the area where you are driving (see previous
received, not a complete list of all radio
allows you to select a frequency from the list of section "Station list" above).
frequencies on the selected wave-
length. all available radio frequencies in the selected
But if you have changed over to manual tun-
wavelength. In other words, if turn TUNE one
• If the signal from the currently received ing (by pressing the button in the cen-
step in a manual search the frequency is
station is weak, this may prevent the tre console when the station list was
changed from e.g. 93.3 to 93.4 MHz, etc. shown), then the radio remains set in the
radio from updating the station list. If
this occurs, press the button To manually select a station: function for manual tuning the next time you
switch on the radio. To change back to the
(while the station list is shown in the dis- 1. Repeatedly press on the RADIO button function for "Station list", turn TUNE one
play screen) in order to change to man- until the desired wavelength (AM, FM1 step (to show the complete list of stations)
ual tuning and set a frequency. If the etc.) is shown, release and wait a second and press the button .
station list is no longer shown, turn or press OK/MENU.
05 TUNE one step in either direction to Note that if you press when the sta-
show the list again, and press to 2. Turn TUNE to select a frequency. tion list is not shown then INFO is activated.
switch. For more information on this function, see
page 226.

The list disappears from the TV screen after a


few seconds.
Preset
10 presets can be stored per wavelength
If the station list is no longer shown, turn (AM, FM1 etc.).
TUNE one step in either direction and press the
The stored presets are selected using the pre-
button in the centre console to change
set buttons.
to manual tuning (or to return from manual tun-
ing to the function for "Station list"). 1. Tune into a station (see "Tuning", page
229).
Manual tuning
The preset from the factory is that the radio 2. Hold in one of the preset buttons for a few
shows the station list of the strongest stations seconds, the sound disappears during this

230
05 Infotainment system

Radio

time and returns when the station is stored. • Automatically switches to a stronger trans- rupted audio source, press the OK/MENU to
The preset button can now be used. mitter if reception in the area is poor. clear the message.
A list of pre-selected channels can be shown2 • Searches for programme type, such as Alarm
in the TV screen. The function is activated/ traffic information or news.
This function is used to warn of serious acci-
deactivated in FM/AM mode under FM menu • Receives text information on current radio dents and catastrophes. The alarm cannot be
Show presets or AM menu Show programme. temporarily interrupted or deactivated. The
presets. message ALARM! appears on the TV screen
NOTE when an alarm message is transmitted.
Scan wavelength
Some radio stations do not use RDS or only
The function automatically searches the cur- some if its functionality. Traffic information – TP
rent wavelength for strong stations. When a This function allows traffic information sent
station is found, it is played for approx. 8 sec- within a set station's RDS network to break
onds before scanning is resumed. When a sta- If a required programme type is located the
through. The TP symbol indicates that the
tion is playing back it can be saved as a preset radio can switch stations interrupting the audio
function is activated. If the preset station can
in the usual way, see the section "Pre- source currently in use. For example, if the CD
send traffic information then this is shown by
player is in use, it is paused. The interrupting 05
set" above. TP glowing brightly in the TV screen, otherwise
transmission is played at a preset volume, see
– To start scanning go in FM/AM mode to TP will be grey.
page 233. The radio returns to the previous
FM menu Scan or AM menu Scan. audio source and volume when the set pro- – Activate/deactivate in FM mode under FM
gramme type is no longer broadcast. menu TP.
NOTE The programme functions alarm (ALARM!), Enhanced Other Networks – EON
Scanning stops if a station is saved. traffic information (TP), news (NEWS), and pro- This function is useful in urban areas with many
gramme types (PTY) interrupt one another in regional radio stations. It allows the distance
order of priority, where alarm has the highest between the car and the radio station trans-
RDS functions
priority and programme types has the lowest. mitter to determine when programme functions
RDS (Radio Data System) links FM transmitters
For additional settings of programming inter- should interrupt the current audio source.
into a network. An FM transmitter in such a
ruptions (EON Distant and EON Local), see
network sends information that gives an RDS
the section "Enhanced Other Networks –
radio the following functions:
EON" below. Press EXIT to return to the inter-

2 Only applies to High Performance Multimedia and Premium Sound Multimedia.

231
05 Infotainment system

Radio

– Activate/deactivate in FM mode by select- – Go in FM mode to FM menu News Resetting and removing PTY are performed
ing one of the options under FM menu settings Set news favourite to change. under FM menu Advanced settings
Advanced settings EON: PTY settings Select PTY Clear all.
Programme types – PTY
• Local – interrupts only if the radio station The PTY function can be used to select one or PTY search
transmitter is close.
more programme types, such as pop music This function searches the entire wavelength
• Distant3 – interrupts if the station trans- and serious classic. The PTY symbol indicates for the selected programme type.
mitter is far away, even if there is a lot of that the function is active. This function allows
static. 1. In FM mode select one or more PTY under
programme types broadcast within a set sta-
FM menu Advanced settings PTY
tion's RDS network to break through.
TP from selected station/all stations settings Select PTY.
The radio can only interrupt for traffic informa- 1. Activate in FM mode by first selecting the
tion from the selected station or all stations programme types under FM menu 2. Go to FM menu Advanced settings
within the RDS network. Advanced settings PTY settings PTY settings Seek PTY.
– Go in FM mode to FM menu Advanced Select PTY. To finish searching, press EXIT.
05 settings Set TP favourite to change. 2. Then the PTY function must be activated – To continue searching for another broad-
under FM menu Advanced settings cast of the selected programme types,
News
PTY settings Receive traffic press on or .
This function allows news broadcasts sent
within a set station's RDS network to break bulletins from other networks.
Display of programme type
through. The NEWS symbol indicates that the An indicator is shown in the TV screen when The programme type of the current station can
function is active. PTY is activated. be shown on the TV screen.
– Activate/deactivate in FM mode under FM Deactivation of the PTY function is performed – Activate/deactivate in FM mode under FM
menu News settings News. in FM mode under FM menu Advanced menu Advanced settings PTY
settings PTY settings Receive traffic settings Show PTY text.
News from selected station/all stations
bulletins from other networks. Selected pro-
The radio can only interrupt for news from the
gramme types (PTY) are not reset.
selected station or all stations in the RDS net-
work.

3 Factory settings.

232
05 Infotainment system

Radio

Radio text – The reset is carried out in FM mode under Service and Ensemble
Some RDS stations transmit information on FM menu Advanced settings • Service - Channel, radio channel (only
programme content, artists, etc. This informa- Reset all FM settings. audio services are supported by the sys-
tion can be shown on the TV screen. tem).
Volume control, programme types • Ensemble - A collection of radio channels
– Activate/deactivate in FM mode under FM
The interrupting programme types, e.g. on the same frequency.
menu Show radio text. NEWS or TP, are heard at the volume selected
for each respective programme type. If the vol- Storing channel groups (Ensemble learn)
Automatic frequency update – AF
ume level is adjusted during the programme When the vehicle is moved to a new broad-
The function selects the strongest transmitter
interruption, the new level is saved until the casting area, programming of existing channel
for the set station. In order to find a strong
next programme interruption. groups in the area may be necessary.
transmitter the function may, in exceptional
cases, need to search the entire FM wave- Programming of channel groups creates an
length. Radio system - DAB* updated list of all available channel groups.
The list is not updated automatically.
– Activate/deactivate in FM mode under FM General
menu Advanced settings DAB (Digital Audio Broadcasting) is a digital Programming is carried out in the menu system 05
Alternative frequency. broadcasting system for radio. in DAB mode under DAB menu Ensemble
learn. Programming can also take place as fol-
Regional radio programmes – REG NOTE lows:
This function causes the radio to continue with
This system does not support DAB+. 1. Turn TUNE one step in either direction.
a regional transmitter even if its signal strength
is low. The symbol REG shows that the func- > Ensemble learn is shown in the list of
tion is active. available channel groups.
NOTE
– Activate/deactivate in FM mode under FM 2. Press OK/MENU.
Coverage for DAB is not available in all loca-
menu Advanced settings REG. tions. If there is no coverage then the mes- > New programming is started.
sage No reception is shown in the display Programming can be cancelled with EXIT.
Resetting RDS functions screen.
All radio settings can be reset to the original If can take up to a minute to program a channel
factory settings. group if both Band III and LBand are selected.
For more information on wavelength, see
page 235.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 233


05 Infotainment system

Radio

Navigation in channel group list Scanning can also be selected in DAB-PTY A preset contains one channel but no sub-
(Ensemble) mode. In which case only channels of the pre- channels. If a subchannel is being played and
To navigate in and access the channel group selected programme type are played. a preset is saved then only the main channel is
list turn TUNE. The name of the Ensemble is registered. This is because subchannels are
shown in the upper part of the TV screen. When
Programme type (PTY) temporary. At the next attempt to retrieve the
Various types of radio programmes can be preset, the channel which contained the sub-
scrolling to the new Ensemble the name
selected using the programme type function. channel will be played. The preset is not
changes to the new one. A thick grey line sep-
There are a number of different programme dependent on the channel list.
arates the two channel groups from each other.
types which also include different programme
• Service - Shows channels irrespective of categories. After selecting a programme type, A list of pre-selected channels can be shown4
the channel group to which they are allo- navigation only takes place within the channels in the TV screen. The function is activated/
cated. The list can also be filtered using the that are broadcasting that type. deactivated in DAB mode under DAB menu
selection of programme type (PTY Show presets.
filtering), see below. Programme type is selected in DAB mode
under DAB menu PTY filtering. Exit this
Scanning NOTE
mode as follows:
05 The function automatically searches the cur- The audio system's DAB system does not
rent wavelength for strong stations. When a – Press EXIT. support all functions available in the DAB
station is found, it is played for approx. 8 sec- > An indicator is shown in the TV screen standard.
onds before scanning is resumed. When a sta- when PTY is activated.
tion is playing back it is saved as a preset in the In certain cases DAB radio will exit PTY mode Radio text
usual way. For more information on presets, when DAB to DAB linking (see below) is imple- Some radio stations transmit information on
see "Preset" below. mented. programme content, artists, etc. This informa-
– Go in DAB mode to DAB menu Scan to tion is shown on the TV screen.
Preset
start scanning. 10 station presets can be stored per wave- The function is deactivated/activated in DAB
length. DAB has 2 memories for presets: mode under DAB menu Show radio text.
NOTE DAB1 and DAB2. Storing of presets is per-
Scanning stops if a station is saved. formed in the usual way, for more information
see page 230. The stored presets are selected
using the preset buttons.

4 Only applies to High Performance Multimedia and Premium Sound Multimedia

234
05 Infotainment system

Radio

NOTE quickly than if both Band III and LBand have gory. This information is shown on the TV
been selected. It is not certain that all channel screen.
Only one of the functions "Show radio groups will be found. Wavelength selection
text" and "Show presets" can be acti- The function is activated/deactivated in DAB
does not affect the stored memories.
vated at a time. If one of them is activated mode under DAB menu Advanced
when the other is already activated, then the Wavelengths can be deactivated/activated in settings Show PTY text.
previously activated function is deactivated DAB mode under DAB menu Advanced
automatically. Both functions can be deac- Resetting the DAB settings
tivated. settings DAB band.
All DAB settings can be reset to the original
Subchannel factory settings.
Advanced settings Secondary components are usually named
– The reset is carried out in DAB mode under
subchannels. These are temporary and can
DAB to DAB link DAB menu Advanced settings
contain e.g. translations of the main pro-
It is possible to exit a channel with poor or no gramme into other languages. Reset all DAB settings.
reception to the same channel in another chan-
nel group with better reception. There may be If one or more subchannels are broadcast then
a certain delay when changing channel group. the > symbol is shown to the left of the channel 05
There may be a period of silence between the name in the TV screen. A subchannel is indi-
current channel no longer being available to the cated by the - symbol appearing to the left of
new channel becoming available. the channel name in the TV screen.
The function can be activated/deactivated in Subchannels can only be accessed on the
DAB mode under DAB menu Advanced selected main channel and not on any other
channel without selecting it.
settings DAB linking.
Display of subchannels can be deactivated/
Wavelength
activated in DAB mode under DAB menu
DAB can be transmitted on two5 wavelengths:
Advanced settings Sub channels
• Band III - covers areas outside big cities
Programme type text
• LBand - mainly in large cities Some radio stations broadcast information
By selecting for example Band III on its own, about programme type and programme cate-
channel programming takes place more

5 Not all areas/countries use both wavelengths.

235
05 Infotainment system

Media player

CD/DVD1 functions The media player supports and can play the Starting playback of a disc
following main types of discs and files: Repeatedly press on the MEDIA button until
• Pre-recorded CD discs (CD Audio). Disc is shown, release and wait a second or
press OK/MENU. If there is a disc in the media
• Burned CD discs with audio and/or video player then the disc starts playing back auto-
files1.
matically, otherwise Insert disc is shown in the
• Pre-recorded DVD video discs1. TV screen. Then insert a disc, with text side up.
• Burned DVD discs1 with audio and/or video The disc starts to play back automatically.
files. If a disc with audio/video files is inserted into
For more information about the supported for- the player then the disc's folder structure
mats, see page 239. needs to be loaded. Depending on the quality
of the disc and the quantity of information there
NOTE may be a certain delay before playback starts.
Centre console control panel.
If the car is equipped with a steering wheel Disc eject
05
Disc insert and eject slot
keypad* and/or remote control* then in A disc remains in the ejected position for
MEDIA key many cases these can be used instead of about 12 seconds, after which it is inserted
the buttons in the centre console. For a
description of the buttons in the steering back into the player for safety reasons.
Disc eject
wheel, see page 224. For a description of
Input of numbers and letters. the remote control, see page 249. Pause
When the volume is turned down completely
Select the disc tracks/folders, or navigate the media player is paused. When the volume
through menu options by turning TUNE. Menus is increased, it starts again.
The menus inMEDIA are controlled from the
Confirm your selection or go to the menu
centre console and the steering wheel key- Playback and navigation
for the selected media source by pressing
pad*. For general information on menu naviga- CD audio discs
OK/MENU.
tion and menu structures, see page 263. Turn TUNE to access the disc's playlist and
Fast forward/reverse and change disc
navigate in the list. Use OK/MENU to confirm
track or chapter2.
the selection of the disc track and start play-

1 Only applies to High Performance Multimedia and Premium Sound Multimedia.


2 Only applies to DVD discs.

236 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


05 Infotainment system

Media player

back. Press EXIT to cancel and exit the playlist. the current folder have been played back. The DVD video discs1
A long press on EXIT leads to the playlist's root system automatically detects and changes For playback of DVD video discs, see
level. setting when a disc containing only audio files page 238.
or only video files is loaded into the media
Disc tracks can also be changed by pressing
player and then plays back these files. How- Fast forward/reverse
on / on the centre console or the
ever, the system does not change setting if a Hold in the buttons / to fast forward/
steering wheel keypad*. disc containing a mixture of audio and video rewind. Audio files are fast forwarded/rewound
Burned discs audio/video files1 files is loaded into the media player, but instead at one speed, while video files are fast forwar-
Turn TUNE to access the disc's playlist/folder the player continues to play back the previous ded/rewound at several speeds. Repeatedly
structure and navigate in the list/structure. Use file type. press the buttons / to increase the fast
OK/MENU to confirm either selection of sub- forward/rewind speed for video files. Release
folder or start of playback of the selected NOTE the button to return to viewing at normal speed.
audio/video file. Press EXIT to either stop and
A video film is only shown when the car is
exit the playlist or go up (back) in the folder stationary. When the car is moving at a Music recognition, GracenoteŸ
structure. A long press on EXIT leads to the speed of over about 8 km/h no picture is If the car is equipped with navigation* then
playlist's root level. shown and No visual media available there is a hard drive in the car that contains a 05
Audio/video files can also be changed by during driving appears on the display database for music recognition of CD audio
screen, although the audio is heard during discs. The database contains the most popular
pressing / on the centre console or the this time. The picture is shown again as songs at the moment. If the media player gets
steering wheel keypad*. soon as the car's speed falls below about 6 a hit in the database then the album title and
km/h.
Audio files have the symbol , video files1 artist name for the media are displayed, and
have the symbol and folders have the each track shows track title, artist and album.
NOTE If the current CD audio disc is not found in the
symbol .
database then the CD text from the disc is
Some audio files that are copy-protected by used. If there is no CD text on the disc then only
When playback of a file is complete the play- record companies or privately copied audio
back of the other files (of the same type) in that files cannot be loaded by the player. Track 1, Track 2 etc. is displayed.
particular folder continues. Change3 of folder
takes place automatically when all the files in

1 Only applies to High Performance Multimedia and Premium Sound Multimedia.


3 If Repeat folder is activated then this does not take place.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 237


05 Infotainment system

Media player

Scan4 has been played out, playback of the first file Navigation in the DVD video disc's menu
This function plays the first ten seconds of starts again.
each disc track/audio file. To scan: 1. Press OK/MENU
1. Press OK/MENU 2. Turn TUNE to Repeat folder
2. Turn TUNE to Scan 3. Press OK/MENU to activate/deactivate
> The first 10 seconds of each disc track the function.
or audio file are played.
Playback of DVD video discs1
3. Cancel the scan with EXIT, the disc track
or audio file being played back will con- Playback
tinue playing. When playing back a DVD video disc a disc
menu may appear on the display screen. The
Random4 disc menu gives access to additional functions
This function plays the tracks in random order. and settings, such as selecting subtitles, lan- Navigation in the DVD video disc's menu is
To listen to the tracks in random order: guage and scene selection. performed using the number keys in the centre
05
1. Press OK/MENU console as illustrated above.
NOTE Changing chapter or title
2. Turn TUNE to Random
A video film is only shown when the car is Turn TUNE to access the list of chapters and
3. Press OK/MENU to activate/deactivate stationary. When the car is moving at a navigate through them (if the film is being
the function. speed of over about 8 km/h no picture is played back then it is paused). Press OK/
shown and No visual media available MENU to select the chapter, this also leads
Disc tracks/audio files can be changed by during driving appears on the display
pressing / on the centre console or the back to the original position (if the film was
screen, although the audio is heard during
being played back then it is restarted). Press
steering wheel keypad*. this time. The picture is shown again as
soon as the car's speed falls below about 6 EXIT to access the title list.
Repeat folder5 km/h. Titles are selected in the title list by turning
This function makes it possible to play files in TUNE and the selection is confirmed with OK/
a folder over and over again. When the last file MENU, this also leads back to the chapter list.

4 Does not apply to DVD video discs.


5 Only applies to audio/video files on burned discs or USB.
1 Only applies to High Performance Multimedia and Premium Sound Multimedia.

238 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


05 Infotainment system

Media player

Press OK/MENU to activate the selection and Picture settings6 Audio formatA CD audio, mp3,
return to the start position. Use EXIT to cancel You can adjust the settings (when the car is wma
the selection and this leads back to the original stationary) for brightness and contrast.
position (without any selection being made). Audio formatB CD audio, mp3,
1. Press OK/MENU and select Image
wma, aac, m4a
The chapter can also be changed by pressing settings, confirm with OK/MENU.
on / on the centre console or the Video formatC CD video,
2. Turn TUNE to the adjustment option and
steering wheel keypad*. DVD video, divx, avi,
confirm with OK/MENU.
asf
Advanced settings6 3. Adjust the setting by turning TUNE and
A Applies to Performance.
Angle confirm with OK/MENU. B Does not apply to Performance.
C Only applies to High Performance Multimedia and Premium
If the DVD video disc supports it, the function To return to the settings list, press the OK/ Sound Multimedia.
can be used to choose from which camera MENU or EXIT.
position a particular scene should be shown.
The picture settings can be reset to factory
Go in disc mode to Disc menu Advanced
settings with the Reset option.
settings Angle. 05
Compatible file formats
DivXŸ Video On Demand
The media player can play back a variety of file
The media player can be registered in order to
types and is compatible with the formats in the
play DivX VOD type files from burned discs or
following table.
USB. The code for registration can be found in
the menu system MY CAR Settings
NOTE
Information DivX® VOD code. For general
information on menus, see under MY CAR, see Dual format, double-sided discs (DVD Plus,
page 144. CD-DVD format) are thicker than regular CD
discs and therefore playback cannot be
For more information visit www.divx.com/vod. guaranteed and malfunction may arise.
If a CD contains a mixture of MP3 and CDDA
tracks, all MP3s will be ignored.

6 Applies to High Performance Multimedia and Premium Sound Multimedia.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 239


05 Infotainment system

External audio source via AUX/USB* input

AUX, USB1 and external audio source NOTE The text Reading USB is shown in the TV
screen when the system is loading the storage
General If the car is equipped with a steering wheel media's file structure. Depending on the file
keypad* and/or remote control* then in
structure and number of files there may be
many cases these can be used instead of
the buttons in the centre console. For a some delay before loading is finished.
description of the buttons in the steering
wheel, see page 224. For a description of NOTE
the remote control, see page 249.
The system supports most iPodŸ models
produced in 2005 or later.
An iPodŸ or MP3 player with rechargeable bat-
teries is recharged (when the ignition is on or
the engine is running) if the device is plugged NOTE
into the USB connection. To prevent damage to the USB connection,
To connect the audio source: this is shut off if the USB connection is
short-circuited or if a connected USB unit is
05 Connection points for external audio sources. 1. Repeatedly press on MEDIA to reach the taking too much power (this may happen if
An external audio source, e.g. an iPodŸ or MP3 desired audio source USB, iPod or AUX, the unit connected does not meet the USB
player, can be connected to the audio system release and wait a second or press OK/ standard). The USB connection is reactiva-
ted automatically the next time the ignition
via any of the connections in the centre con- MENU.
is turned on, unless the fault persists.
sole. An audio source connected to the USB > If USB is selected then Connect USB is
input can then be handled2 with the car's audio shown in the TV screen.
controls. A device connected via the AUX input Menus
2. Connect your audio source to one of the The menus inMEDIA are controlled from the
cannot be controlled via the car.
connections in the centre console's stor- centre console and the steering wheel key-
age compartment (see previous illustra- pad*. For general information on menu naviga-
tion). tion and menu structures, see page 263.

1 Applies to High Performance, High Performance Multimedia and Premium Sound Multimedia.
2 Only applies to the media source connected via the USB connection.

240 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


05 Infotainment system

External audio source via AUX/USB* input

Playback and navigation3 the player continues to play back the previous Audio sources
Turn TUNE to access the playlist/folder struc- file type.
USB memory
ture and navigate in the list/structure. Use OK/ To facilitate the use of a USB memory stick,
MENU to either confirm selection of subfolder Fast forward/reverse3
See page 237. only store music files on it. It takes a lot longer
or start of playback of the selected audio/video for the system to load storage media that con-
file. Press EXIT to either stop and exit the play- tains anything other than compatible music
Scan3
list or go up (back) in the folder structure. A long files.
See page 238.
press on EXIT leads to the playlist's root level.
Audio/video files can also be changed by Random3 NOTE
pressing / on the centre console or the See page 238. The system supports mobile media compli-
steering wheel keypad*. ant with USB 2.0 and the FAT32 file system
Search function3 and can handle 1000 folders with a maxi-
Audio files have the symbol , video files4 The keypad on the control panel in the centre mum of 254 subfolders/files in every folder.
have the symbol and folders have the console can be used to find a filename in the The top level, which can handle up to 1000
current folder. subfolders/files, is an exception to this.
symbol . 05
The search function is accessed either by turn-
When playback of a file is complete the play- NOTE
ing TUNE (to access the folder structure) or by
back of the other files (of the same type) in that
pressing one of the letter keys. As a letter or When using a longer model USB memory
particular folder continues. Change5 of folder character in a search string is entered you get
takes place automatically when all the files in stick the use of a USB adapter cable is rec-
closer to your search target. ommended. This is to avoid mechanical
the current folder have been played back. The wear to the USB input and the connected
system automatically detects and changes Start playback of a file by pressing OK/ USB memory stick.
setting when a device containing only audio MENU.
files or only video files is connected to the USB
port and then it plays back these files. How- Repeat folder6 USB hub
ever, the system does not change setting if a See page 238. It is possible to connect a USB hub to the USB
device containing a mixture of audio and video connection and thereby connect multiple USB
files is connected to the USB port, but instead devices simultaneously. Selection of USB

3 Only applies to USB and iPodŸ.


4 Applies to High Performance Multimedia and Premium Sound Multimedia.
5 If Repeat folder is activated then this does not take place.
6 Only applies to USB.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 241


05 Infotainment system

External audio source via AUX/USB* input

device is made in USB mode under USB menu Audio format mp3, wma, aac,
Select USB device. m4a
MP3 player
Video formatA divx, avi, asf
Many MP3 players have their own file systems
that are not supported by the audio system. For A Only applies to High Performance Multimedia and Premium
Sound Multimedia.
use in the system, an MP3 player must be set
in USB Removable device/Mass Storage
Device mode.
iPodŸ
An iPodŸ is charged and supplied with power
by the USB connection* via the player's con-
nection cable.

NOTE
05
The system only supports the playback of
audio files from iPodŸ.

NOTE
When an iPodŸ is used as audio source, the
car's infotainment system has a menu
structure that is similar to the iPodŸ player's
own menu structure.

Compatible file formats via the USB


connection
Audio and video files in the following table are
supported by the system for playback via the
USB connection.

242 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


05 Infotainment system

Media BluetoothŸ*

Streaming audio NOTE Overview


General The BluetoothŸ media player must support
The car's media player is equipped with the Audio/Video Remote Control Profile
BluetoothŸ1 and can wirelessly play streaming (AVRCP) and Advanced Audio Distribution
Profile (A2DP). The player should use
audio files from external devices with
AVRCP version 1.3, A2DP 1.2. Otherwise
BluetoothŸ, such as mobile phones and PDAs. some functions may not work.
Navigation and control of the sound can be
Not all mobile phones and external media
carried out via the centre console buttons or via
players available in the market are fully com-
the steering wheel keypad*. In some external
patible with the BluetoothŸ function in the
devices it is also possible to change tracks car's media player. Volvo recommends that
from the device. you contact an authorised Volvo dealer or
To play back the audio the car's media player visit www.volvocars.com for information on
compatible phones and external media Centre console control panel.
must first be set in Bluetooth mode. players.
VOL – volume
05
NOTE MEDIA key

The car's media player can only play the Navigate in the menu by turning TUNE.
audio files via the BluetoothŸ function.
Confirm your selection or go to the menu
by pressing OK/MENU.
EXIT - leads up in the menu system, stops
the function in progress.
Short presses are used to scroll between
audio files. Long presses are used to fast
forward and rewind audio files.

1 Applies to High Performance, High Performance Multimedia and Premium Sound Multimedia.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 243


05 Infotainment system

Media BluetoothŸ*

NOTE 4. Check that the external device is searcha- nect a new external device, see "Change to
ble/visible via BluetoothŸ, see the manual another external device" below.
If the car is equipped with a steering wheel for the external device.
keypad* and/or remote control* then in Change to another external device
many cases these can be used instead of 5. Press OK/MENU. It is possible to change a connected device
the buttons in the centre console. For a > The infotainment system searches for with another device if there are several devices
description of the buttons in the steering
wheel, see page 224. For a description of external devices in the vicinity. The in the car. However, the device must first have
the remote control, see page 249. search may take a little while. The devi- been paired, see "Pair and connect external
ces detected are specified with their device" above. To change to another device:
respective BluetoothŸ name in the cen- 1. Repeatedly press on MEDIA until
Menus tre console TV screen.
The menus inMEDIA are controlled from the Bluetooth is shown, release and wait a
centre console and the steering wheel key- 6. Select the external device you want to pair second or press OK/MENU.
pad*. For general information on menu naviga- with and press OK/MENU.
2. Check that the external device is searcha-
tion and menu structures, see page 263. 7. Enter the series of numbers that is shown ble/visible via BluetoothŸ, see the manual
05 in the centre console TV screen via the for the external device.
Pair and connect external device
external device's keypad and press the
The connection of an external device takes 3. Press OK/MENU.
external device's button to confirm the
place in different ways depending on whether
selection. 4. Turn TUNE to Change device, and con-
or not it has been previously paired. A maxi-
firm with OK/MENU.
mum of 10 external devices can be paired. The external device is paired and connected
Pairing takes place once per external device. automatically to the infotainment system. > After a while, the external device's name
To connect a device for the first time, follow the is shown in the TV screen. If several
Change audio file by pressing / on the external devices have been paired then
instructions below:
centre console or the steering wheel keypad*. these are also shown.
1. Repeatedly press on MEDIA until
Bluetooth is shown, release and wait a Automatic connection 5. Select the device to be connected by turn-
second or press OK/MENU. When the BluetoothŸ function is active and the ing TUNE and confirm with OK/MENU.
last external device connected is in range it is > Connection of the external device takes
2. Press OK/MENU.
connected automatically. When the infotain- place.
3. When Add device is shown, press OK/ ment system searches for the last device con-
Change audio file by pressing / on the
MENU. nected its name is shown in the TV screen. To
centre console or the steering wheel keypad*.
connect to another device, press EXIT. Con-

244 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


05 Infotainment system

Media BluetoothŸ*

Remove the connected device tion in Bluetooth mode under Bluetooth menu
1. Press Bluetooth mode on OK/MENU. Scan.
2. Turn TUNE to Remove Bluetooth Cancel scanning with EXIT.
device and confirm with OK/MENU.
Version information BluetoothŸ
3. Select the device to be removed by turning
The car's current BluetoothŸ version can be
TUNE, and confirm with OK/MENU.
seen in Bluetooth mode under Bluetooth
> A prompt asking whether or not you
menu Bluetooth software version in car.
want to remove the connection is shown
in the TV screen.
4. Press OK/MENU to confirm.
EXIT cancels.

Disconnecting the device


Automatic disconnection takes place if the 05
external device moves out of the infotainment
system's range. For more information on con-
nection, see page 244.

Random
This function plays back the audio files on the
external device in random order. Activate/
deactivate the random function in Bluetooth
mode under Bluetooth menu Random.
Change audio file by pressing / on the
centre console or the steering wheel keypad*.

Scanning of audio files in external device


This function play backs the first ten seconds
of each audio file. Activate/deactivate the func-

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 245


05 Infotainment system

TV*

TV* IMPORTANT NOTE


General A TV licence is required for this product in If the car is equipped with a steering wheel
some countries. keypad* and/or remote control* then in
many cases these can be used instead of
NOTE the buttons in the centre console. For a
This system only supports TV transmissions
Overview description of the buttons in the steering
in countries which transmit signals in wheel, see page 224. For a description of
mpeg-2 format and follow the DVB-T stand- the remote control, see page 249.
ard. The system does not support TV trans-
missions in mpeg-4 format or analogue
transmissions.
Menus
The menus inMEDIA are controlled from the
centre console and the steering wheel key-
NOTE pad*. For general information on menu naviga-
tion and menu structures, see page 263.
The TV picture is only shown when the car
05 is stationary. When the car is moving at a
speed over about 6 km/h the picture disap-
Watch TV
pears, No visual media available during If this is the first time the TV function is used or
driving appears on the display screen, the country of residence has changed then the
although the audio is heard during this time. Centre console control panel. setting of TV channels must first be carried out.
The picture reappears when the car has MEDIA key. To set the TV channels to see the sec-
stopped. tion "Searching TV channels/Preset list" page
Station presets, numeric input 247.
NOTE Navigate in channel lists or menus by turn- – Repeatedly press on MEDIA until TV is
ing TUNE. shown in the TV screen, release the button
The reception is dependent both on how
good the signal strength and signal quality Confirm your selection or go to the menu and wait a second or press OK/MENU.
are. The transmission may be disturbed by by pressing OK/MENU. > A search starts and after a short while
various factors such as tall buildings or the EXIT - leads up in the menu system, stops the most recently used channel is
TV transmitter being far away. Coverage shown.
level can also vary depending on where in the function in progress.
the country you are located. The next available channel is shown by Changing channel
pressing / . It is possible to change channel as follows:

246 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


05 Infotainment system

TV*

• Turn TUNE, a list of all available channels Searching TV channels/Preset list NOTE
in the area is shown. If any of these chan- 1. Press TV mode on OK/MENU.
nels is already saved as a preset then its If the country of residence has changed, a
preset number is shown to the right of the 2. Turn TUNE to TV menu and press OK/ new scan of TV channels must be run.
channel name. Continue turning TUNE to MENU.
reach the desired channel and press OK/ 3. Turn TUNE to Select country and press Channel management
MENU. OK/MENU. The preset list can be edited. You can change
• By pressing the preset buttons (0-9). > If one or more countries have previously the order of the channels that are shown in the
• Via a short press on the / buttons been selected then they are shown in a preset list. A TV channel can have more than
list. one place in the preset list. The TV channel
the next available channel in the area is
shown. positions can also vary in the preset list.
4. Turn TUNE to either Other countries or
one of the previously selected countries. To change the order in the preset list, go in TV
NOTE Press OK/MENU. mode to TV menu Reorganize presets.
If the car has been moved within the coun- > A list of all available countries is shown. 1. Turn TUNE to the channel you want to
try, for example, from one city to another, it move in the list and confirm with OK/ 05
is not certain that the presets are available 5. Turn TUNE to the desired country (e.g.
Sweden) and press OK/MENU. MENU.
at the new location as the frequency range
may have changed. In which case, carry out > An automatic scan for available TV > The selected channel is highlighted.
a new search and save a new preset list, see channels starts, this scan takes a little 2. Turn TUNE to the new location in the list
the function "Save the available TV channels while. During this time the figure for
as presets", page 248. and confirm with OK/MENU.
each channel found and added as a pre- > The channels change places with each
set is shown. When the scan is com- other.
NOTE plete a message is shown and the pic-
ture is shown. A preset list (max. 30 pre- After the preset channels (max. 30) come all the
If no reception is available on the preset other channels available in the area. It is pos-
sets) has now been created and is avail-
buttons, it may be because the car is at a sible to move a channel up to a place in the
location other than where the scan of TV able. To change channel, see
channels was run, for example, if the car page 246. preset list.
was driven from Germany to France. A new The scan and preset storage can be cancelled
selection of country and a new search may
with EXIT.
then need to be carried out.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 247


05 Infotainment system

TV*

Save the available TV channels as EXIT, then the channel that you just watched can sometimes be displayed, such as start and
presets continues to be shown. Scanning does not end times and a brief description of the current
If the car has been moved within the country, affect the preset list. programme. For more information on the
for example, from one city to another, it is not INFO button, see page 226.
Activate scanning in TV mode under TV menu
certain that the presets are available at the new Scan. To return to the TV picture, wait several sec-
location as the frequency range may have onds or press EXIT.
changed. In which case, carry out another scan Teletext
and save a new preset list. It is possible to read Teletext. Follow these Picture settings
1. Press TV mode on OK/MENU. steps: The settings for brightness and contrast can be
adjusted. For more information, see page 239.
2. Turn TUNE to TV menu and press OK/ 1. Press the button on the remote con-
MENU. trol. The reception is lost
If the reception for the TV channel that is being
3. Turn TUNE to Autostore and press OK/ 2. Enter the page number (3 digits) with the
shown disappears then the picture will freeze.
MENU. number keys (0-9) to select page.
Shortly after this a message appears informing
05 > An automatic scan for available TV > The page is shown automatically. that the reception has been lost for the current
channels starts, this scan takes a little Enter new page number, or press the remote TV channel, and a new search for the channel
while. During this time the figure for continues. When the reception returns the dis-
control buttons / to go to the next page.
each channel found and added as a pre- play of the TV channel starts immediately. It is
set is shown. When the scan is com- Return to TV screen with EXIT or by pressing possible to change channel at any time when
plete a message is shown and the pic- the button on the remote control. the message is shown.
ture is shown. A preset list (max. 30 pre-
sets) has now been created and is avail- It is also possible to control the teletext with the If the message Reception lost, searching is
able. To change channel, see coloured buttons on the remote control. shown then this is because the system has
page 246. detected that there is no reception for all TV
Information about the current channels. One possible reason may be that a
Scanning the TV channels programme border has been crossed and that the system
This function automatically scans through the Press the INFO button in order to display the is set to the wrong country. In which case,
frequency range for all channels available in the information about the current programme, the change to the right country in accordance
area where you are. When a channel is found, next programme and its start time. If the with "Searching TV channels/Preset list", see
it is shown for approx. 10 seconds before INFO button is pressed once more then addi- page 247.
scanning is resumed. Scanning is stopped with tional information on the current programme

248 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


05 Infotainment system

Remote control*

Remote control* The remote control can be used for all func- Key Function
tions in the infotainment system. The remote
control's buttons have the same functions as F = Front TV screen
the buttons in the centre console or steering
wheel keypad*.
Change to navigation*
When using the remote control, first press the
remote control's button to position F. Change to radio source (AM,
Then aim the remote control at the IR receiver, FM1 etc.)
which is located to the right of the INFO button
(see page 226) in the centre console. Change to media source (Disc,
TV* etc.)
WARNING
Change to BluetoothŸ hands-
Keep loose objects such as mobile phones, free*
cameras, remote controls for accessories,
etc. in the glove compartment or other com- Scroll/fast rewind, change track/ 05
partments. Otherwise they may injure peo- song.
ple in the car in the event of sudden braking
or a collision. Play/pause

NOTE Stop
Do not expose the remote control to direct
sunlight (e.g. on the instrument panel) - oth- Scroll/fast forward, change
erwise problems may arise with the batter- track/song.
ies.
Menu

To previous, cancels function,


deletes input characters

Scroll wheel, corresponds to TUNE in the


centre console.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 249


05 Infotainment system

Remote control*

Key Function Key Function


Navigate up/down Subtitles, selection of language
for text
Navigate right/left Teletext*, On/Off

Confirm selection or go to the


menu system for the selected Replacing the battery in the remote
source control
Volume, decrease
NOTE
Volume, increase Battery life is normally 1-4 years and 1. Push down the catch on the battery cover
depends on how much the remote control and slide the battery cover in the direction
is used. of the infrared lens.
05 0-9 Preset channels, number and let-
ter input 2. Remove the used batteries, turn the new
The remote control is powered by four batter- batteries in accordance with the symbols
Shortcuts for favourite setting. ies of the AA/LR6 type. in the battery compartment and fit them.
Take along extra batteries for a long journey. 3. Refit the cover.
Information about the current
programme, song, etc. Also used NOTE
when there is more information Be sure to dispose of the exhausted batter-
available than can be shown in ies in an environmentally safe manner.
the TV screen.

Selection of language for sound-


track

250 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


05 Infotainment system

BluetoothŸ handsfree*

General its own keys irrespective of whether or not it is Phone functions, controls overview
connected.

NOTE
Only a selection of mobile phones are fully
compatible with the handsfree function.
Volvo recommends that you seek assis-
tance from an authorised Volvo dealer or
visit www.volvocars.com for information on
compatible phones.

Menus
The menus in TEL are controlled from the cen-
System overview. tre console and the steering wheel keypad*. Centre console control panel.
Mobile phone For general information on menu navigation Number and letter buttons
05
and menu structures, see page 263.
Microphone TEL - Activate/Disconnect
Steering wheel keypad TUNE - Turn in normal view to the right to
access the phone book, and to the left for
Centre console control panel the call register for all calls; also used for
navigation among the options on the TV
BluetoothŸ1 screen.
A mobile phone equipped with BluetoothŸ can
Accept incoming calls, confirm your selec-
be connected wirelessly to the Infotainment
tion or go to the Phone menu by pressing
system. The infotainment system then works
OK/MENU.
handsfree, with the option to control a range of
the mobile phone's functions remotely. The EXIT - Cancels/rejects phone calls, deletes
microphone used is located by the driver's sun input characters, leads up in the menu sys-
visor (2). The mobile phone can be operated by tem and cancels the current function.

1 Applies to High Performance, High Performance Multimedia and Premium Sound Multimedia.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 251


05 Infotainment system

BluetoothŸ handsfree*

NOTE 2. Activate the vehicle's handsfree function Alternative 2 - via the mobile phone's menu
by pressing TEL. Continue by pressing system
If the car is equipped with a steering wheel OK/MENU.
keypad* and/or remote control* then in 1. Activate the handsfree function by press-
many cases these can be used instead of 3. Select, Change phone, press OK/ ing TEL in the centre console. If there is a
the buttons in the centre console. For a MENU. phone connected, disconnect the con-
description of the buttons in the steering nected phone.
> The menu option Add phone is shown
wheel, see page 224. For a description of
the remote control, see page 249. on the TV screen. If one or more mobile 2. Make the car detectable/visible via
phones have already been paired then BluetoothŸ, press OK/MENU and activate
these are also shown. Press OK/ the Phone settings Discoverable
Remember MENU. option.
4. Check that the mobile phone's
Activate/deactivate 3. Search with the mobile phone's
A short press on TEL activates the handsfree BluetoothŸ function is switched on and BluetoothŸ function, see the mobile phone
press OK/MENU. manual.
function. The symbol indicates that the
handsfree function is active. > The audio system searches for mobile
05 4. Select My Volvo Car in the list of units
phones in the vicinity. The search takes
approximately 30 seconds. The mobile detected in your mobile phone.
Connect mobile phone
A mobile phone is connected in different ways phones detected are specified with their 5. Enter an optional PIN code on your mobile
depending on whether or not it has been con- respective BluetoothŸ name in the TV phone via the mobile phone's keypad
nected previously. To connect a mobile phone screen. The handsfree function's when prompted to enter the PIN code.
for the first time, follow the instructions below: BluetoothŸ name is shown in the mobile Then key in the same PIN code via the car's
phone as My Volvo Car. keypad.
There are two options for connecting a mobile
phone, either via the car's menu system or via 5. Choose one of the mobile phones in the 6. Select to connect to My Volvo Car from
the mobile phone's menu system. If one option centre console TV screen. the mobile phone.
does not work then try with the other.
6. Enter the series of numbers that is shown The mobile phone is paired (registered) and
Alternative 1 - via the car's menu system in the centre console TV screen via the connects automatically to the audio system.
mobile phone's keypad and press the For more information about how mobile
1. Make the mobile phone detectable/visible
mobile phone's button to confirm the phones are paired, see page 254.
via BluetoothŸ, see the mobile phone's
selection. When the connection is established the mobile
manual or www.volvocars.com.
phone's BluetoothŸ name is shown in the TV

252 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


05 Infotainment system

BluetoothŸ handsfree*

screen. Now the mobile phone can be con- When the mobile phone has been discon- In call menu
trolled from the audio system. nected an ongoing call can be continued by Press OK/MENU during an ongoing call to
using the mobile phone's built-in microphone access the following functions:
To call and speaker.
1. Make sure that the symbol appears • Mute - audio system microphone is
muted.
at the top of the TV screen and that the NOTE
handsfree function is in phone mode. • Mobile phone - the call is transferred from
Even when your mobile phone has been handsfree to the mobile phone. For some
2. Dial either the desired number or speed manually disconnected, some mobile mobile phones the connection is interrup-
dial number, see page 258. Or in normal phones may automatically couple up to the ted. This is normal. The handsfree function
view turn TUNE to the right to access the last handsfree unit connected, e.g. when a asks if you want to reconnect.
phone book, and to the left for the call reg- new call begins.
ister for all calls. For information on the
• Dial number - option to call a third party
using the number keys (current call set in
phone book, see page 255.
Making and receiving calls standby).
3. Press OK/MENU.
Incoming call Call lists
The call is interrupted with EXIT. 05
– Press OK/MENU to answer the call, even The call lists are copied to the handsfree func-
if the audio system is in e.g. RADIO or tion at each new connection and are then
Disconnecting the mobile phone
MEDIA mode. updated during the connection. In normal view,
Automatic disconnection takes place if the
turn to the left with TUNE to see the call register
mobile phone moves out of the audio system's Refuse or end with EXIT. for All calls .
range. The connection to the mobile phone can
be interrupted manually via a long press on Automatic answer In phone mode it is possible to see all the call
TEL or in phone mode under Phone menu The automatic answer function means that lists under Phone menu All calls:
Disconnect phone. For more information calls are accepted automatically.
• All calls
on connection, see page 254. – Activate/deactivate in phone mode under
Phone menu Call options Auto
• Missed calls
The handsfree function is deactivated when
the engine is switched off or when a door is answer. • Answered calls
opened2. • Dialled calls
• Call duration

2 Only Keyless Drive.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 253


05 Infotainment system

BluetoothŸ handsfree*

NOTE menu Phone settings Sounds and More on pairing and connecting
volume Mute radio/media. A maximum of ten mobile phones can be
Certain mobile phones show a list of the last
dialled numbers in reverse order. paired (registered). Pairing is performed once
Ring volume per phone. After pairing the phone no longer
In phone mode go to Phone menu Phone needs to be visible/detectable. A maximum of
Voice mailbox one mobile phone can be connected at a time.
settings Sounds and volume Ring
In normal view a speed dial number for the
volume and adjust by turning VOL. Press
voice mailbox can be programmed in and then Automatic connection
EXIT to save.
accessed later via a long press on 1. When the handsfree function is active and the
Ring signals last mobile phone connected is in range it is
Voice mailbox number is changed in phone
The handsfree function has integrated ring sig- connected automatically. If the last connected
mode under Phone menu Call options
nals that can be selected in phone mode under mobile phone is not available then the system
Voicemail number Change number. If will try to connect a mobile phone that was
there is no number stored then this menu can Phone menu Phone settings Sounds
paired earlier. When the audio system
be reached with one long press on 1. and volume Ring signals Ring signal 1 searches for the last phone connected its name
05 etc. is shown in the TV screen.
Audio settings
NOTE Manual connection
Phone call volume If you want to change the connected mobile
For some mobile phones, the ringtone on
The phone call volume can only be changed the phone connected will not be switched phone, go in phone mode to Phone menu
during a call. Use the steering wheel keypad* off when one of the inbuilt signals for the Change phone.
or turn the VOL control. handsfree system is used.
Remove the device
Audio system volume A connected mobile phone can be deregis-
In order to select the connected phone's ring
Providing there is no ongoing call taking place, tered and removed. This is performed in phone
signal3, go in phone mode to Phone menu
the audio system volume is controlled as usual mode under Phone menu Remove
by turning VOL. Phone settings Sounds and volume
Bluetooth device.
Ring signals Mobile phone ring signal.
If an audio source is active during an incoming
call then it can be muted automatically. Acti-
vate/deactivate in phone mode under Phone

3 Not supported by all mobile phones.

254 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


05 Infotainment system

BluetoothŸ handsfree*

Version information BluetoothŸ NOTE Quick search for contacts


The car's current BluetoothŸ version can be In normal view turn TUNE to the right to obtain
Changes made from the car to a record in a list of contacts. Turn TUNE to select and
seen in phone mode under Phone menu the mobile phone's telephone book will
result in a new record in the car's telephone press OK/MENU to call.
Phone settings Bluetooth software
version in car. book, i.e. changes will not be saved to the Under the name of the contact is the phone
phone. From the car, this will now look like number that is selected by default. If the sym-
you have double records, with different
bol appears to the right of the contact then
Phone book icons. Note also that when a shortcut num-
ber is saved or a change to a contact is there are several phone numbers stored for the
There are two phone books. These are merged
made, this will result in a new record in the contact. Change and dial a different number
into one in the car and are displayed as a single
car's phone book. than the one that is selected by default by
phone book in the car.
pressing the button on the control panel
• The car downloads the mobile phone's All use of the phone book requires that the in the centre console. Then turn TUNE to select
phone book and only displays this phone and press OK/MENU to call.
symbol appears at the top of the TV
book when the mobile phone from which
this phone book was downloaded is con- screen and that the handsfree function is in Search in the list of contacts by using the cen-
phone mode. tre console's keypad to key in the start of the 05
nected.
The audio system stores a copy of the phone contact's name (see "Character table keypad
• The car also has a built-in phone book. This
contains all the contacts stored in the car book from each paired mobile phone. The in centre console" for button functions).
irrespective of which phone was con- phone book can be copied automatically to the The list of contacts can also be accessed from
nected when saving them. These contacts audio system during each connection. normal view by pressing and holding the button
are visible for all users, regardless of the on the centre console's keypad with the letter
– Activate/deactivate the function in phone
mobile phone that is connected to the car. that the contact searched for starts with. For
If a contact is saved in the car then the mode under Phone menu Phone
example, a long press on the button for 6 gives
symbol is shown in front of the con- settings Phonebook download.
instant access to that part of the list where the
tact in the phone book. If the phone book contains a ringing caller's contacts with the letter M are located.
contact information then this is shown in the TV
screen.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 255


05 Infotainment system

BluetoothŸ handsfree*

Character table keypad in centre Key Function NOTE


console
+0pw There is no text wheel for High Performance,
Key Function so TUNE cannot be used there to input
characters: only the digit and letter buttons
Space . , - ? @ : ; / ( ) 1 #* on the control panel in the centre console
can be used for this.
ABCÅÄÆÀÇ2
Searching for contacts 1. Turn4 TUNE to the desired letter, press
DEFÈÉ3 OK/MENU to confirm. The number and
letter buttons on the control panel in the
centre console can also be used.
GHIÌ4
2. Continue with the next letter and so on. The
result of the search is shown in the phone
JKL5
book (3).
05
3. To change the input mode to numbers or
MNOÖØÑÒ6
special characters, or to go to the phone
book, turn TUNE to one of the options (see
PQRSß7 explanation in the table below) in the list for
changing the input mode (2), press OK/
TUVÜÙ8 Search contacts using the text wheel. MENU.
Character list
WXYZ9 Changing the input mode (see table below)
Phone book
Shift between upper and lower
case letter. To search for or edit a contact, go in phone
mode to Phone menu Phone book
Search.

4 Only applies to High Performance Multimedia and Premium Sound Multimedia.

256 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


05 Infotainment system

BluetoothŸ handsfree*

123/ Change between letters and New contact 1. When the Name row is selected, press
ABC numbers with OK/MENU. OK/MENU to reach the input mode (illus-
tration above).
More Change to special characters 2. Turn4 TUNE to the desired letter, press
with OK/MENU.
OK/MENU to confirm. The number and
Leads to the phone book (3). letter buttons on the control panel in the
Turn TUNE to select a contact, centre console can also be used.
press OK/MENU to see the 3. Continue with the next letter and so on. The
saved numbers and other infor- name entered is shown in the input field (2)
mation. in the TV screen.
4. To change the input mode to numbers,
A short press on EXIT deletes an input char- special characters, change between
acter. A long press on EXIT will clear all entered Entering letters for New contact. uppercase/lowercase letters, etc., turn
characters. Changing the input mode (see table below) TUNE to one of the options (see explana-
05
By pressing a number key in the centre console tion in the table below) in the list (1) and
Input field then press OK/MENU.
when the text wheel is shown (see illustration
above), a new character list (1) appears in the New contacts can be added in phone mode When the name has been fully entered, select
TV screen. Continue repeatedly pressing the under Phone menu Phone book New OK in the list on the TV screen (1) and press
number key to the desired letter and then contact. OK/MENU. Now continue with the telephone
release. Continue with the next letter and so
number in the same way as above.
on. When a button is depressed the entry is
NOTE When the telephone number has been entered,
confirmed when another button is depressed.
There is no text wheel for High Performance, press OK/MENU and select a telephone num-
To enter a number, hold in the corresponding so TUNE cannot be used there to input ber type (Mobile, Home, Work or General).
number key. characters: only the digit and letter buttons Press OK/MENU to confirm.
on the control panel in the centre console
can be used for this. When all details have been filled in, select Save
contact in the menu to save the contact.

4 Only applies to High Performance Multimedia and Premium Sound Multimedia.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 257


05 Infotainment system

BluetoothŸ handsfree*

123/ Change between letters and speed dial number then an option is shown to
ABC numbers with OK/MENU. save a contact to the selected speed dial num-
ber.
More Change to special characters
with OK/MENU. Receiving a vCard
It is possible to receive a vCard to the car's
OK Save and go back to Add con- phone book from other mobile phones (other
tact with OK/MENU. than the one currently connected to the car). In
order to allow this the car is set to visible mode
Change between uppercase and for BluetoothŸ. The function is activated in
lowercase letters with OK/ phone mode under Phone menu Phone
MENU.
book Receive vCard.
Press OK/MENU, the cursor
moves to the input field (2) at the Memory status
top of the TV screen. The cursor Memory status of the car's phone book and the
05 can now be moved, with TUNE, connected mobile phone's phone book can be
to the appropriate place to e.g. seen in phone mode under Phone menu
insert new letters or delete with Phone book Memory status.
EXIT. To be able to insert new
letters first go back to the input Delete phone book
mode, by pressing OK/MENU. The car's phone book can be deleted, this is
carried out in phone mode under Phone menu
Speed dial numbers Phone book Clear phone book.
Use phone mode to add speed dial numbers
under Phone menu Phone book Speed NOTE
dial. Deleting the car's telephone book only dele-
Dialling with speed dial numbers can be per- tes contacts in the car's telephone book.
formed in phone mode using the number keys Contacts in the mobile phone's phone book
on the keypad in the centre console, by press- are not deleted.
ing a number key and then pressing OK/
MENU. If there is no contact stored on the

258 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


05 Infotainment system

Voice recognition* mobile phone

Introduction WARNING Language


The infotainment system's voice recognition1 The driver always holds overall responsibil-
allows the driver to voice-activate certain func- ity for driving the vehicle in a safe manner
tions in a BluetoothŸ-connected mobile phone and complying with all applicable rules of
or in Volvo's navigation system - RTI (Road and the road.
Traffic Information System).
The voice recognition system allows the driver
NOTE to voice-activate certain functions of a
• The information in this section BluetoothŸ-connected mobile phone and in
describes the use of voice commands Volvo's navigation system - RTI (Road and
to control a mobile phone connected Traffic Information System), while the driver
using BluetoothŸ. For detailed infor- can keep his/her hands on the wheel at the
mation on using a mobile phone con- same time. The input data are in dialogue form Language list.
nected using BluetoothŸ with the car's with spoken commands from the user and ver-
Infotainment system see page 251. bal replies from the system. The voice recog- Voice recognition is not possible for all lan-
05
nition system uses the same microphone as guages. Languages available for voice recog-
• The Volvo navigation system RTI (Road nition are marked with an icon in the language
and Traffic Information System) has a the BluetoothŸ handsfree system (see illustra-
tion on page 251) and the voice recognition list - . Changing the language is performed
separate user manual which contains
more information on voice control and system's replies come via the car's speakers. in the menu system MY CAR, see page 146.
voice commands to control that sys-
tem.

Voice commands offer convenience and help


the driver to avoid being distracted, and
instead concentrate on driving and focus
attention on the road and traffic conditions.

1 Only applies to vehicles equipped with Volvo's navigation system - RTI (Road and Traffic Information System).

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 259


05 Infotainment system

Voice recognition* mobile phone

Remember Keep the following things in mind when you use Help functions for voice recognition
the voice recognition system: • Instructions: A function that helps you get
familiar with the system and the procedure
• For a command - speak after the tone, with for giving commands.
normal voice at normal speed.
• Do not speak while the system is replying • Voice training: A function that enables the
(the system cannot understand commands voice recognition system to learn to know
during this time). your voice and your accent. The function
provides an opportunity to voice train two
• The car's doors, windows and sunroof* user profiles.
must be closed.
The help functions can be accessed by press-
• Avoid background noise in the passenger ing the MY CAR button on the control panel in
compartment. the centre console and then turning TUNE to
the desired menu option.
Steering wheel keypad. NOTE
Instructions
Button for voice recognition If the driver is unsure of which command to The instructions can be started in two ways:
05
use, he (she) can say "Help" - the system
To activate the system then responds with a few different com-
mands which can be used in the current sit- NOTE
Before voice commands to a mobile phone can
uation. This instruction and voice training can only
be used the mobile phone must be paired and
connected via BluetoothŸ handsfree. If a tele- Voice commands can be disabled by: be started when the car is parked.
phone command is given and no mobile phone • saying "Cancel"
is paired, then the system will provide informa-
• not speaking • Press the button for Voice recognition and
tion about this. For information on pairing and say "Voice instructions".
connecting a mobile phone, see page 252. • a long press on the steering wheel but-
ton for Voice recognition • Activate the instructions in the menu sys-
• Press the button for voice recognition (1) in tem MY CAR under Settings Voice
order to activate the system and initiate a
• Press EXIT or another source button
settings Voice tutorial. For a descrip-
(e.g. MEDIA).
dialogue with voice commands. The sys- tion of the menu system, see page 144.
tem will then display commonly used com-
The instructions are divided into 3 lessons,
mands in the TV screen in the centre con-
which take around 5 minutes in total to com-
sole.
plete. The system starts with the first lesson.

260 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


05 Infotainment system

Voice recognition* mobile phone

To skip a lesson and go to the next one, press Using voice commands commands. For a description of the menu
the button for voice recognition and say The driver initiates a dialogue with the voice system, see page 144.
"Next". Go back to the previous lesson by say- commands by pressing the button for voice
ing "Previous". Dial a number
recognition (see illustration on page 260).
The system understands the numbers 0 (zero)
Exit the instructions by means of a long press Once a dialogue has been started, commonly to 9 (nine). These numbers can be pronounced
on the button for voice recognition. used commands will be shown in the TV individually, in groups of several numbers at a
Voice training screen. Greyed-out text or text within brackets time, or the whole number all at once. Numbers
The system displays up to fifteen phrases for is not included in the spoken command. greater than 9 (nine) cannot be handled by the
you to say. Voice training can be started in the When the driver becomes accustomed to the system, e.g. 10 (ten) or 11 (eleven) are not pos-
menu system MY CAR under Settings system, he/she can speed up the command sible.
Voice settings Voice training. Choose dialogue and skip the prompts from the sys- The following is an example of a dialogue with
between User 1 or User 2. For a description tem, by briefly pressing the button for voice voice commands. The system's reply will vary
of the menu system, see page 144. recognition. depending on the situation.
After voice training has been completed, Commands can be given in several ways The user starts the dialogue by saying: 05
remember to set your user profile under Voice The command "Phone call contact" can be Phone > call number
user setting. pronounced as e.g.: or
Additional settings in MY CAR • "Phone > Call contact" - Say "Phone", wait Phone call number
• User setting - Two user profiles can be for the system's reply, and then continue
set, the function is activated in the menu by saying "Call contact." System reply
Number?
system MY CAR under Settings Voice or
settings Voice user setting. Choose User action
• "Phone call contact" - Say the whole com- Start saying the numbers (as individual units,
between User 1 or User 2. For a descrip- mand in one sequence.
tion of the menu system, see page 144. i.e. six-eight-seven, etc.) in the phone number.
Quick commands If you say several numbers and pause, the sys-
• Voice volume - Can be changed in the tem will repeat them, and then say "Continue".
menu system MY CAR under Settings Quick commands for the phone can be found
Voice settings Voice output in the menu system MY CAR under Settings Continue to say the numbers. When finished,
volume. For a description of the menu sys- Voice settings Voice command list finish the command by saying "Call".
tem, see page 144. Phone commands and General • You can also change the number by saying
the commands "Correct" (which deletes
``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 261


05 Infotainment system

Voice recognition* mobile phone

the last spoken group of numbers) or play in the numbered rows and the system
"Delete" (which deletes the whole spoken prompts you to select a row number.
phone number). • If there are more rows in the list than can
be displayed simultaneously, saying
Dialling from the call register
"Down" allows you to scroll down in the list
The following dialogue allows you to make a
(and saying "Up" allows you to scroll up in
phone call from one of your mobile phone's call the list).
registers.
The user starts the dialogue by saying: Calling voice mailbox
Phone > call from the call register The following dialogue allows you to call your
voice mailbox to check if you have received
or any messages. The phone number for your
Phone call from the call register voice mailbox must be registered in the
BluetoothŸ function, see page 254.
Continue by responding to the system's
prompts. The user starts the dialogue by saying:
05 Phone > call voice mailbox
Call a contact
or
The following dialogue allows you to call your
pre-defined contacts in the mobile phone. Phone call voice mailbox
The user starts the dialogue by saying: Continue by responding to the system's
Phone > call contact prompts.
or
Phone call contact
Continue by responding to the system's
prompts.
Consider the following when you call a contact:
• If there are several contacts with similar
names, they will be presented in the dis-

262 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


05 Infotainment system

Menu navigation, Infotainment

To navigate in the menus Controls in the centre console Audio settings Equalizer, which requires
The infotainment system's functions are con- that the following is carried out beforehand:
trolled via the system's menus. Each source in 1. Select a source by pressing one of the but-
the infotainment system (e.g. RADIO, MEDIA) tons (e.g. RADIO, MEDIA etc.). Continue
has its own separate menus. In order to access to press in order to scroll down among the
the menus and activate a function a source
options on the TV screen (e.g. FM1),
must first have been selected (e.g. RADIO/ release and wait a second and the selec-
FM1). Then press OK/MENU for access into tion is accepted automatically. Alterna-
the menu for the selected source. tively, turn TUNE and confirm with OK/
The menu options are selected by means of the MENU.
buttons in the centre console or via the steering 2. Press OK/MENU and turn TUNE, or use
wheel keypad*. The functions are described the thumbwheel* on the steering wheel
under their respective sections. keypad to reach the desired menu option
RADIO
e.g. Audio settings and press OK/
MEDIA MENU. 05

TEL 3. Turn TUNE again to reach the desired sub-


menu, e.g. Equalizer, and press OK/
TUNE MENU.
OK/MENU
Menus RADIO
Search paths
The search paths to the menu functions are Main menu AM
specified in the owner's manual with the form: AM menu
Show presets1
Scan

1 Only applies to High Performance Multimedia and Premium Sound Multimedia.


``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 263


05 Infotainment system

Menu navigation, Infotainment

Audio settings2 Reset all FM settings Menus MEDIA


Sound stage3 Audio settings5 Main menu CD Audio
Equalizer4 Disc menu
Main menu DAB1*/DAB2*
Volume compensation Random
DAB menu
Reset all audio settings Scan
Ensemble learn
PTY filtering Audio settings5
Main menu FM1/FM2
FM menu Turn off PTY filtering Main menu CD/DVD1 Data
TP Show radio text Disc menu
Show radio text Show presets1 Play/Pause
Show presets1 Scan Stop
05 Scan Advanced settings Random
News settings DAB linking Repeat folder
Advanced settings DAB band Change subtitle
REG Sub channels Change audio track
Alternative frequency Show PTY text Scan
EON Reset all DAB settings Audio settings5
Set TP favourite Audio settings5
PTY settings

2 The menu options for audio settings are the same for all audio sources.
3 Only applies to Premium Sound Multimedia.
4 Does not apply to Performance.
1 Only applies to High Performance Multimedia and Premium Sound Multimedia.
5 For submenus, see "Main menu AM".

264 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


05 Infotainment system

Menu navigation, Infotainment

Main menu DVD1 Video Main menu USB4 Audio settings5


Disc menu USB menu
DVD disc menu Play/Pause Main menu AUX
AUX menu
Play/Pause/Continue Stop
AUX input volume
Stop Random
Audio settings5
Subtitles Repeat folder
Audio tracks Select USB device Main menu TV*
Advanced settings Change subtitle TV menu

Angle Change audio track Select country

DivX® VOD code Scan Reorganize presets


Autostore
Audio settings5 Audio settings5
Scan 05
Main menu iPod4 Main menu Media Bluetooth4 Audio settings5
iPod menu Bluetooth menu
Random Random
Pop-up menu6 video and TV*
Scan Change device
Press OK/MENU when a video file is being
Audio settings5 Remove Bluetooth device played back or TV* is being shown in order to
access the pop-up menu.
Scan
Bluetooth software version in car Image settings

1 Only applies to High Performance Multimedia and Premium Sound Multimedia.


5 For submenus, see "Main menu AM".
4 Does not apply to Performance.
6 Only applies when playing back videos or displaying TV*.
``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 265


05 Infotainment system

Menu navigation, Infotainment

Source menu7 Change phone


DVD video menu8 Remove Bluetooth device
DVD disc TOP menu8 Phone settings
Discoverable
Menus TEL Sounds and volume
Phonebook download
Main menu BluetoothŸ handsfree4
Phone menu Bluetooth software version in
car
All calls
Call options
All calls
Auto answer
Missed calls
Voicemail number
Answered calls
05 Disconnect phone
Dialled calls
Call duration
Phone book
Search
New contact
Speed dials
Receive vCard
Memory status
Clear phone book

7 What is shown in the pop-up menu for the source menu depends on what is being played back or displayed, it can be e.g. Disc menu or USB menu.
8 Only applies to DVD video discs.
4 Does not apply to Performance.

266
05 Infotainment system

05

267
Recommendations during driving......................................................... 270
Refuelling.............................................................................................. 273
Fuel....................................................................................................... 274
Loading................................................................................................. 278
Cargo area............................................................................................ 280
Driving with a trailer.............................................................................. 283
Towing and recovery............................................................................. 289

268
DURING YOUR JOURNEY
06 During your journey

Recommendations during driving

General 2nd gear under normal conditions on level IMPORTANT


ground.
Economical driving Engine damage can occur if water enters
For more information and further advice, see the air filter.
Driving economically means driving smoothly the pages 12 and 363.
while thinking ahead and adjusting your driving In depths greater than 25 cm, water could
style and speed to the prevailing conditions. enter the transmission. This reduces the
WARNING lubricating ability of the oils and shortens
• Drive in the highest gear possible, adapted Never switch off the engine while moving, the service life of these systems.
to the current traffic situation and road -
such as downhill, this deactivates important In the event of the engine stalling in water,
lower engine speeds result in lower fuel
systems such as the power steering and do not try restart - tow the car from the water
consumption. brake servo. to a workshop - an authorised Volvo work-
• Avoid driving with open windows. shop is recommended. Risk of engine
• Avoid sudden unnecessary acceleration breakdown.
Driving in water
and heavy braking. The car can be driven through water at a maxi-
• Remove unnecessary items from the car - mum depth of 25 cm at a maximum speed of Engine, gearbox and cooling system
the greater the load the higher the fuel con- 10 km/h. Extra caution should be exercised Under special conditions, for example hard
sumption. when passing through flowing water. driving in hilly terrain and hot climate, there is
• Use engine braking to slow down, when it a risk that the engine and drive system may
During driving in water, maintain a low speed
can take place without risk to other road overheat - in particular with a heavy load.
and do not stop the car. When the water has
users. been passed, depress the brake pedal lightly For information about overheating when driv-
06
• A roof load and ski box increase air resis- and check that full brake function is achieved. ing with a trailer, see page 283.
tance, leading to higher fuel consumption Water and mud for example can make the
- remove the load carriers when not in use. • Remove any auxiliary lamps from in front
brake linings wet resulting in delayed brake of the grille when driving in hot climates.
• Do not run the engine to operating tem- function.
perature at idling speed, but rather drive • If the temperature in the engine's cooling
with a light load as soon as possible - a
• Clean the electric contacts of the electric system is too high the instrument panel's
engine block heater and trailer coupling warning symbol is illuminated and there is
cold engine consumes more fuel than a after driving in water and mud.
warm one. a text message displayed there High
• Do not let the car stand with water over the engine temp Stop safely - stop the car in
• Cars with the D5 engine and 6-speed man- sills for any long period of time - this could a safe way and allow the engine to run at
ual transmission or DRIVe engine and 6- cause electrical malfunctions. idling speed for several minutes to cool
speed manual transmission are started in down.

270
06 During your journey

Recommendations during driving

• If the text message High engine temp Open tailgate least 15 minutes - battery charging is more
Stop engine or Coolant level low, Stop effective during driving than running the
engine is shown then the engine must be WARNING engine at idling speed while stationary.
switched off after stopping the car.
Do not drive with the tailgate open. Toxic Before a long journey
• In the event of overheating in the gearbox exhaust fumes could be drawn into the car
a built-in protection function is activated • Check that the engine is working normally
through the cargo area. and that fuel consumption is normal.
which, amongst other things, illuminates
the instrument panel's warning symbol and • Make sure that there are no leaks (fuel, oil
there is a text message displayed there Do not overload the battery or other fluid).
Transmission hot Reduce speed or The electrical functions in the car load the bat- • Check all bulbs and tyre tread depths.
Transmission hot Stop safely - follow tery to varying degrees. Avoid using the key
the recommendation given and lower the position II when the engine is switched off. • Carrying a warning triangle is a legal
requirement in certain countries.
speed and stop the car in a safe way and Instead use the I mode - which uses less
allow the engine to run at idling speed for power. Winter driving
a few minutes to allow the gearbox to cool Check the following in particular before the
Also, be aware of different accessories that
down. cold season:
load the electrical system. Do not use functions
• If the car overheats, the air conditioning which use a lot of power when the engine is
may be switched off temporarily. • The engine coolant must contain at least
switched off. Examples of such functions are: 50% glycol. This mixture protects the
• Do not turn the engine off immediately you
• ventilation fan engine against frost erosion down to
stop after a hard drive. approximately –35 °C. To achieve optimum 06
• headlamps antifreeze protection, different types of gly-
NOTE • windscreen wiper col must not be mixed.
It is normal for the engine's cooling fan to • audio system (high volume). • The fuel tank must be kept filled to prevent
operate for a while after the engine has been If the battery voltage is low the information dis- condensation.
switched off. play shows the text Low battery Power save • Engine oil viscosity is important. Oils with
mode. The energy-saving function then shuts lower viscosity (thinner oils) facilitate star-
down certain functions or reduces certain ting in cold weather and also reduce fuel
functions such as the ventilation fan and/or consumption while the engine is cold. For
audio system. more information on suitable oils, see
page 360.
– In which case, charge the battery by star-
ting the engine and then running it for at

271
06 During your journey

Recommendations during driving

IMPORTANT
Low viscosity oil must not be used for hard
driving or in hot weather.

• The condition of the battery and charge


level must be inspected. Cold weather pla-
ces great demands on the battery and its
capacity is reduced by the cold.
• Use washer fluid to avoid ice forming in the
washer fluid reservoir.
To achieve optimum roadholding Volvo rec-
ommends using winter tyres on all wheels if
there is a risk of snow or ice.

NOTE
The use of winter tyres is a legal requirement
in certain countries. Studded tyres are not
permitted in all countries.
06

Slippery driving conditions


Practise driving on slippery surfaces under
controlled conditions to learn how the car
reacts.

272
06 During your journey

Refuelling

Refuelling Opening the fuel filler flap manually Opening/closing the fuel cap
Opening/closing the fuel filler flap

The fuel filler cap can be attached onto the flap.


The fuel filler flap can be opened manually
when electric opening from the passenger A certain overpressure may arise in the tank in
Open the fuel filler flap using the button on the compartment is not possible. the event of high outside temperatures. Open
lighting panel - the flap opens when the button the cap slowly.
is released. 1. Open/remove the side hatch in the cargo
area (same side as fuel filler flap). • After refuelling - refit the cap and turn it
The arrow on the information display's until one or more clicking sounds are
2. Expand/open a perforated section in the 06
symbol reminds which side of the car heard.
isolation and locate a green cord with han-
the fuel filler cap is located. dle. Filling up with fuel
• Close the fuel filler flap by pressing it in until 3. Pull the cord gently straight back until the • Do not overfill the tank but fill until the
a click confirms that it is closed. fuel filler flap folds out with a "click". pump nozzle cuts out.

IMPORTANT NOTE
Pull the wire gently - minimal force is Excess fuel in the tank can overflow in hot
required to disengage the hatch lock. weather.

273
06 During your journey

Fuel

General information on fuel IMPORTANT Lambda-sondTM oxygen sensor


Fuel of a lower quality than that recommended The Lambda-sond is part of a control system
Mixing different types of fuel or the use of
by Volvo must not be used as engine power intended to reduce emissions and improve fuel
fuel not recommended invalidates Volvo's
and fuel consumption is negatively affected. guarantees, and any associated service economy.
agreement. This applies to all engines. An oxygen sensor monitors the oxygen content
WARNING NOTE: It does not apply to cars with engines of the exhaust gases leaving the engine. This
that are adapted to run on ethanol fuel (E85).
Always avoid inhaling fuel vapour and get- value is fed into an electronic system that con-
ting fuel splashes in the eyes. tinuously controls the injectors. The ratio of fuel
NOTE to air directed to the engine is continuously
In the event of fuel in the eyes, remove any
contact lenses and rinse the eyes in plenty adjusted. These adjustments create optimal
Extreme weather conditions, driving with a
of water for at least 15 minutes and seek conditions for efficient combustion, and
trailer or driving at high altitudes in combi-
medical attention. nation with fuel grade are factors that could together with the three-way catalytic converter
affect the car's performance. reduce harmful emissions (hydrocarbons, car-
Never swallow fuel. Fuels such as petrol,
bioethanol and mixtures of them and diesel bon monoxide and nitrous oxides).
are highly toxic and could cause permanent
Catalytic converters
injury or be fatal if swallowed. Seek medical Petrol
attention immediately if fuel has been swal- The purpose of the catalytic converters is to
lowed. purify exhaust gases. They are located close to Petrol must fulfil the EN 228 standard. Most
the engine so that operating temperature is engines can be run with octane ratings of 95
06 reached quickly. and 98 RON. Only in exceptional cases should
WARNING 91 RON be used.
The catalytic converters consist of a monolith
Fuel which spills onto the ground can be (ceramic or metal) with channels. The channel • 95 RON can be used for normal driving.
ignited. walls are lined with a thin layer of platinum/rho- • 98 RON is recommended for optimum per-
Switch off the fuel-driven heater before star- dium/palladium. These metals act as catalysts, formance and minimum fuel consumption.
ting to refuel. i.e. they participate in and accelerate a chem-
When driving in temperatures above +38 °C,
Never carry an activated mobile phone ical reaction without being used up them-
fuel with the highest possible octane rating is
when refuelling. The ring signal could cause selves.
recommended for optimum performance and
spark build-up and ignite petrol fumes,
fuel economy.
leading to fire and injury.

274
06 During your journey

Fuel

IMPORTANT IMPORTANT refuelling, check that the area around the fuel
filler pipe is clean. Avoid spilling fuel onto the
• Always refuel with unleaded petrol so as Make sure the reserve fuel can is securely paintwork. Wash off any spillage with deter-
not to damage the catalytic converter. fastened and that its cap is sealed. gent and water.
• Do not use additives not recommended
by Volvo. WARNING IMPORTANT
Ethanol is sensitive to sparks, and explosive Only ever use fuel that fulfils the European
Bioethanol E85 gases could form in the reserve fuel can if it diesel standard.
is refuelled with ethanol. The sulphur content must be a maximum of
Do not modify the fuel system or its compo-
nents, and do not replace components with 50 ppm.
parts that are not specifically designed for use Diesel
with bioethanol. IMPORTANT
Only use diesel fuel from well-known produc-
ers. Never use diesel of dubious quality. Diesel Diesel type fuels that must not be used:
WARNING should fulfil the EN 590 or JIS K2204 stand-
Methanol must not be used. A decal on the ards. Diesel engines are sensitive to contami- • Special additives
inside of the fuel filler flap shows the correct nants in the fuel, such as excessively high vol- • Marine diesel fuel
alternative fuel. umes of sulphur particles for example. • Heating oil
The use of components not designed for At low temperatures (-6 °C to -40 °C), a paraffin • FAME1 (Fatty Acid Methyl Ester) and
bioethanol engines could cause fire, injury 06
precipitate may form in the diesel fuel, which vegetable oil.
or engine damage.
may lead to ignition problems. Special diesel These fuels do not fulfil the requirements in
fuel designed for low temperatures around accordance with Volvo recommendations
Reserve fuel can freezing point is available from the major oil and generate increased wear and engine
The reserve fuel can should be filled with petrol, companies. This fuel is less viscous at low tem- damage that is not covered by the Volvo
see the NOTE box, page 114. peratures and reduces the risk of paraffin pre- warranty.
cipitate.
The risk of condensation in the fuel tank is Empty tank
reduced if the tank is kept well filled. When The design of the fuel system in a diesel engine
means that if the vehicle runs out of fuel, the

1 Diesel fuel may contain a certain amount of FAME, but further amounts must not be added.

275
06 During your journey

Fuel

tank may need to be vented in the workshop in The fuel filter must be drained at the intervals When the filter has become approximately
order to restart the engine after fuelling. specified in the Service and Warranty Booklet 80% full of particles, a warning triangle on the
or if you suspect that the car has been filled instrument panel illuminates, and the message
Once the engine has stopped due to fuel star-
with contaminated fuel. Soot filter full See manual is shown on the
vation, the fuel system needs a few moments
instrument panel display.
to carry out a check. Do this before starting the
engine, once the fuel tank has been filled with IMPORTANT Start regeneration of the filter by driving the car
diesel: Certain special additives remove the water until the engine reaches normal operating tem-
1. Insert the remote control key in the ignition separation in the fuel filter. perature, preferably on a main road or motor-
switch and push it in to the end position way. The car should then be driven for approx-
(see page 80). Diesel particle filter (DPF) imately 20 minutes more.
2. Press the START button without depress- Diesel cars are equipped with a particle filter,
ing the brake and/or clutch pedal. which results in more efficient emission con- NOTE
3. Wait approx. 1 minute. trol. The particles in the exhaust gases are col- A smaller reduction of engine power may be
lected in the filter during normal driving. So- noticed temporarily during regeneration.
4. To start the engine: Depress the brake and/ called "regeneration" is started in order to burn
or clutch pedal and then press the away the particles and empty the filter. This
START button again. When regeneration is complete the warning
requires the engine to have reached normal text is cleared automatically.
operating temperature.
NOTE Use the parking heater* in cold weather so that
06 Regeneration of the filter is automatic and nor- the engine reaches normal operating tempera-
Before filling with fuel in the event of fuel mally takes 10-20 minutes. It may take a little
shortage: ture more quickly.
longer at a low average speed. Fuel consump-
• Stop the car on as flat/level ground as tion may increase slightly during regeneration.
IMPORTANT
possible - if the car is tilting there is a
risk of air pockets in the fuel supply. Regeneration in cold weather
If the filter fills up with particles then it can
If the car is frequently driven short distances in be difficult to start the engine and the filter
cold weather then the engine does not reach will be incapable of functioning. Then there
Draining condensation from the fuel filter normal operating temperature. This means that is a risk that the filter will have to be
The fuel filter separates condensation from the regeneration of the diesel particle filter does replaced.
fuel. Condensation can disrupt engine opera- not take place and the filter is not emptied.
tion.

276 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


06 During your journey

Fuel

Fuel consumption and emissions of


carbon dioxide
Fuel consumption figures may change if the car
is equipped with extra equipment that affects
the car's weight. See information on weights
page 355 and table page 363.
The manner in which the car is driven, and
other non-technical factors can also affect fuel
consumption.
Consumption is higher and power output lower
for fuel with an octane rating of 91 RON.

NOTE
Extreme weather conditions, driving with a
trailer or driving at high altitudes in combi-
nation with fuel grade are factors that could
affect the car's performance.

06

277
06 During your journey

Loading

General information on loading • Secure all loads to the load retaining eye- Front seat
Payload depends on the car's kerb weight. The lets with straps or web lashings. The passenger seat backrest can also be
total of the weight of the passengers and all folded for an extra long load, see page 82.
accessories reduces the car's payload by a WARNING
corresponding weight. For more detailed infor- A loose object weighing 20 kg can, in a Roof load
mation on weights, see page 355. frontal collision at a speed of 50 km/h, carry
The tailgate is opened via a button on the impact of an item weighing 1000 kg. Using load carriers
the lighting panel or the remote con- To avoid damaging the car and for maximum
trol key, see page 61. possible safety while driving, the load carriers
WARNING
designed by Volvo are recommended.
The protection provided by the inflatable
WARNING curtain in the headlining may be compro- Carefully follow the installation instructions
mised or eliminated by high loads. supplied with the carriers.
The car's driving characteristics change
depending on the weight and distribution of • Never load cargo above the backrest. • Check periodically that the load carriers
the load. and load are properly secured. Lash the
load securely with retaining straps.
WARNING • Distribute the load evenly over the load
To bear in mind when loading
Always secure the load. During heavy brak- carriers. Put the heaviest objects at the
• Position the load firmly against the rear ing the load may otherwise shift, causing bottom.
seat's backrest. injury to the car's occupants.
06 • The size of the area exposed to the wind,
Note that objects must not prevent the function Cover sharp edges and sharp corners with and therefore fuel consumption, increase
of the WHIPS system for the front seats if any something soft. with the size of the load.
of the rear seat's backrests is folded down,see
page 27.
Switch off the engine and apply the parking • Drive gently. Avoid quick acceleration,
brake when loading/unloading long items. heavy braking and hard cornering.
• Centre the load. Otherwise you may accidentally knock the
gear lever or gear selector with the load into
• Heavy objects should be placed as low as a drive position - and the car could then
WARNING
possible. Avoid placing heavy loads on move off. The car's centre of gravity and driving cha-
lowered backrests. racteristics are altered by roof loads. For
• Cover sharp edges with something soft to information on maximum permitted roof
avoid damaging the upholstery. load, including load carriers and any space
box, see page 355.

278
06 During your journey

Loading

Lowering the rear seat backrest Bag holder* 12 V electrical socket*


To simplify loading in the cargo area, the rear
seat backrest can be folded down, see
page 84.

Load retaining eyelets

Bag holder under folding hatch in the floor.


The bag holder keeps carrier bags in place and Lower the cover to access the electrical
prevents them from overturning and spreading socket.
their contents across the cargo area. • The socket also provides voltage when the
remote control key is not in the ignition
1. Fold up the holder, which is part of the floor
switch.
The folding load retaining eyelets are used to hatch. 06
fasten straps in order to anchor items in the 2. Fasten the bags with strap and secure the NOTE
cargo area. carrying handle in the hooks.
Remember that using the electrical socket
with the engine switched off involves the
WARNING risk of discharging the car's battery.
Hard, sharp and/or heavy objects that are
loose or protrude could cause injury during
heavy braking.
Always secure large and heavy objects with
a seatbelt or cargo retaining straps.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 279


06 During your journey

Cargo area

Safety net* The two-part safety net cassette is secured on Pull the net up from the cassettes. The net is
the rear of the backrest. The narrowest cas- self-locking after about 1 minute if the rear
sette is secured on the left-hand side (seen seat's backrests are raised.
from the tailgate).
Pull up the right-hand section of the net
1. Fold the rear seat's backrest forward, see using its strap.
page 85.
Insert the rod in the mounting on the right-
2. Align the cassette's anchor rails in front of hand side and then press it forward – the
the backrest attachment lugs . rod locks in with a click.
3. Slide the cassette into the attachment lugs Pull out the rod's telescope section and
. click it in on the other side.

4. Fold back and lock the backrests. Pull up the left-hand safety net and hook it
into the rod.
Storage space, safety net cassettes. • Removing the cassettes takes place in
A rollable safety net comprising two cassettes reverse order. • Folding up takes place in reverse order.
has a storage space under the cargo area floor The net can also be used when the rear seat's
hatch.
Using the safety net backrests are folded forward.

Securing the net cassettes Removing the net cassettes


06 1. Roll the safety nets into the cassettes in
accordance with the procedure in the sec-
tion entitled "Using the safety net", but in
reverse.
2. Fold the whole backrest forward.
3. Slide the cassettes out until they loosen
from the anchor rails.
Store the cassettes in their compartment under
the cargo area floor hatch.

280 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


06 During your journey

Cargo area

WARNING Safety grille* up in the roof and so be out of the way if a


longer cargo area is required. However, if
Loads in the cargo area must be firmly desired, the safety grille can be dismantled and
secured, even if the safety net is correctly removed from the car.
fitted.
For information about the tools required and
methods for fitting/removal, see the installation
Safety net combined with cargo cover
instructions1 that were included with the initial
purchase.
For safety reasons, the safety grille must
always be correctly fastened and secured
when being refitted.

Cargo cover*
A safety grille prevents loads or pets from
being thrown forward in the passenger com-
partment in the event of sudden braking.

Folding up
Puller-straps for raising the net. Take hold of the bottom of the safety grille and
pull back/up. 06
The safety net can also be raised from the rear
seat when the cargo cover is extended.
IMPORTANT
Follow the procedure in the section entitled
The safety grille cannot be folded up or
"Using the safety net". The straps for raising down when a cargo cover is fitted.
are located by the arrows.

Fitting/removal
The safety grille is normally permanently instal- Pull the cargo cover over the load and hook it
led in the car because it can easily be folded into the recesses at the cargo area's rear posts.

1 Installation instructions no. 30756681.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 281


06 During your journey

Cargo area

IMPORTANT
The safety grille cannot be folded up or
down when the cargo cover is fitted.

Attaching the cargo cover


Move one end piece of the cover into the
recess on the side panel.
Move the other end piece into the corres-
ponding recess.
Press both sides in. A "click" should be
audible and the red marking should disap-
pear.
> Check that both end pieces are locked.

Removing the cargo cover


1. Press in one end piece button and lift it out.
2. Carefully angle the cover up/out and the
06 other end piece loosens automatically.

Lowering the cargo cover's rear sealing


disc
In its rolled-in position, the cargo cover's rear
sealing disc protrudes horizontally into the
cargo area when it is fitted.
– Pull the sealing disc back gently, free from
its support shelves, and lower.

282
06 During your journey

Driving with a trailer

General • For safety reasons, the maximum permit- stationary the rear of the car lowers slightly,
Payload depends on the car's kerb weight. The ted speed for the car when coupled with a which is normal.
total of the weight of the passengers and all trailer should not be exceeded. Follow the
regulations in force for the permitted Trailer weights
accessories, e.g. towbar, reduces the car's
speeds and weights. For information on Volvo's permitted trailer
payload by a corresponding weight. For more
• Maintain a low speed when driving with a weights, see page 356.
detailed information on weights, see
page 355. trailer up long, steep ascents.
• Avoid driving with a trailer on inclines of NOTE
If the towing bracket is mounted by Volvo, then
more than 12%. The stated maximum permitted trailer
the car is delivered with the necessary equip-
weights are those permitted by Volvo.
ment for driving with a trailer. Trailer cable National vehicle regulations can further limit
• The car's towing bracket must be of an An adapter is required if the car's towing trailer weights and speeds. Towbars can be
approved type. bracket has 13 pin electrics and the trailer has certified for higher towing weights than the
7 pin electrics. Use an adapter cable approved car can actually tow.
• If the towbar is retrofitted, check with your
Volvo dealer that the car is fully equipped by Volvo. Make sure the cable does not drag
for driving with a trailer. on the ground. WARNING
• Distribute the load on the trailer so that the Direction indicators and brake lights on Follow the stated recommendations for
weight on the towing bracket complies the trailer trailer weights. Otherwise, the car and trailer
with the specified maximum towball load. may be difficult to control in the event of
If any of the trailer's lamps for direction indica-
• Increase the tyre pressure to the recom- tors are broken, then the combined instrument sudden movement and braking. 06
mended pressure for a full load. For tyre panel's symbol for direction indicators flashes
pressure label location, see page 301. faster than normal and the display shows the
Manual gearbox
• The engine is loaded more heavily than text Bulb fail - Ind. signal trailer.
usual when driving with a trailer. Overheating
If any of the trailer's lamps for the brake light
• Do not tow a heavy trailer when the car is are broken then the Bulb fail - Stop lamp When driving with a trailer in hilly terrain in a hot
brand new. Wait until it has been driven at trailer text is shown. climate there may be a risk of overheating.
least 1000 km.
• Do not run the engine at higher revolutions
• The brakes are loaded much more than Level control* than 4500 rpm (diesel engines: 3500 rpm)
usual on long and steep downhill slopes. The rear shock absorbers maintain a constant - otherwise the oil temperature may
Downshift to a lower gear and adjust your height irrespective of the car's load (up to the become too high.
speed. maximum permissible weight). When the car is

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 283


06 During your journey

Driving with a trailer

Diesel engine 5-cyl 2. Activate the parking brake. WARNING


• In the event of a risk of overheating the 3. Move the gear selector to position P.
optimal speed for the engine is 2300-3000 If the car is fitted with a Volvo detachable
rpm for optimal circulation of the coolant. 4. Release the foot brake. towbar:

• Move the gear selector to park position P • Follow the installation instructions care-
when parking an automatic car with a fully.
Automatic gearbox
hitched trailer. Always use the parking • The detachable section must be locked
Overheating brake. with the key before setting off.
When driving with a trailer in hilly terrain in a hot • Block the wheels with chocks when park- • Check that the indicator window shows
climate there may be a risk of overheating. ing a car with hitched trailer on a hill. green.
• An automatic gearbox selects the optimum Starting on a hill
gear related to load and engine speed. Important checks
1. Depress the foot brake.
• In the event of overheating a warning sym- • The towbar's towball must be cleaned and
bol illuminates on the instrument panel 2. Move the gear selector to driving posi- greased regularly.
combined with a text message - follow the tion D.
recommendation given. 3. Release the parking brake. NOTE
Steep inclines 4. Release the foot brake and start driving off. If a towball hitch with vibration damper is
• Do not lock the automatic transmission in used, it is not necessary to grease the tow-
06 a higher gear than the engine "can cope ball.
with" - it is not always a good idea to drive Towing bracket
at a high gear with low engine revolutions. If the car is equipped with a detachable towbar,
the installation instructions for the loose sec-
IMPORTANT tion must be followed carefully, see
See also the specific information on slow page 286.
driving with trailer for cars with the
Powershift automatic transmission on page
120.

Parking on a hill
1. Depress the foot brake.

284
06 During your journey

Driving with a trailer

Storing the detachable towbar Specifications

G021485
Towbar storage space. Dimensions, mounting points (mm)

IMPORTANT A 998

Always remove the towbar after use and B 80


store it in the appointed location in the car.
C 854
06
D 427

E 109

F 282

G Side member

H Ball centre

285
06 During your journey

Driving with a trailer

Attaching the towbar

G021488

G021490
G018928
The indicator window must show red. The indicator window must show green.
Remove the protective cover by first press-
ing in the catch and then pulling the
cover straight back .

G021489

G000000
06

Insert the towbar until you hear a click. Turn the key anticlockwise to locked posi-
G021487

tion. Remove the key from the lock.

Ensure that the mechanism is in the


unlocked position by turning the key clock-
wise.

286
06 During your journey

Driving with a trailer

G021494

G021495
Check that the towbar is secure by pulling Safety cable. Push in the locking wheel and turn it
it up, down and back. anticlockwise until you hear a click.
WARNING
WARNING
Be sure to attach the trailer's safety cable to
If the towbar is not fitted correctly then it the correct place.
must be detached and reattached in
accordance with the previous instructions.

IMPORTANT Removing the towbar


06
Only grease in the ball for the towing hitch,
the remainder of the towbar should be clean
and dry. Turn the locking wheel down fully, until it
comes to a stop. Hold it in this position
while pulling the towbar rearward and
upward.

WARNING
Insert the key and turn it clockwise to the Secure the towbar safely if it is stored in the
car, see page 285.
unlocked position.

287
06 During your journey

Driving with a trailer

• Car with trailer subjected to a sudden and NOTE


powerful side wind.
TSA function is switched off if the driver
• Car with trailer drives on an uneven road selects Sport mode, see page 168.
surface or in a pothole.
• Sweeping steering wheel movements. TSA may fail to engage if the driver uses severe
Operation steering wheel movements to try to rectify the

G018929
If snaking has started, it could be difficult or snaking because in such a situation the TSA
even impossible to suppress. This makes the system cannot determine whether it is the
car/trailer combination difficult to control and trailer or the driver that is causing the snaking.
Push the protective cover until it snaps
there is a risk that you could, for example, end The DSTC symbol in the combined
tight.
up in the wrong lane or leave the carriageway. instrument panel flashes when the
TSA system continually monitors car move- TSA is working.
Trailer Stability Assist - TSA*
ments, particularly lateral movements. If snak-
The TSA system (Trailer Stability Assist) serves ing is detected, the front wheels are individually
to stabilise the car and trailer combination if it braked. This serves to stabilise the car/trailer
begins to snake. combination. This is often enough to help the
The TSA function is part of the DSTC system driver regain control of the car.
(Dynamic Stability and Traction Control), see If snaking is not eliminated the first time the
06 page 168. TSA system comes into action, the car/trailer
Function combination is braked with all wheels and
The snaking phenomenon can occur with any engine power is reduced. Once snaking has
car/trailer combination. Normally, snaking been gradually suppressed and the car/trailer
occurs at extremely high speeds. But, there is combination is once again stable, the TSA sys-
a risk of it occurring at lower speeds tem stops regulating and the driver once again
(70-90 km/h) if the trailer is overloaded or the has full control of the car.
load is improperly distributed, e.g. too far back. Miscellaneous
In order for snaking to occur, there must be a The TSA system can engage within the speed
triggering factor, e.g.: interval 60 to 160 km/h.

288 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


06 During your journey

Towing and recovery

Towing WARNING lubrication. If towing still has to take place, the


Find out the statutory maximum speed limit for route must be as short as possible and then
The brake servo and power steering do not with very low speed.
towing before towing begins. work when the engine is switched off - the
1. Unlock the steering lock by inserting the brake pedal needs to be depressed In the event of uncertainty as to whether or not
remote control key in the ignition switch about 5 times more heavily and the steering the car is equipped with Powershift transmis-
is considerably heavier than normal. sion, this can be verified by checking the des-
and giving a long press on the START/
STOP ENGINE button - key position II is ignation on the decal number (5) under the
activated, see page 80 for more informa- Manual gearbox bonnet - see page 352. The designa-
tion on key positions. Prior to towing: tion ”MPS6” means that it is Powershift trans-
mission - otherwise it is Geartronic automatic
2. The remote control key must remain in the – Move gear lever into neutral and release transmission.
ignition switch while the car is being towed. the parking brake.
3. Keep the towline taut when the towing Automatic gearbox Geartronic IMPORTANT
vehicle reduces speed by holding your foot
Avoid towing.
gently pressed on the brake pedal -
IMPORTANT • However, the car can be towed for a
thereby avoiding unnecessary jerking.
Note that the car must always be towed with short distance at low speed to move it
4. Be prepared to brake to stop. the wheels rolling forward. from a dangerous position - not further
than 10 km and not faster than
WARNING • Cars with automatic gearbox must not
10 km/h. Note that the car must always
be towed at speeds above 80 km/h or 06
• Check that the steering lock is unlocked
further than 80 km.
be towed with the wheels rolling for-
before towing. ward.
• The remote control key must be in key
Prior to towing:
• In the event of moving a longer distance
position II - in position I all airbags are than 10 km, the car must be transported
deactivated. – Move the gear selector to position N and with the drive wheels raised from the
release the parking brake. road - professional recovery is recom-
• Never remove the remote control key
from the ignition switch when the car is mended.
being towed. Automatic gearbox Powershift
The model with Powershift transmission Prior to towing:
should not be towed as it is dependent on the
engine running in order to receive sufficient – Move the gear selector to position N and
release the parking brake.

289
06 During your journey

Towing and recovery

Jump starting Screw the towing eye right in up to its


Do not tow the car to bump start the engine. flange. Turn in the towing eye firmly e.g.
Use a donor battery if the battery is discharged using the wheel wrench.
and the engine does not start, see page 116. After use, unscrew the towing eye and
return it to its place.
IMPORTANT
Finish by refitting the cover onto the
The catalytic converter may be damaged bumper.
during attempts to tow-start the engine.
IMPORTANT
Towing eye The towing eye is only designed for towing
The towing eye is screwed into a threaded on roads - not for pulling the car unstuck or
socket behind a cover on the right-hand side Take out the towing eye that is located out of a ditch. Call a recovery service for
recovery assistance.
of the bumper, front or rear. under the floor hatch in the cargo area.

Attaching the towing eye The cover for the towing eye's attachment
point is available in two variants which NOTE
must be opened in different ways: On certain cars with towbar fitted the towing
eye cannot be attached in the rear bracket.
• Open the variant with a recess using a Attach the towrope in the towbar.
06 coin or similar inserted in the recess,
turning it outwards. Then turn out the For this reason it is advisable to store the
cover completely and remove it. detachable towbar's towball in the car.
• The second variant has a marking along
one side or in a corner: Press the mark-
ing with a finger and fold out the oppo-
site side/corner at the same time using
a coin or similar - the cover turns around
its axis and can then be removed.

290
06 During your journey

Towing and recovery

Recovery
Call a recovery service for recovery assistance.

IMPORTANT
Note that the car must always be transpor-
ted with the wheels rolling forward.
• An All Wheel Drive car (AWD) with raised
front suspension must not be towed at
speeds above 70 km/h. It should not be
towed further than 50 km.

06

291
General ................................................................................................. 294
Changing wheels .................................................................................. 298
Tyre pressure ....................................................................................... 301
Warning triangle and first-aid kit*.......................................................... 302
Tyre pressure monitoring (TPMS)*........................................................ 303
Emergency puncture repair (TMK) ....................................................... 305

292 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


WHEELS AND TYRES
07 Wheels and tyres

General

Driving characteristics Tyres with the greatest tread depth should New tyres
Tyres greatly affect the car's driving characte- always be fitted to the rear of the car (to
ristics. The type of tyre, dimensions, tyre pres- decrease the risk of skidding).
sure and speed rating are important for how the
car performs. NOTE
Direction of rotation Ensure that tyres of the same type and
dimensions, and also the same make, are
fitted to all four wheels.

Follow the recommended tyre pressures


specified in the tyre pressure table, see
page 366.

Tyre care Tyres are perishable. After a few years they


begin to harden at the same time as the friction
Tyre age capacity/characteristics gradually deteriorate.
For this reason, aim to get as fresh tyres as
G021778

All tyres older than 6 years old should be


checked by an expert even if they seem possible when you replace them. This is espe-
The arrow shows the tyre's direction of rotation. undamaged. Tyres age and decompose, even cially important with regard to winter tyres. The
if they are hardly ever or never used. The func- last four digits in the sequence mean the week
Tyres with a tread pattern which are designed tion can therefore be affected. This applies to and year of manufacture. This is the tyre's
to only turn in one direction have the direction all tyres that are stored for future use. Exam- DOT marking (Department of Transportation),
of rotation marked with an arrow. The tyre must ples of external signs which indicate that the and this is stated with four digits, for example
07
always rotate in the same direction throughout tyre is unsuitable for use are cracks or discol- 1510. The tyre in the illustration was manufac-
its lifespan. Tyres should only be switched oration. tured in week 15 of 2010.
between front and rear positions, never
between left and right-hand sides, or vice Summer and winter tyres
versa. If the tyres are fitted incorrectly, the car's When summer and winter wheels are changed
braking characteristics and capacity to force the wheels should be marked with which side
rain and slush out of the way are adversely of the car they were mounted on, for example
affected. L for left and R for right.

294
07 Wheels and tyres

General

Wear and maintenance Tyres with tread wear indicators Only use rims that are tested and approved by
The correct tyre pressure results in more even Volvo and which are Volvo genuine accesso-
wear, see page 301. Driving style, tyre pres- ries. Check the torque with a torque wrench.
sure, climate and road condition affect how
Locking wheel bolts*
quickly your tyres age and wear. To avoid dif-
Locking wheel bolts* can be used on both alu-
ferences in tread depth and to prevent wear
minium and steel rims. Under the cargo area
patterns arising, the front and rear wheels can
floor there is space for the sleeve for the lock-
be switched with each other. A suitable dis-
able wheel bolts.
tance for the first change is approx. 5000 km
and then at 10 000 km intervals. Volvo recom-
mends that you contact an authorised Volvo Tools

G021829
workshop for checking if you are uncertain
about tread depth. If significant differences in
wear (>1 mm difference in tread depth) Tread wear indicators.
between tyres have already occurred, the least
Tread wear indicators are narrow treadless
worn tyres must always be placed on the rear.
bands across the width of the tread. On the
Understeer is normally easier to correct than
side of the tyre are the letters TWI (Tread Wear
oversteer, and leads to the car continuing for-
Indicator). When the tyre's tread depth is down
wards in a straight line rather than having the
to 1.6 mm, the tread depth will be level in height
rear end skidding to one side, resulting in pos-
with the tread wear indicators. Change to new
sible complete loss of control over the car. This
tyres as soon as possible. Remember that
is why it is important for the rear wheels never
tyres with little tread depth provide very poor
to lose grip before the front wheels.
grip in rain and snow.
Wheels should be stored lying down or hanging Located under the cargo area floor are the 07
up - and not standing up. Rims and wheel bolts
car's towing eye, jack* and wheel wrench*.
There is also space for the sleeve for the lock-
WARNING IMPORTANT able wheel bolts.
A damaged tyre can lead to loss of control The wheel bolts must be tightened to
of the car. 140 Nm. Overtightening can damage the
nuts and the bolts.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 295


07 Wheels and tyres

General

Jack* Winter tyres Using snow chains


The original jack should only be used for Volvo recommends winter tyres with particular Snow chains may only be used on the front
changing to the spare wheel. The jack's thread dimensions. Tyre dimensions are dependent wheels (also applies to all-wheel drive cars).
must always be well greased. on engine variant. When driving on winter tyres, Never drive faster than 50 km/h with snow
Tools - returning into place the correct type of tyres must be fitted to all chains. Avoid driving on bare ground as this
four wheels. wears out both the snow chains and tyres.

NOTE WARNING
Volvo recommends that you consult a Volvo Use Volvo genuine snow chains or equiva-
dealer about which wheel rim and tyre types lent chains designed for the car model, and
are most suitable. tyre and rim dimensions. In the event of
uncertainty Volvo recommends that you
Studded tyres consult an authorised Volvo workshop. The
wrong snow chains may cause serious
Studded winter tyres should be run in gently for damage to your car and lead to an accident.
500-1000 km so the studs settle properly into
G029336

the tyres. This gives the tyre, and especially the


studs, a longer service life. Specifications
The tools and jack* must be returned to their The car has whole vehicle approval. This
correct places after use. The jack needs to be NOTE means that certain combinations of wheels and
cranked together to the correct position in The legal provisions for the use of studded tyres are approved. For the permissible com-
order to have space. tyres vary from country to country. binations, see page 366

IMPORTANT Wheel (rim) dimensions


07 Tread depth Wheels (rims) have a designation of dimen-
The tools and jack* must be stored in the Road conditions with ice, slush and low tem- sions, for example: 7Jx16x50.
intended location in the car's cargo area peratures place considerably higher demands
when not in use. on tyres than summer conditions. Volvo there-
7 Rim width in inches
fore recommends not to drive on winter tyres
that have a tread depth of less than 4 millime- J Rim flange profile
tres.

296 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


07 Wheels and tyres

General

16 Rim diameter in mum permitted index is specified in the table, V 240 km/h
inches see page 366.
W 270 km/h
50 Off-set in mm (dis- Speed ratings
tance from wheel Each tyre can withstand a certain maximum Y 300 km/h
centre to wheel con- speed, a speed rating (Speed Symbol; SS).
tact surface against Tyre speed class must at least correspond with WARNING
the hub) the car's top speed. Minimum permitted speed
The car must be fitted with tyres which have
rating is specified in the table, see page 366. the same or a higher load index (LI) and
Tyre dimensions speed rating (SS) than specified. If a tyre
The only exception to these conditions is win-
The dimensions are stated on all car tyres. with too low a load index or speed rating is
ter tyres (both those with metal studs and those
Example of designation: 215/55R16 97W. used, it may overheat.
without), where a lower speed rating may be
used. If such a tyre is chosen, the car must not
215 Tyre width (mm) be driven faster than the speed rating of the
tyre (for example, class Q can be driven at a
55 Ratio between tyre wall height and
maximum of 160 km/h).
tyre width (%)
Traffic regulations determine how fast a car
R Radial ply can be driven, not the speed rating of the tyres.
16 Rim diameter in inches (")
NOTE
97 Codes for the maximum permitted
It is the maximum permitted speed that is
tyre load, tyre load index (LI) stated in the table.
W Speed rating for maximum permitted 07
speed, speed rating (SS). (In this case Q 160 km/h (used only on winter tyres)
270 km/h).
T 190 km/h
Load index
Each tyre has a certain capacity to carry a load, H 210 km/h
a load index (LI). The car's weight determines
the load capacity required of the tyres. Mini-

297
07 Wheels and tyres

Changing wheels

Removing Use heavy wooden blocks or large stones


Set up the warning triangle, see page 302 if a for example.
wheel must be replaced at a busy location. The 4. Cars with steel rims have removable wheel
car and jack* must be on a firm horizontal sur- covers. Use the removal tool to hook in and
face. pull off any full-wheel wheel covers. Alter-
1. Apply the parking brake and engage natively, the wheel covers can be pulled
reverse gear, or position P if the car has an away by hand.
automatic gearbox.

WARNING
Check that the jack is not damaged, that the
threads are thoroughly lubricated and that it
is free from dirt. IMPORTANT
The towing eye must be screwed into all
NOTE threads in the wheel bolt wrench.
Volvo recommends only using the jack* that
belongs to the car model in question, which 6. Loosen the wheel bolts ½-1 turn anticlock-
is indicated on the jack's label. wise with the wheel wrench.
The label also indicates the jack's maximum 5. Screw together the towing eye with the
lift capacity at a specified minimum lifting WARNING
wheel wrench* until the stop position as
height.
illustrated below. Never position anything between the
ground and the jack, nor between the jack
07
2. Take out the jack*, wheel wrench* and and the car's jacking point.
removal tool for wheel covers* located
under the cargo floor in the cargo area. If 7. There are two jacking points on each side
another jack is selected, see page 312. of the car. There is a recess in the plastic
3. Place chocks in front of and behind the cover at each point. Crank the foot of the
wheels which will remain on the ground.

298 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


07 Wheels and tyres

Changing wheels

jack down so it is pressed squarely on the 3. Lower the car so that the wheels cannot WARNING
ground. rotate.
Never crawl under the car when it is raised
on the jack.
Passengers must leave the car when it is
raised on the jack.
Park the car so that passengers have the car
- or preferably a crash barrier - between
them and the road.

Spare wheel*
The spare wheel (Temporary spare) is only
intended for use temporarily and must be
replaced by an ordinary wheel as soon as pos-
4. Tighten the wheel bolts crosswise. It is sible. The car's handling may be altered by the
IMPORTANT important that the wheel bolts are tight- use of the spare wheel. The spare wheel is
The ground must be firm, smooth and level. ened properly. Tighten to 140 Nm. Check smaller than the normal wheel. The car's
the torque with a torque wrench. ground clearance is affected accordingly. Pay
attention to high kerbs and do not machine
8. Lift the car so that the wheel is free. 5. Refit any full wheel covers.
wash the car. If the spare wheel is fitted on the
Remove the wheel bolts and lift off the front axle, you cannot use snow chains at the
wheel. NOTE same time. On all-wheel drive cars the drive on
The wheel cover outlet for the valve must be the rear axle can be disconnected. The spare
Installation positioned over the valve on the wheel rim wheel must not be repaired. The correct tyre 07
1. Clean the contact surfaces between wheel during fitting. pressure for the spare wheel is stated in the
and hub. tyre pressure table, see page 366.
2. Put on the wheel. Tighten the wheel bolts
thoroughly.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 299


07 Wheels and tyres

Changing wheels

IMPORTANT spare wheel and through the lower handle. 2. Fold up the cargo area floor.
Tighten the short tensioning strap onto the long
Never drive faster than 80 km/h with a spare 3. Lift the tools and jack out from the foam
one. Attach the second load retaining eyelet
wheel on the car. block.
and tighten.

IMPORTANT
The car must never be driven fitted with
more than one temporary spare wheel.

The spare wheel must be stored on the cargo


floor in the cargo area, fitted in the spare wheel
bag and secured with straps.

Cars with four load retaining eyelets.


Turn the handle on the spare wheel bag out
towards you. Attach the sewn-in tensioning
strap hooks in the front load retaining eyelets.
Attach the long strap into one of the front load
retaining eyelets, run the strap diagonally over
the spare wheel and through the upper handle.
07 Tighten the short tensioning strap onto the long
one. Attach the rear load retaining eyelet and
Cars with two load retaining eyelets.
tighten.
Turn the handle on the spare wheel bag in
towards the rear seat. Attach the sewn-in ten- Taking out the spare wheel
sioning strap hooks in the load retaining eye- 1. Loosen the straps, lift out the spare wheel
lets. Attach the long strap into one of the load from the cargo area and remove it from the
retaining eyelets, run the strap around the spare wheel bag.

300
07 Wheels and tyres

Tyre pressure

Tyre pressure Fuel economy, ECO pressure


At speeds under 160 km/h, the general tyre
pressure is recommended (applies for both full
load and light load) in order to obtain optimum
fuel economy.

Checking the tyre pressure


The tyre pressures must be checked every
month.
Check tyre pressures on cold tyres. "Cold
tyres" means the tyres are the same tempera-
G021830
ture as the ambient temperature. After several
kilometres of driving, the tyres warm up and the
pressure increases.
The tyre pressure decal on the driver's side
door pillar (between frame and rear door) Inadequate tyre pressure increases fuel con-
shows which pressures the tyres should have sumption, shortens tyre lifespan and impairs
at different loads and speed conditions. This is the car's roadholding. Driving on tyres with tyre
also specified in the tyre pressure table, see pressure that is too low could result in the tyres
page 366. overheating and being damaged. Tyre pres-
sure affects travelling comfort, road noise and
• Tyre pressure for the car's recommended
tyre dimension steering characteristics.

• ECO pressure1 NOTE


07
NOTE Tyre pressure decreases over time, this is a
natural phenomenon. Tyre pressure also
Temperature differences change the varies depending on ambient temperature.
tyre pressure.

1 ECO pressure results in improved fuel economy.

301
07 Wheels and tyres

Warning triangle and first-aid kit*

Warning triangle Lift the floor hatch and take out the warning First aid kit*
triangle.
Take the warning triangle from the case,
fold out and assemble the two loose sides.
Fold out the warning triangle's support
legs.
Follow the regulations for the use of a warning
triangle. Position the warning triangle in a suit-
able place with regard to traffic.
Ensure the warning triangle and its case are
properly secured in the cargo area after use.

NOTE A case with first aid equipment is located under


the floor in the cargo area.
If the car has been locked with privacy lock-
ing then the boot lid/tailgate and floor hatch
cannot be opened, see page 51.

07

302 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


07 Wheels and tyres

Tyre pressure monitoring (TPMS)*

General IMPORTANT 5. Start the car and drive at least at 40 km/h


TPMS (Tyre Pressure Monitoring System)* for a total of at least 1 minute and check
If a fault should arise in the tyre pressure that the message disappears.
warns the driver when the pressure is too low
system a warning lamp on the instru-
in one or more of the car's tyres. It uses sensors > Calibration is complete.
ment panel will illuminate and a message
located inside the air valve in each wheel. will be shown. This can be for various rea-
When the car is driven at about 40 km/h the Rectifying low tyre pressure
sons, e.g. fitting a wheel not equipped with
system detects the tyre pressure. If the pres- a sensor adapted for Volvo's tyre pressure If a message for low tyre pressure is shown in
sure is too low then a warning lamp on the monitoring system. the display:
instrument panel illuminates and a message is 1. Check the tyre pressure in all four tyres.
shown on the display. Adjusting tyre pressure monitoring 2. Inflate the tyre(s) to the correct pressure.
Only factory fitted wheels are equipped with Tyre pressure monitoring can be adjusted in
order to follow Volvo's tyre pressure recom- 3. Drive at least at 40 km/h for a total of at
TPMS sensors in the valves.
mendations, when driving with a heavy load for least 1 minute and check that the message
If wheels without TPMS sensors are used then example. disappears.
Tyre press. syst Service required will be
shown every time the car is driven faster than Deactivating/activating tyre pressure
NOTE monitoring
40 km/h for more than 10 minutes.
The engine must not be running when the
Always check the system after changing a tyres are calibrated.
wheel in order to ensure that replacement
NOTE
wheels work with the system. The engine must not be running when tyre
The settings are made with the control in the pressure monitoring is activated/deacti-
For information on correct tyre pressures, see centre console, see page 145. vated.
page 366.
1. Inflate the tyres to the required pressure
The system does not replace normal tyre main- and select key position I or II. The settings are made with the control in the 07
tenance. centre console, see page 145.
2. Select the menu system MY CAR to open
the menus to Settings Tyre pressure 1. Select key position I or II.

3. Select Calibrate tyre pressure. 2. Select the system MY CAR to open the
menus to Car settings Tyre pressure
4. Press OK.
3. Select Tyre pressure system and press
OK.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 303


07 Wheels and tyres

Tyre pressure monitoring (TPMS)*

> A X is shown in the display if the system max. 80 km/h. The tyre must be replaced as
is activated, the option disappears if the soon as possible.
system is deactivated. Drive carefully, in some cases it can be difficult
Recommendations to see which tyre is faulty. In order to establish
• Volvo recommends that TPMS sensors are which tyre needs attention, check all four tyres.
fitted to all wheels on the car.
• Volvo recommends that sensors are not WARNING
moved between different wheels. SST tyres should only be fitted by individu-
als with expertise on SST tyres.
WARNING SST tyres must only be fitted together with
When inflating a tyre equipped with TPMS, TPMS.
hold the nozzle of the pump directly against After a fault message on low tyre pressure
the valve to avoid damaging the valve. has been shown, do not drive faster than
80 km/h.
Maximum driving distance to tyre change is
Driveable punctured tyres* 80 km.
If Self Supporting run flat Tyres (SST)* have
Avoid hard driving such as sudden braking
been selected then the car is also equipped or turning.
with TPMS.
SST tyres must be replaced if they are dam-
This type of tyre has a specially reinforced side aged or punctured.
wall that makes continued driving possible to
a limited extent despite the tyre losing all or
07 some of its pressure. These tyres are fitted on
a special rim. (Normal tyres can also be fitted
to this rim).
If an SST tyre loses tyre pressure then the yel-
low TPMS lamp on the instrument panel illumi-
nates and a message is shown in the text
panel. If this occurs, reduce speed to

304 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


07 Wheels and tyres

Emergency puncture repair (TMK)

General the wall. Do not seal tyres with the emergency Overview
puncture repair kit if they have larger slits,
cracks or similar damage.
For connecting the compressor there are 12 V
sockets in the centre console and by the rear
seat, as well as a 12 V socket in the cargo
area*. Choose the electrical socket that is near-
est the punctured tyre.

Location of the emergency puncture


repair kit
Set up the warning triangle if a tyre is being
sealed in a trafficked location. The emergency
puncture repair kit is located under the floor in Label, maximum permitted speed
Emergency puncture repair (TMK; Temporary
the cargo area, see page 302.
Mobility Kit) is used to seal a puncture and Switch
check and adjust tyre pressure. It consists of a
compressor and a bottle with sealing fluid. The WARNING Cable
kit works as a temporary repair. The sealing You should not drive faster than 80 km/h
fluid bottle must be replaced before its expira- after the emergency tyre repair kit has been Bottle holder (orange cap)
tion date and after use. used. Volvo recommends that you visit an
Protective cap
authorised Volvo workshop for inspection of
The sealing fluid effectively seals tyres punc- the sealed tyre (maximum driving distance Pressure reducing valve
tured in the tread. is 200 km). The staff there can determine
whether or not the tyre can be repaired or if Air hose
it needs to be replaced. 07
NOTE
Sealing fluid bottle
The emergency puncture repair kit is only
intended for sealing tyres with a puncture in Pressure gauge
the tread.

The emergency puncture repair kit has limited


capacity to seal tyres which have punctures in

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 305


07 Wheels and tyres

Emergency puncture repair (TMK)

Sealing punctured tyres WARNING WARNING


The sealing fluid can irritate the skin. In the Do not leave children in the car without
case of contact with skin, wash away the supervision when the engine is running.
fluid with soap and water.
8. Flick the switch to position I.
3. Check that the switch is in position 0 and
locate the cable and the air hose. WARNING
Never stand next to the tyre when the com-
NOTE pressor is running. If cracks or unevenness
Do not break the bottle's seal before use. arise then the compressor must be
The seal is broken automatically when the switched off immediately. The journey
bottle is screwed in. should not be continued. Contacting an
authorised tyre centre is recommended.
4. Unscrew the orange cap and unscrew the
bottle's stopper. NOTE
5. Screw the bottle into its holder. When the compressor starts, the pressure
can increase up to 6 bar but the pressure
WARNING drops after approximately 30 seconds.
G014338

Do not unscrew the bottle, it is equipped


with a reverse catch to prevent leakage. 9. Inflate the tyre for 7 minutes.
For information on the function of the parts, see
preceding illustration. IMPORTANT
07 6. Unscrew the wheel's dust cap and screw
1. Open the lid of the emergency puncture in the air hose valve connection to the bot- Risk of overheating. The compressor must
repair kit. tom of the thread on the tyre's air valve. not run for more than 10 minutes.
2. Detach the label for maximum permitted 7. Plug the cable into the 12 V socket and
speed and affix it to the steering wheel. start the car. 10. Switch off the compressor to check the
pressure on the pressure gauge. Minimum

306
07 Wheels and tyres

Emergency puncture repair (TMK)

pressure is 1.8 bar and maximum 3.5 bar. tyre pressure table, see page 366 (1 WARNING
(Release air with the pressure reducing bar=100 kPa). Release air using the
valve if the tyre pressure is too high.) pressure reducing valve if the tyre pres- You should not drive faster than 80 km/h
sure is too high. after the emergency tyre repair kit has been
used. Volvo recommends that you visit an
WARNING authorised Volvo workshop for inspection of
WARNING the sealed tyre (maximum driving distance
If the pressure is below 1.8 bar then the hole
in the tyre is too big. The journey should not Do not unscrew the bottle, it is equipped is 200 km). The staff there can determine
be continued. Contacting an authorised tyre with a reverse catch to prevent leakage. whether or not the tyre can be repaired or if
centre is recommended. it needs to be replaced.

3. Make sure the compressor is switched off.


11. Switch off the compressor and unplug the Detach the air hose and cable. Refit the Inflating the tyres
cable from the 12 V socket. dust cap. The car's original tyres can be inflated by the
12. Detach the hose from the tyre valve and fit compressor.
the valve cap. NOTE
1. The compressor must be switched off.
13. As soon as possible, drive approximately The sealing fluid bottle and the hose must Make sure that the switch is in position 0
3 km at a maximum speed of 80 km/h so be replaced after use. Volvo recommends and locate the cable and air hose.
that this replacement is performed by an
that the sealing fluid can seal the tyre. 2. Unscrew the wheel's dust cap and screw
authorised Volvo workshop.
Rechecking the repair and pressure in the air hose valve connection to the bot-
1. Reconnect the equipment. tom of the thread on the tyre's air valve.
WARNING
2. Read the tyre pressure on the pressure Check the tyre pressure regularly. WARNING
gauge.
Inhaling car exhaust fumes can result in
• If it is below 1.3 bar then the tyre is Volvo recommends that you drive to the near- 07
danger to life. Never leave the engine run-
insufficiently sealed. The journey should est authorised Volvo workshop for the replace- ning in sealed areas or areas that lack suf-
not be continued. Contact a tyre centre. ment/repair of the damaged tyre. Advise the ficient ventilation.
• If the tyre pressure is higher than 1.3 workshop that the tyre contains sealing fluid.
bar, the tyre must be inflated to the pres-
sure specified in accordance with the

307
07 Wheels and tyres

Emergency puncture repair (TMK)

WARNING Replacing the sealing fluid canister


Replace the bottle when the expiration date
Do not leave children in the car without
supervision when the engine is running. has passed. Treat the old bottle as environ-
mentally hazardous waste.

3. Connect the cable to one of the car's 12 V


WARNING
sockets and start the car.
The bottle contains 1.2-Ethanol and natural
4. Start the compressor by flicking the switch rubber-latex.
to position I.
Harmful if ingested. Could result in allergic
reaction in the event of skin contact.
IMPORTANT
Avoid contact with the skin and eyes.
Risk of overheating. The compressor must
not run for more than 10 minutes. Store out of the reach of children.

5. Inflate the tyre to the pressure specified in


accordance with the tyre pressure table,
see page 366. (Release air using the pres-
sure reducing valve if the tyre pressure is
too high.)
6. Switch off the compressor. Detach the air
hose and cable.
7. Refit the dust cap.
07

308
07 Wheels and tyres

07

309
Engine compartment............................................................................. 312
Lamps................................................................................................... 319
Wiper blades and washer fluid.............................................................. 325
Battery................................................................................................... 327
Fuses..................................................................................................... 333
Car care................................................................................................ 344

310
MAINTENANCE AND SERVICE
08 Maintenance and service

Engine compartment

General WARNING If the car is raised with a workshop jack; posi-


tion the jack against the front edge on the
Volvo service programme Remember that the radiator fan (located at engine's subframe.
To keep the car as safe and reliable as possi- the front of the engine compartment, behind
ble, follow the Volvo service programme as the radiator) may start automatically some Do not damage the splashguard under the
after the engine has been switched off. engine. Ensure that the workshop jack is posi-
specified in the Service and Warranty Booklet.
Volvo recommends engaging an authorised Always have the engine cleaned by a work- tioned so that the car cannot slide off the jack.
Volvo workshop to perform the service and shop. There is a risk of fire if the engine is Always use axle stands or similar.
maintenance work. Volvo workshops have the hot.
If you raise the car using a two-pillar workshop
personnel, special tools and service literature
lift, ensure that the front and rear lift arms are
to guarantee the highest quality of service. Raising the car
fixed under the lifting points. See preceding
illustration.
IMPORTANT NOTE
For the Volvo warranty to apply, check and Volvo recommends only using the jack that Opening and closing the bonnet
follow the instructions in the Service and belongs to the car model in question. If a
Warranty Booklet. jack is selected other than the one recom-
mended by Volvo, follow the instructions for
use supplied with the equipment.
Check regularly
Check the following oils and fluids at regular
intervals, e.g. when refuelling:
• Coolant
• Engine oil
• Power steering fluid
The handle for bonnet opening is always on the
• Washer fluid left-hand side.

08

312
08 Maintenance and service

Engine compartment

Engine compartment, overview Filling washer fluid


Air filter

WARNING
The ignition system has very high voltage
and output. The voltage in the ignition sys-
tem is highly dangerous. The remote control
key must always be in 0 position when work
is being done in the engine compartment,
Turn the handle about 20-25 degrees see page 80.
clockwise. You will hear when the catch
releases. Do not touch the spark plugs or ignition coil
when the remote control key is in II position
Move the catch to the left and open the The appearance of the engine compartment may or when the engine is hot.
bonnet. (The catch hook is located vary depending on engine variant.
between the headlamp and grille, see illus- Coolant expansion tank
tration.) Checking the engine oil
Power steering fluid reservoir
WARNING Engine oil dipstick1
Check that the bonnet locks properly when
closed. Radiator
Filling engine oil
Reservoir for brake and clutch fluid
(located on the driver's side)
Battery
Relay and fuse box
08

1 Engines with electronic oil level sensor have no dipstick (5-cyl. diesel).

313
08 Maintenance and service

Engine compartment

Volvo recommends Castrol oil products. driver is informed via the warning symbol in the Checking the oil level in a new car is especially
centre of the instrument unit as well as by dis- important before the first scheduled oil change.
When driving under adverse conditions, see
play texts. Certain models have both variants.
page 359. Volvo recommends checking the oil level every
Contact a Volvo dealer for more information.
2 500 km. The most accurate measurements
IMPORTANT Change the engine oil and oil filter in accord- are made on a cold engine before starting. The
In order to fulfil the requirements for the ance with the intervals specified in the Service measurement will be inaccurate if taken imme-
engine's service intervals all engines are and Warranty Booklet. diately after the engine is switched off. The
filled with a specially adapted synthetic dipstick will indicate that the level is too low
engine oil at the factory. The choice of oil Using oil of a higher than specified grade is
because the oil has not had time to flow down
has been made very carefully with regard to permitted. If the car is driven in adverse con-
into the oil sump.
service life, starting characteristics, fuel ditions, Volvo recommends using an oil of a
consumption and environmental impact. higher grade, see page 359.
An approved engine oil must be used in For capacities, see page 360 and onwards.
order that the recommended service inter-
vals can be applied. Only use a prescribed Engine with oil dipstick2
grade of oil for both filling and oil change,
otherwise you will risk affecting service life,
starting characteristics, fuel consumption
and environmental impact.
Volvo Car Corporation disclaims all war-
ranty liability if engine oil of the prescribed

G021737
grade and viscosity is not used.
Volvo recommends that oil changes are car-
ried out at an authorised Volvo workshop. The oil level must be between the MIN and MAX
marks.

G021734
Volvo uses different systems for warning of Measurement and filling if required
low/high oil level or low/high oil pressure. Cer- 1. Ensure that the car is level. After switching
tain variants have an oil pressure sensor, and Dipstick and filler pipe. off the engine it is important to wait
08 then the lamp for oil pressure is used. Other
variants have an oil level sensor, and then the

2 Only applies to petrol and 4-cyl. diesel.

314
08 Maintenance and service

Engine compartment

5 minutes to allow the oil time to run back Engine with electronic oil level sensor3
to the sump.
2. Pull up and wipe the dipstick.
3. Re-insert the dipstick.
4. Pull it out and check the level.
5. If the level is close to MIN then 0.5 litres
should be added. If the level is significantly
below, then an additional amount is
required.
6. If required, check the level again, do it after
driving a short distance. Then repeat steps Message and graph in the display.
1 - 4. Filler pipe.4 Message
WARNING You do not need to take action with respect to Engine oil level
the engine oil level before a message is shown
Never fill above the MAX mark. The level in the display, see the illustration below. The oil level is checked using the electronic oil
should never be above MAX or below MIN level gauge with the thumbwheel when the
as this could lead to engine damage. engine is switched off,see page 142.

WARNING WARNING
Do not spill oil onto the hot exhaust manifold If the message Oil service required is
due to the risk of fire. shown, visit a workshop. The oil level may
be too high.

08

3 Only applies to 5-cyl. diesel.


4 Engines with electronic oil level sensor have no dipstick (5-cyl. diesel).

315
08 Maintenance and service

Engine compartment

IMPORTANT Measuring the oil level Coolant


If the oil level needs to be checked then it
In the event of the message Oil level low should be carried out in accordance with the Checking the level and topping up
Refill 0,5 Ltr, only fill with 0.5 litres.
sequence below.
1. Activate key position II, see page 80.
NOTE
2. Rotate the thumbwheel on the left-hand
The oil level is only detected by the system stalk switch to position Engine oil level
during driving. The system cannot directly
Wait....
detect changes when the oil is filled or
drained. The car must be driven > You will then see information displayed
about 30 km before the oil level display is about the engine oil level.
correct.

WARNING
Do not fill more oil if filling level (3) or (4) When topping up the coolant, follow the
appears as shown in the illustration below. instructions on the packaging. It is important
The level must never be above MAX or
below MIN, as this could lead to engine that the mixture of coolant concentrate and
damage. water is correct for the prevailing weather con-
ditions. Never top up with water only. The risk
of freezing increases with both too little and too
WARNING much coolant concentrate.

Do not spill oil onto the hot exhaust manifold


The figures 1-4 represent filling level. Do not fill WARNING
due to the risk of fire.
more oil if filling level (3) or (4) is shown. Recom-
Coolant can be very hot. If the coolant
mended filling level is 4.
requires topping up when the engine is at
operating temperature, unscrew the expan-
sion tank cap slowly to gently release the
08 overpressure.

316
08 Maintenance and service

Engine compartment

For capacities and for standards regarding IMPORTANT Brake and clutch fluid
water quality, see page 361.
• A high content of chlorine, chlorides Checking the level
Check the coolant regularly and other salts may cause corrosion in Brake and clutch fluid have a common reser-
The level must lie between the MIN and MAX the cooling system. voir. The level must be between the MIN and
marks on the expansion tank. If the system is • Always use coolant with anti-corrosion MAX marks that are visible inside the reservoir.
not filled sufficiently, high temperatures could agent as recommended by Volvo. Check the level regularly.
occur, causing a risk of damage to the engine.
• Ensure that the coolant mixture is 50% Change the brake fluid every other year or at
water and 50% coolant. every other regular service.
• Mix the coolant with approved quality For capacities and recommended fluid grade,
tap water. In the event of any doubt see page 361. The fluid should be changed
about water quality, used ready-mixed
annually on cars driven in conditions requiring
coolant in accordance with Volvo rec-
hard, frequent braking, such as driving in
ommendations.
mountains or tropical climates with high
• When changing coolant/replacing cool- humidity.
ing system components, flush the cool-
ing system clean with approved quality
WARNING
tap water or flush with ready-mixed
coolant. If the brake fluid is under the MIN level in the
brake fluid reservoir, do not drive further
• The engine must only be run with a well-
before topping up the brake fluid. Volvo rec-
filled cooling system. Otherwise, tem-
ommends that the reason for the loss of
peratures that are too high may occur brake fluid is investigated by an authorised
resulting in the risk of damage (cracks) Volvo workshop.
in the cylinder head.

08

317
08 Maintenance and service

Engine compartment

Filling Power steering fluid

Brake fluid reservoir location.


The fluid reservoir is protected under the cover IMPORTANT
over the cold zone in the engine compartment.
Keep the area around the power steering
The round cover must be removed first before fluid reservoir clean when checking. The
the reservoir cap can be reached. cover must not be opened.
1. Turn and open the cover located on the
covering. Check the level frequently. The fluid does not
2. Unscrew the reservoir cap and fill the fluid. require changing. The fluid level must be
The level must be between the MIN and between the MIN and MAX marks. For capaci-
MAX marks, which are located on the ties and recommended fluid grade, see
inside of the reservoir. page 361.

IMPORTANT NOTE
Do not forget to refit the cap. If a fault should arise in the power steering
08 system or if the engine is switched off and
the car must be towed, it can still be steered.

318
08 Maintenance and service

Lamps

General IMPORTANT
All bulbs are specified, see page 324. The fol-
Never touch the glass part of the bulbs with
lowing list contains locations of bulbs and your fingers. Grease and oils from your fin-
other light sources that are specialised or gers are vaporised by the heat, coating the
unsuitable for changing except at a workshop: reflector and then causing damage.
• Active Xenon headlamps - ABL (Xenon
lamps)
Headlamps front
• Direction indicators, door mirrors
• Approach lighting, door mirrors
• Courtesy lighting
• Glovebox lighting
• General interior lighting in the roof All of the headlamp bulbs are replaced via the
engine compartment. Loosen and remove the
• Reading lamps whole headlamp.
• Side position, position lamps rear
WARNING
• Brake light
• LED lights, general The remote control key must not be turned
to key position I or II during bulb replace-
ment.
WARNING
See the section "Key positions" - for a
On cars with Xenon headlamps, the description of the remote control key's 3 key
replacement of Xenon lamps must be car- positions.
ried out at a workshop - an authorised Volvo
workshop is recommended. Working with
Xenon lamps demands extreme caution Removing the headlamp
because the headlamp is equipped with a 1. Make sure the remote control key is in key
high voltage unit. position 0, see page 80:
2. (First illustration) 08

319
08 Maintenance and service

Lamps

Pull out the headlamp's locking pins. Securing the headlamp Removing the cover
Release the headlamp by alternately
tilting and pulling it out.

IMPORTANT
Do not pull the electrical cable, only the con-
nector.

3. (Second illustration)
Detach the headlamp connector by
pressing down the clip with your thumb.
At the same time, guide out the con- 1. Plug in the connector, a clicking sound Before starting to replace a bulb, see
nector with your other hand. should be heard. page 319.
4. Lift out the headlamp and place it on a soft 2. Reinstall the headlamp and locking pins. 1. Unscrew the cover's four screws with the
surface to avoid scratching the lens. The short pin is fitted closest to the grille. tool (1) in the tool kit, see page 294. They
Check that they are correctly inserted. should not be detached completely.
5. Replace the bulb in question.
3. Check the lighting. (3 - 4 turns are sufficient.)

The headlamp must be mounted and the con-


IMPORTANT
nector correctly installed before the lighting is
switched on or the remote control key is Use the tool in the toolkit to remove and
inserted into the ignition switch. attach this correctly.

2. Slide the cover to one side.


3. Remove the cover.
08
Reinstall the cover in reverse order.

320
08 Maintenance and service

Lamps

Dipped beam, halogen Main beam, Halogen Extra main beam, ABL headlamps*

1. Detach the headlamp, see page 319. 1. Detach the headlamp. 1. Detach the headlamp.
2. Remove the cover. 2. Remove the cover, see page 320 2. Remove the cover, see page 320.
3. Unplug the connector from the bulb. 3. Detach the bulb by turning anticlockwise 3. Detach the bulb by turning anticlockwise
and then pulling straight out and then pulling straight out
4. Detach the bulb by pulling it straight out.
4. Unplug the connector from the bulb. 4. Unplug the connector from the bulb.
5. The guide pin on the lamp should be
straight up when it is fitted and a clicking 5. Replace the bulb and align it in the socket 5. Replace the bulb and align it in the socket
sound should be heard when it clicks into and turn clockwise in order to secure it. It and turn clockwise in order to secure it. It
place. can be secured in one position. can only be secured in one position.
Reinstall the parts in reverse order. Reinstall the parts in reverse order. Reinstall the parts in reverse order.

08

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 321


08 Maintenance and service

Lamps

Direction indicators/flashers Lamp housing, rear 7. Refit the insulation and panel.

NOTE
If an error message remains after the broken
bulb has been replaced then we recom-
mend that you visit an authorised Volvo
workshop.

Location of rear bulbs

1. Detach the headlamp. The reversing, fog and direction indicator bulbs
in the rear lamp cluster are replaced from inside
2. Detach the cover by pulling it straight out.
the cargo area.
3. Pull the bulb holder in order to extract the
1. Open the panel.
bulb.
2. Remove the insulation that is fitted in front
4. Press and simultaneously turn the bulb to
of the bulb holder by pulling it straight out.
detach it.
3. Press down the catch and pull out the bulb
Reinstall the parts in reverse order.
holder. Lamp lens, right-hand side
4. Remove the blown bulb by pressing it in Brake light (LED)
and turning anticlockwise.
Direction indicators
5. Fit a new bulb, press down and turn clock-
wise. Reversing lamp
08 6. Press down the catch when the bulb holder Rear fog lamp (driver's side)
is refitted.

322
08 Maintenance and service

Lamps

Number plate lighting Lighting, cargo area Vanity mirror lighting


Removal of lamp lens

G031942
1. Remove the screws with a screwdriver. 1. Insert a screwdriver and gently prize so
that the lamp housing comes loose.
2. Carefully detach the whole lamp housing 1. Insert a screwdriver under the lamp lens
and withdraw it. 2. Replace the bulb. and gently prize up the lug on the edge.
3. Replace the bulb. 3. Check that the bulb illuminates and press 2. Carefully detach and lift aside the lamp
back the lamp housing. lens.
4. Refit the whole lamp housing and screw it
into place. 3. Pull the bulb straight out to the side and
replace it with a new one.

Attaching the lamp lens


1. Refit the lamp lens.
2. Press it into place.

08

``

323
08 Maintenance and service

Lamps

Specification, bulbs Lighting WA Type


Lighting WA Type
Reversing lamp 21 P21W LL
Dipped beam, 55 H7 LL
Rear fog lamp 21 H21W LL
halogen
A Watt
Main beam, 65 H9
Halogen

Extra main 65 H9
beam, ABL

Front direction 21 HY21W


indicators

Courtesy light- 3 T10 Socket


ing front W2.1x9.5d

Glovebox light- 5 Socket SV8.5


ing Length 43 mm

Vanity mirror 1.2 T5 Socket


lighting W2x4.6d

Cargo area 10 Socket SV8.5


lighting Length 43 mm

Number plate 5 C5W LL


lighting

Direction indi- 21 PY21W SV


08 cators, rear

- - -

324
08 Maintenance and service

Wiper blades and washer fluid

Wiper blades Replacing the wiper blades Lift up the wiper arm. Press the button
located on the wiper blade mounting and
Service position pull straight out parallel with the wiper arm.
Slide in the new wiper blade until a "click"
is heard.
Check that the blade is firmly installed.

In order to change, clean or lift the wiper blades


(for scraping off ice from the windscreen) they

G021763
must be in service position.
1. Turn the remote control key to key position
0, see page 80, and keep the remote con-
trol key in the ignition switch. NOTE
2. Move the right-hand stalk switch up for The wiper blades are different lengths. The
about 1 second. The wipers then move to blade on the driver's side is longer than the
standing straight up. blade on the passenger side.

The wipers return to the starting position when


the car is started.
08

325
08 Maintenance and service

Wiper blades and washer fluid

Replacing the wiper blades, rear window IMPORTANT


Check the wiper blades regularly.
Neglected maintenance shortens the serv-
ice life of the wiper blades.

Filling washer fluid

1. Fold out the wiper arm.


2. Grip the inner section of the blade (by the
arrow).
3. Turn anticlockwise to use the blade's end
position against the wiper arm as a lever to
detach the blade more easily.
The windscreen and headlamp washers share
4. Press the new wiper blade into position. a common reservoir.
Check that it is firmly installed.
5. Lower the wiper arm. IMPORTANT
Use washer fluid with antifreeze during the
Cleaning winter to avoid freezing in the pump, reser-
For cleaning wiper blades and windscreen, see voir and hoses.
page 344 and onwards.
08
For capacities, see page 361.

326
08 Maintenance and service

Battery

Operation NOTE IMPORTANT


The service life and function of the battery is
The life of the battery is shortened if it If the following instruction is not observed
influenced by factors such as the number of becomes discharged repeatedly. then the energy saving function for infotain-
starts, discharging, driving style, driving con- ment may be temporarily disengaged, and/
ditions, climatic conditions etc. The life of the battery is affected by several
or the message in the information display
factors, including driving conditions and cli-
about the main battery's state of charge
• Never disconnect the battery when the mate. Battery starting capacity decreases
may be temporarily inapplicable, following
engine is running. gradually with time and therefore needs to
the connection of an external battery or bat-
be recharged if the car is not used for a
• Check that the cables to the battery are longer time or when it is only driven short
tery charger:
correctly connected and properly tight-
ened.
distances. Extreme cold further limits star- • The negative battery terminal on the
ting capacity. car's main battery must never be used
To maintain the battery in good condition, at for connecting an external battery or
WARNING least 15 minutes of driving/week is recom- battery charger - only the car chassis
• The battery can generate oxyhydrogen mended or that the battery is connected to may be used as the grounding point.
gas, which is highly explosive. A spark a battery charger with automatic trickle See the section "Start assistance" - for a
can be formed if a jump lead is con- charging. description of how the cable clamps must
nected incorrectly, and this can be A battery that is kept fully charged has a be attached.
enough for the battery to explode. maximum service life.
• The battery contains sulphuric acid,
which can cause serious burns. IMPORTANT
• If sulphuric acid comes into contact
Never use a quick charger to charge the
with eyes, skin or clothing, flush with
battery.
large quantities of water. If acid
splashes into the eyes - seek medical
attention immediately.

08

327
08 Maintenance and service

Battery

Symbols on the battery Avoid sparks and naked Replacing the main battery
Use protective goggles. flames.
Removal
First of all: Take the remote control key from
the ignition switch and wait at least 5 minutes
before any electrical connections are touched
- this is because the car's electrical system
Risk of explosion. needs to store the necessary information to
Further information in the control modules.
owner's manual.

Must be taken for recy-


Store the battery out of cling.
the reach of children.

The battery contains cor-


NOTE
rosive acid. An expended battery must be recycled in an
environmentally responsible manner - it
contains lead.

08

328
08 Maintenance and service

Battery

Release the rubber moulding so that the Cross-stay on the R-Design*


rear cover is free.
Remove the rear cover by screwing one
quarter turn and lifting it away.

WARNING
Connect and remove the positive and neg-
ative cables in the correct order.

Detach the black negative cable.


Cross-stay and plenum chamber cover.
Detach the red positive cable.
Cars with R-Design have a cross-stay that
Detach the ventilation hose from the bat- must be removed before the main battery can
tery. be replaced.
Loosen the screw holding the battery 1. Remove the plenum chamber covers on
clamp. the right and left-hand sides. Prize carefully
Move the battery to the side and lift it up. with a plastic knife or similar.
2. Loosen and remove the screws (one on the
right and one on the left-hand side) that
hold the cross-stay.
3. Remove the cross-stay.
> Now the main battery can be removed
in accordance with the previous section.
• Fitting the cross-stay takes place in the 08
Open the clips on the front cover and
reverse order.
remove the cover.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 329


08 Maintenance and service

Battery

NOTE 8. Fit the rubber moulding. (See Removal). Battery Start Support
Tighten the screws to 30 Nm. Check the 9. Align the front cover and secure it with the
clips. (See removal). Cold
torque with a torque wrench.
start 120B
For more information on the car's main battery capacity 760
Fitting - see page 369 A, CCA 180C
(A)
Eco Start/Stop DRIVe*
SizeD, 150×90×106B
Cars with the Start/Stop function are equipped L×W×H 278×175×190
with two 12 V batteries - one extra powerful (mm) 150×90×130C
battery for starting and one standby battery
that helps during the Eco Start/Stop DRIVe Capacity 8B
function's starting sequence. 70
(Ah) 10C
For more information on Start/Stop - see
A In accordance with the SAE standard.
page 123. B
1. Lower the battery into the battery box. Right-hand drive or left-hand drive cars with manual gear-
box.
For more information on the car's main battery C Left-hand drive D3 with automatic gearbox.
2. Move the battery inward and to the side - see page 116 and 369. D Largest possible size.
until it reaches the rear edge of the box.
3. Tighten the clamp that holds the battery. IMPORTANT
4. Connect the ventilation hose. When replacing batteries in cars with the
> Check that it is correctly connected to Start/Stop function, the AGM1 type batter-
ies must be fitted.
both battery and outlet in the body.
5. Connect the red positive cable.
6. Connect the black negative cable.
7. Press in the rear cover. (See Removal).
08

1 Absorbed Glass Mat

330 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


08 Maintenance and service

Battery

NOTE Location of the batteries IMPORTANT


• The higher the current take-off in the car If the following instruction is not observed
(extra cooling/heating, etc.) the more then the Start/Stop function may temporar-
the batteries must be charged = ily cease to work after the connection of an
increased fuel consumption. external battery or battery charger:
• When the capacity of the battery has • The negative battery terminal on the
fallen below the lowest permissible level car's main battery must never be used
then the Start/Stop function is disen- for connecting an external battery or
gaged. battery charger - only the car chassis
may be used as the grounding point.
Temporarily reduced Start/Stop function due See the section "Start assistance" - for a
description of how the cable clamps must
to high current take-off means:
be attached.
A: Left-hand drive car. B: Right-hand drive car. 1.
• The engine starts automatically2 without Battery for starting3 2. Support battery.
the driver depressing the clutch pedal
(manual gearbox). The support battery normally requires no more
service than the normal battery that is used for
• The engine starts automatically without the
driver lifting his/her foot off the foot brake starting. A workshop should be contacted in
pedal (automatic gearbox). the event of questions or problems - an author-
ised Volvo workshop is recommended.

08

2 Automatic starting can only take place if the gear lever is in neutral position.
3 The battery for starting is described in detail on page 328.

331
08 Maintenance and service

Battery

NOTE
If the battery has become so discharged
that everything is "black" and in principle
the car does not have all the normal electri-
cal functions and the engine is subsequently
started using an external battery or battery
charger, then the Start/Stop function will be
activated. It will then be possible for the
engine to be auto-stopped but in the event
of an auto-stop the Start/Stop function may
fail to auto-start the engine due to inade-
quate capacity in the battery.
The battery must first be charged in order to
ensure a successful auto-start after an auto-
stop. At an outside temperature of +15 °C
the battery needs to be charged for at least
1 hour. At a lower outside temperature a
charging time of 3-4 hours is recom-
mended. The recommendation is that the
battery is charged using an external battery
charger.
If this is not possible then the recommen-
dation is to temporarily deactivate the
Start/Stop function until the battery has
been adequately recharged.
For more information about recharging the
battery, see the section "Battery" in the
chapter "Maintenance and service".

08

332
08 Maintenance and service

Fuses

General Location, fuse boxes


All electrical functions and components are
protected by a number of fuses in order to pro-
tect the car's electrical system from damage by
short circuiting or overloading.
If an electrical component or function does not
work, it may be because the component's fuse
was temporarily overloaded and failed. If the
same fuse fails repeatedly then there is a fault
in the circuit. Volvo recommends that you visit
an authorised Volvo workshop for checking.

Changing
1. Look in the fuse diagram to locate the fuse.
Central electrical unit locations in a left-hand
2. Pull out the fuse and check from the side drive car. In a right-hand drive car the central
to see whether the curved wire has blown. electrical units under the glovebox change
sides.
3. If this is the case, replace it with a new fuse
of the same colour and amperage. Engine compartment

, Under the glovebox


WARNING
Never use a foreign object, or a fuse with an Cargo area under the cargo floor
amperage higher than that specified when Engine compartment cold zone (only
replacing a fuse. This could cause signifi-
Start/Stop*)
cant damage to the electrical system and
possibly lead to fire.

08

333
08 Maintenance and service

Fuses

Engine compartment

08

334
08 Maintenance and service

Fuses

General fuses, engine compartment Function A Function A


On the inside of the cover there are tweezers
that facilitate the procedure for the removal Primary fuse for the central elec- 50 Parking heater* 25
and fitting of fuses. tronic module (CEM) with fuse
box B under the gloveboxA Ventilation fanA 40
Positions (see preceding illustration)
Engine compartment, upper Primary fuse for the central elec- 50 - -
tronic module (CEM) with fuse
Engine compartment, front box B under the glovebox ABS pump 40
Engine compartment, lower
Primary fuse for central electri- 60 ABS valves 20
These fuses are all located in the engine com- cal unit in cargo areaA
partment box. The fuses in (C) are located - -
Primary fuse for central electri- 60
under (A).
cal unit in passenger compart- Headlamp levelling*, Active 10
On the inside of the cover is a label that shows ment with fuse box A under the Xenon headlamps - ABL*
the location of the fuses. gloveboxA
Primary fuse for the central elec- 20
• Fuses 1-7 and 42-44 are of the "Midi Fuse" Primary fuse for central electri- 60 tronic module (CEM) with fuse
type and must only be replaced by a work-
cal unit in passenger compart- box B under the glovebox
shop1.
ment with fuse box A under the
• Fuses 8-15 and 34 are of the "JCASE" type gloveboxA ABS 5
and should be replaced by a workshop1.
- - Speed related power steering* 5
• Fuses 16-33 and 35-41 are of the "Mini
Fuse" type.
PTC element, air preheater*A 100 Engine control module, Trans- 10
mission control module, Air-
Headlamp washers* 20 bags

Windscreen wipers 30 Heated washer nozzles* 10


08

1 An authorised Volvo workshop is recommended.


``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 335


08 Maintenance and service

Fuses

Function A Function A Function A


Relay coil, relay, vacuum pump 5 Relay coil, relay, compressor A/ 5 Valves (1.6 l petrol), Mass air 10
(5-cyl. petrol) C (not 5-cyl. diesel), Relay coil, flow sensor (1.6 l petrol)
relay, coolant pump (5-cyl. die-
Headlamp control 5 Mass air flow sensor (D4162T),
sel Start/Stop)
Control valve, fuel flow
- - Relay coils in central electrical (D4162T)
unit in engine compartment cold
- - zone Start/Stop Mass air flow sensor (5, 6-cyl.), 15
Control valves (5-cyl. diesel),
- - Actuator solenoid, starter 30 Injectors (5, 6-cyl. petrol),
motorA Engine control module (6-cyl.)
Internal relay coils 5
Ignition coils (4-cyl. petrol), 10 Compressor A/C (5, 6-cyl.), 10
Auxiliary lamps* 20 Glow control module (5-cyl. die- Engine valves, Engine control
sel) module (6-cyl.) Solenoids (6-cyl.
Horn 15 without turbo), Actuator motors,
Ignition coils (5, 6-cyl. petrol), 20 intake manifold (6-cyl. without
Relay coil, main relay, engine 10 Capacitor (6-cyl.) turbo), Mass air flow sensor (4-
management system, Engine cyl. 2.0 l petrol), Oil level sensor
Engine control module (petrol) 10
control module (5, 6-cyl. petrol) (5-cyl. diesel)
Engine control module (diesel) 15 Coolant pump (D4162T)
Transmission control module 15
Lambda-sonds (4-cyl. petrol), 10
Compressor A/C (not 5-cyl. die- 15
Lambda-sond (diesel), Control
sel), Coolant pump (5-cyl. diesel
module, radiator roller cover
Start/Stop)
(manual 5-cyl. 2.0 l diesel)

EVAP valve (5, 6-cyl. petrol), 15


08
Lambda-sonds (5, 6-cyl. petrol)

336 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


08 Maintenance and service

Fuses

Function A
Coolant pump (1.6 l petrol Start/ 10
Stop)

Vacuum pump (5-cyl. petrol), 20


Crankcase ventilation heater (5-
cyl. petrol), Diesel filter heater

Crankcase ventilation heater (5- 10


cyl. diesel)

Glow plugs (diesel) 70

Cooling fan (4-cyl., 5-cyl. petrol) 60

Cooling fan (6-cyl. petrol, 5-cyl. 80


diesel)

Electro-hydraulic power steer- 100


ing
A For cars with the Start/Stop function this fuse location is
empty - see instead page 342.

08

``

337
08 Maintenance and service

Fuses

Under the glovebox

Positions Box A Function A Box A Function A


On the inside of the cover is a label that shows
the location of the fuses in fuse box A. - - Control panel, rear passen- 20
ger door, right
Box A Function A - -
Control panel, rear passen- 20
Primary fuse for audio con- 40 Door handle (Keyless*) 5 ger door, left
trol module*, Primary fuse Keyless* 7.5
for fuses 16-20 - -

- - Control panel, driver's door 20 Power seat driver's side* 20

08
- - Control panel, front passen- 20 Power seat passenger side* 20
ger door

338 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


08 Maintenance and service

Fuses

Box A Function A Box A Function A Box B Function A


Folding head restraint* 15 Parking assistance*, Park- 5 Central locking system, fuel 10
ing camera*, Towbar control filler flap
Infotainment control module 5 module *
Rear window washer 15
Audio control module* 10 BLIS*
Windscreen washers 15
Digital radio*, TV* AWD control module* 10
Unlocking, tailgate 10
Audio 15 Active chassis Four-C* 10
- -
Telematics*, Bluetooth* 5
Box B Function A Fuel pump 20
- -
Rear window wiper 15
Climate panel 5
Sun roof*, Interior lighting 5
roof, Climate sensor - -
Steering lock 15
12 V socket, tunnel console 15 Interior lighting, Driver's 7.5
door control panel, power Siren alarm*, Data link con- 5
Seat heating, rear right* 15 windows, Power seats, nector OBDII
front*, Remote controlled - -
Seat heating, rear left* 15 garage door opener*
Airbags 10
- - Information display (DIM) 5
Collision warning system 5
Seat heating (passenger 15 Adaptive cruise control, 10
side) ACC*, collision warning sys- Accelerator pedal, PTC ele- 7.5
tem* ment air preheater*, Dim-
Seat heating (driver's side) 15
Interior lighting, Rain sensor 7.5 ming, interior rearview mir- 08
ror*, Seat heating, rear*
Steering wheel module 7.5

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 339


08 Maintenance and service

Fuses

Box B Function A
- -

Brake light 5

Sunroof* 20

Immobiliser 5

08

340 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


08 Maintenance and service

Fuses

Cargo area

Positions Function A Function A


Function A
- - - -
Electric parking brake, left 30
12 V socket, cargo area 15 - -
Electric parking brake, right 30
- - Trailer socket 1* 40
Rear window defroster 30
- - - -
Trailer socket 2* 15

08

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 341


08 Maintenance and service

Fuses

Engine compartment, cold zone - Start/Stop*

Location of fuses for the Start/Stop function.


• Fuses A1 and A2 are of the "MEGA Fuse" Positions Function A
type and must only be replaced by a work-
shop2.
Function A
Main fuse for central electronic 175
• Fuses 1-11 are of the "Midi Fuse" type and Main fuse for central electrical 175 module (CEM) with fuse box B
must only be replaced by a workshop2. unit in the engine compartment under the glovebox, central
electrical unit in passenger
• Fuse 12 is of the "Mini Fuse" type. compartment with fuse box A
For more information on Start/Stop - see under the glovebox, central
page 123. electrical unit in cargo area

PTC element, air preheater* 100


08

2 An authorised Volvo workshop is recommended.

342 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


08 Maintenance and service

Fuses

Function A Function A
Primary fuse for the central elec- 50 Support battery 70
tronic module (CEM) with fuse
box B under the glovebox Central electronic module 15
(CEM) (Reference voltage
Primary fuse for central electri- 60 standby battery)
cal unit in passenger compart-
ment with fuse box A under the
glovebox

Primary fuse for central electri- 60


cal unit in passenger compart-
ment with fuse box A under the
glovebox

Primary fuse for central electri- 60


cal unit in cargo area

Ventilation fan 40

- -

- -

Actuator solenoid, starter motor 30

Internal diode 50

08

343
08 Maintenance and service

Car care

Washing the car IMPORTANT Automatic car washes


Wash the car as soon as it becomes dirty. An automatic car wash is a simple and quick
Dirty headlamps have impaired functional- way of washing the car, but it cannot reach
Wash the car in a car wash with oil separator. ity. Clean them regularly, when refuelling for
Use car shampoo. example. everywhere. Handwashing the car is recom-
mended for achieving optimum results.
• Remove bird droppings from the paintwork
as soon as possible. Bird droppings con-
NOTE NOTE
tain chemicals that affect and discolour
paintwork very quickly. An authorised Outside lighting such as headlamps, fog During the first few months a new car must
Volvo workshop is recommended for the lamps and rear lamps may temporarily have only be handwashed. This is because the
removal of any discoloration. condensation on the inside of the lens. This paintwork is more sensitive when it is new.
is normal, all exterior lighting is designed to
• Hose down the underbody. withstand this. Condensation is normally
• Rinse the entire car to remove loose dirt. vented out of the lamp housing when the High-pressure washing
Do not spray directly onto the locks. lamp has been switched on for a time. When using high-pressure washing, use
sweeping movements and make sure that the
• Wash using a sponge, car shampoo and
plenty of lukewarm water. Cleaning the wiper blades nozzle does not come closer than 30 cm to the
Asphalt, dust and salt residue on wiper blades, surface of the car (the distance applies to all
• Clean the wiper blades with a lukewarm exterior parts). Do not spray directly onto the
soap solution or car shampoo. as well as insects, ice etc. on the windscreen,
impair the service life of wiper blades. locks.
• Use cold degreasing agent on very dirty
surfaces. For cleaning: Testing the brakes
• Dry the car using a clean, soft chamois or – Set the wiper blades in service position,
a water scraper. see page 325. WARNING
Always test the brakes after washing the
WARNING NOTE car, including the parking brake, to ensure
that moisture and corrosion do not attack
Always have the engine cleaned by a work- Wash the wiper blades and windscreen reg- the brake linings and reduce braking per-
shop. There is a risk of fire if the engine is ularly with lukewarm soap solution or car formance.
hot. shampoo.
08
Do not use any strong solvents. Lightly depress the brake pedal now and then
when driving long distances in rain or slush.
The heat from the friction causes the brake lin-

344
08 Maintenance and service

Car care

ings to warm up and dry. Do the same thing Polishing and waxing Water-repellent coating*
after starting in very damp or cold weather. Polish and wax the car if the paintwork is dull Never use products such as car wax,
or to give the paintwork extra protection. degreaser or similar on glass surfa-
Exterior plastic, rubber and trim
ces as this could ruin their water-repellent
components The car does not need to be polished until it is
properties.
A special cleaning agent available from Volvo at least one year old. However, the car can be
dealers is recommended for the cleaning and waxed during this time. Do not polish or wax Take care when cleaning so as not to damage
care of coloured plastic parts, rubber and trim the car in direct sunlight. the glass surface.
components, such as glossy trim mouldings. Wash and dry the car thoroughly before you To avoid damaging glass surfaces when
When using such a cleaning agent the instruc- begin polishing or waxing. Clean off asphalt removing ice – only use plastic ice scrapers.
tions must be followed carefully. and tar stains using tar remover or white spirit.
There is natural wear of the water-repellent
More stubborn stains can be removed using
coating.
IMPORTANT fine rubbing paste designed for car paintwork.
Treatment with a special finishing agent avail-
Avoid waxing and polishing on plastic and Polish first with a polish and then wax with liq-
rubber. able from Volvo dealers is recommended in
uid or solid wax. Follow the instructions on the
order to maintain the water-repellent proper-
When using degreasant on plastic and rub- packaging carefully. Many preparations con-
ties. This should be used first after three years
ber, only rub with light pressure if it is nec- tain both polish and wax.
and then each year.
essary. Use a soft washing sponge.
Polishing glossy trim mouldings could wear IMPORTANT
away or damage the glossy surface layer. Rustproofing – inspection and
Only paint treatment recommended by maintenance
Polishing agent that contains abrasive must Volvo should be used. Other treatment such
not be used. as preserving, sealing, protection, lustre The car received a thorough and complete
sealing or similar could damage the paint- rustproofing at the factory. Parts of the body
work. Paintwork damage caused by such are made of galvanised sheet metal. The
Rims treatments is not covered by Volvo war- underbody is protected by a wear-resistant
Only use rim cleaning agent recommended by ranty. anti-corrosion compound. A thin, penetrating
Volvo. rustproofing fluid was sprayed into the
Strong rim cleaning agents can damage the exposed members, cavities, closed sections
and side doors. 08
surface and cause stains on chrome-plated
aluminium rims.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 345


08 Maintenance and service

Car care

Under normal conditions the rustproofing does WARNING regular cleaning is required in order to maintain
not require treatment for approximately 12 both characteristics and appearance. Volvo
years. After this period, it should be treated at Before setting off check that the inlaid mat offers a comprehensive product for the clean-
three-year intervals. Volvo recommends that in the driver area is firmly affixed and ing and treatment of leather upholstery which,
secured in the pins in order to avoid getting
you engage an authorised Volvo workshop for caught adjacent to and under the pedals. when used in accordance with the instructions,
assistance if the car needs further treatment. preserves the leather's protective coating.
After a period of use the natural appearance of
Dirt and road salt can lead to corrosion so it is A special textile cleaner is recommended for the leather will nevertheless emerge, depend-
important to keep the car clean. The car's rust- stains on the floor mat after vacuuming. Floor ing more or less on the surface texture of the
proofing needs to be checked regularly and mats should be cleaned with agents recom- leather. This is a natural maturing of the leather
touched-up if necessary in order for it to be mended by your Volvo dealer! and shows that it is a natural product.
maintained.
Stains on fabric upholstery and roof To achieve best results Volvo recommends
upholstery cleaning and the application of protective
Cleaning the interior
A special fabric cleaning agent, available from cream once to four times per year (or more if
Only use cleaning agents and car care prod- necessary). The Volvo Leather Care kit is avail-
authorised Volvo dealers, is recommended to
ucts recommended by Volvo. Clean regularly able from your Volvo dealer.
avoid impairing the fire retardant qualities of
and follow the instructions included with the
the upholstery.
car care product.
IMPORTANT
Vacuuming is important prior to using cleaning IMPORTANT
agents. • Certain items of coloured clothing (for
Sharp objects and Velcro may damage the example, jeans and suede garments)
Carpets and cargo area fabric upholstery. may stain the upholstery.
Remove inlaid carpets for separate cleaning of • Never use strong solvents. Such prod-
the floor carpet and the inlaid carpets. Use a Treating stains on leather upholstery ucts may damage fabric, vinyl and
vacuum cleaner to remove dust and dirt. Volvo's leather upholstery is chromium-free leather upholstery.
Each inlay mat is secured with pins. and is treated to preserve its original appear-
ance. Washing instructions for leather
– Take hold of the inlay mat at each pin and
lift the mat straight up. Leather upholstery ages and acquires a beau- upholstery
08
tiful patina over time. The leather is refined and 1. Pour the leather cleaner on the dampened
Fit the inlay mat in place by pressing it in at processed so that it retains its natural charac- sponge and squeeze out a strong foam.
each pin. teristics. It is given a protective coating, but

346
08 Maintenance and service

Car care

2. Work the dirt away with gentle circular If the steering wheel has stains: Volvo dealer. Make sure the seatbelt is dry
movements. before allowing it to retract.
Group 1 (ink, wine, coffee, milk, sweat and
3. Dab accurately with the sponge on the blood)
stains. Allow the sponge to absorb the
– Use a soft cloth or sponge. Mix a 5%
Touching up minor paintwork damage
stain. Do not rub. Paint is an important part of the car's rust-
ammonia solution. (For blood stains, use a
4. Wipe off with soft paper or a cloth and solution of 2 dl water and 25g salt.) proofing and should therefore be checked reg-
allow the leather to dry completely. ularly. To avoid the onset of rust, damaged
Group 2 (fats, oils, sauces and chocolate) paintwork should be rectified immediately. The
Protective treatment of leather most common types of paintwork damage are
1. Same procedure as group I.
upholstery stone chips, scratches, and marks on the
1. Pour a small amount of the protective 2. Polish with an absorbent paper or cloth. edges of wings and doors.
cream on the felted cloth and massage in Group 3 (dry dirt, dust)
a thin layer of cream with gentle circular Materials
movements on the leather. 1. Use a soft brush to remove the dirt. • primer in a can
2. Allow the leather to dry for 20 minutes 2. Same procedure as group I. • spray can or touch-up pen1
before use. • masking tape
Treating stains on interior plastic, metal
The leather has now been given improved pro- and wood parts
tection against stains and improved UV pro- A fibrillated fibre or microfibre cloth, lightly
tection. moistened with water, available from Volvo
Washing instructions for the leather dealers, is recommended for cleaning interior
steering wheel parts and surfaces.
• Remove dirt and dust with a soft pre-mois- Do not scrape or rub stains. Never use strong
tened sponge and neutral soap. stain removers. A special cleaning agent avail-
• Leather needs to breathe. Never cover the able from Volvo dealers can be used for more
leather steering wheel with protective plas- difficult cleaning.
tic.
Cleaning seatbelts
• Use natural oils. Volvo's leather care Use water and a synthetic detergent. A special 08
agents are recommended for best results.
textile cleaning agent is available from your

1 Follow the instructions that are included with the package for the touch-up pen.
``

347
08 Maintenance and service

Car care

Colour code Before work is begun, the car must be clean


and dry and at a temperature above 15 °C.
1. Apply a piece of masking tape over the
damaged surface. Then remove the tape to
remove any loose paint.
2. Stir the primer well and apply using a fine
brush or a matchstick. Apply paint using a
brush once the primer is dry.
3. For scratches, proceed as above, but
mask around the damaged area to protect
the undamaged paintwork.
4. After a few days, polish the touched-up
Car colour code areas. Use a soft rag and a small amount
It is important that the correct colour is used. of lapping paste.
For product decal location, see page 352.
NOTE
Repairing stone chips
If the stone chip has not penetrated to the
bare metal and there is an undamaged col-
our coat, you can paint straight after clean-
ing the damaged surface.

08
G021832

348
08 Maintenance and service

08

349
Type designations................................................................................. 352
Dimensions and weights....................................................................... 354
Engine specifications............................................................................ 358
Engine oil............................................................................................... 359
Fluids and lubricants............................................................................. 361
Fuel....................................................................................................... 363
Wheel and tyres, dimensions and pressure ......................................... 366
Electrical system................................................................................... 369
Type approval....................................................................................... 370
Symbols in the display.......................................................................... 382

350
SPECIFICATIONS
09 Specifications

09 Type designations

Label location

352
09 Specifications

Type designations 09

Knowing the car's type designation, vehicle NOTE


identification and engine numbers can facili-
tate all contact with an authorised Volvo dealer The labels shown in the owner's manual are
regarding the car and when ordering spare not provided as exact reproductions of
those in the car. The purpose is to show
parts and accessories. their approximate appearance and location
Type designation, vehicle identification in the car. The information that applies to
number, maximum permissible weights, your car in particular is available on the label
in question in your car.
codes for colour and upholstery and type
approval number. The label is visible when
the right rear door is opened.
Label for parking heater.
Engine code, component and serial num-
bers.
Label for engine oil.
Gearbox type designation and serial num-
ber.
Manual gearbox
Automatic gearbox
Car's identification number. (VIN Vehicle
Identification Number)
Further information on the car is presented in
the registration document.

353
09 Specifications

09 Dimensions and weights

Dimensions

Dimensions mm Dimensions mm Dimensions mm


A Wheelbase 2776 G Front track 1588A K Width including door mirrors 2097

B Length 4628 1578B L Width including folded-in door


mirrors 1899
C Load length, floor, folded rear H Rear track 1585A
A with 16" wheel
seat 1749
1575B B with 17" wheel
D Load length, floor 978
I Load width, floor 1082
E Height 1484
J Width 1865
F Load height 658

354
09 Specifications

Dimensions and weights 09

Weights WARNING
Kerb weight includes the driver, the fuel tank
The car's driving characteristics change
90% full and all fluids. depending on how heavily it is loaded and
The weight of passengers and accessories, how the load is distributed.
and towball load (when a trailer is hitched, see
table page 356) influences the payload and is
not included in the kerb weight.
Permitted max. load = Gross vehicle weight -
Kerb weight.

NOTE
The documented kerb weight applies to
cars in the standard version - i.e. a car with-
out extra equipment or accessories. This
means that for every accessory added the
loading capacity of the car is reduced cor-
respondingly by the weight of the acces-
sory. For information on decal location, see page 352.
Examples of accessories that reduce load- Max. gross vehicle weight
ing capacity are the Kinetic/Momentum/
Summum equipment levels, as well as other Max. train weight (car+trailer)
accessories such as Towbar, Load carriers, Max. front axle load
Space box, Audio system, Auxiliary lamps,
GPS, Fuel-driven heater, Safety grille, Car- Max. rear axle load
pets, Cargo cover, Power seats, etc.
Weighing the car is a certain way of ascer- Equipment level
taining the kerb weight of your own partic-
ular car. Max. load: See registration document.
Max. roof load: 75 kg.

355
09 Specifications

09 Dimensions and weights

Towing capacity and towball load


Engine Gearbox Max. weight braked trailer (kg) Max. towball load (kg)
T3A Manual, MMT6 1600 75

T4A Manual, MMT6 1600 75

T4A Automatic, MPS6 1600 75

T4F Manual, MMT6 1600 75

T4F Automatic, MPS6 1600 75

T5 Manual, MMT6 1800 90

T5 Automatic, MPS6 1800 90

T6 AWD Automatic, TF-80SC 1800 90

DRIVe Manual, MMT6 1300 75

D3 Manual, M66 1600 75

D3 Automatic, TF-80SCB 1600 75

D3 Automatic, TF-80SDC 1600 75

D5 Manual, M66 1600 75

D5 Automatic, TF-80SC 1800 90

D5 AWD Automatic, TF-80SC 1800 90


A DRIVe for certain markets.
B Without Start/Stop.
C With Start/Stop.

356
09 Specifications

Dimensions and weights 09

Max. weight unbraked trailer (kg) Max. towball load (kg)


750 50

357
09 Specifications

09 Engine specifications

Engine specifications

NOTE
Not all engines are available in all markets.

Engine Engine Output Output Torque (Nm/ No. of Bore Stroke Swept Com-
codeA (kW/rpm) (hp/rpm) rpm) cylin- (mm) (mm) volume pression
ders (litres) ratio
T3B B4164T3 110/5700 150/5700 240/1600–4000 4 79 81.4 1.596 10.0:1

T4B B4164T 132/5700 180/5700 240/1600–5000 4 79 81.4 1.596 10.0:1

T4F B4164T2 132/5700 180/5700 240/1600–5000 4 79 81.4 1.596 10.0:1

T5 B4204T7 177/5500 240/5500 320/1800-5000 4 87.5 83.1 1.999 10.0:1

T6 B6304T4 224/5600 304/5600 440/2100–4200 6 82.0 93.2 2.953 9.3:1

DRIVe D4162T 84/3600 115/3600 270/1750-2500 4 75 88.3 1.560 16.0:1

D3 D5204T3 120/3500 163/3500 400/1500-2750 5 81.0 77 1.984 16.5:1

D5 D5244T11C 158/4000 215/4000 420/1500–3250 5 81.0 93.15 2.400 16.5:1

D5 D5244T15D 158/4000 215/4000 440/1500-3000 5 81.0 93.15 2.400 16.5:1


A Engine code, component and serial number can be read on the engine, see page 352.
B DRIVe for certain markets.
C Manual gearbox
D Automatic gearbox

358
09 Specifications

Engine oil 09

Adverse driving conditions Choose a fully synthetic engine oil for adverse IMPORTANT
Adverse driving conditions can lead to abnor- driving conditions. It provides extra protection
for the engine. In order to fulfil the requirements for the
mally high oil temperature or oil consumption. engine's service intervals all engines are
Below are some examples of adverse driving Volvo recommends Castrol oil products. filled with a specially adapted synthetic
conditions. engine oil at the factory. The choice of oil
has been made very carefully with regard to
Check the oil level more frequently for long
service life, starting characteristics, fuel
journeys: consumption and environmental impact.
• towing a caravan or trailer An approved engine oil must be used in
• in mountainous regions order that the recommended service inter-
vals can be applied. Only use a prescribed
• at high speeds grade of oil for both filling and oil change,
• in temperatures colder than -30 °C or hot- otherwise you will risk affecting service life,
ter than +40 °C starting characteristics, fuel consumption
and environmental impact.
The above also apply to shorter driving dis-
tances at low temperatures. Volvo Car Corporation disclaims all war-
ranty liability if engine oil of the prescribed
grade and viscosity is not used.
Volvo recommends that oil changes are car-
ried out at an authorised Volvo workshop.

359
09 Specifications

09 Engine oil

Engine oil grade

Engine Engine code Recommended oil grade Volume, incl. oil filter
(litres)
T6 B6304T4 Oil grade: ACEA A5/B5 approx 6.8

D3 D5204T3 Viscosity: SAE 0W–30 approx. 5.9

D5 D5244T11A approx. 5.9

D5 D5244T15B approx. 5.9

T5 B4204T7 Oil grade: ACEA A5/B5 approx. 5.4


Viscosity: SAE 5W–30
DRIVe D4162T approx. 3.8
When driving under adverse conditions, use ACEA A5/B5 SAE 0W-30.

T3C B4164T3 Certified and factory-filled oil: Oil grade WSS-M2C925-A approx. 4.1

T4C B4164T options for service: approx. 4.1


Oil grade: ACEA A5/B5
T4F B4164T2 approx. 4.1
Viscosity: SAE 5W–30
A Manual gearbox
B Automatic gearbox
C DRIVe for certain markets.

For filling engine oil, see page 313.

360
09 Specifications

Fluids and lubricants 09

Other fluids and lubricants


Manual gearbox Volume (litres) Prescribed transmission fluid
MMT6 1.7
BOT 350M3
M66 1.9

Automatic gearbox Volume (litres) Prescribed transmission fluid


MPS6 7.3 BOT 341

TF-80SC 7.0 AW1

TF-80SD 7.0 AW1

Fluid System Volume (litres) Prescribed grade


Coolant T5 10.5

T6, D3 and D5 8.9

T3B, T4B, C and T4FC 9.2 Coolant recommended by Volvo mixed with 50% waterA, see the packaging.

T4B, D and T4FD 9.8

DRIVe 10.5

Brake fluid Brake system 0.6 DOT 4+

Power steering Power steering - WSS M2C204-A2 or equivalent product.


fluid

``

361
09 Specifications

09 Fluids and lubricants

Fluid System Volume (litres) Prescribed grade


Washer fluid Cars with headlamp 5.4 Washer fluid recommended by Volvo - with frost protection during cold
washing weather and below freezing point.

Cars without headlamp 4.0


washing

Fuel Petrol engine approx. 67 Petrol: see page 274

Diesel engine approx. 67 Diesel: see page 275


A Water quality must fulfil the standard STD 1285.1.
B DRIVe
C Manual gearbox
D Automatic gearbox

NOTE
Under normal driving conditions, the gear-
box oil does not need to be changed during
its service life. However, this may be nec-
essary under adverse driving conditions,
see page 361.

362
09 Specifications

Fuel 09

CO2 emissions and fuel consumption


A B C

T3A - - - - - -

T4FB - - - - - -

T4FB - - - - - -

T4A - - - - - -

T4A - - - - - -

T5 263 11.3 147 6.3 189 8.1

T5 262 11.3 154 6.6 194 8.3

T6 AWD 346 14.8 175 7.5 237 10.2

DRIVe 137 5.2 109 4.1 119 4.5

D3 167 6.4 112 4.3 132 5.1

``

363
09 Specifications

09 Fuel

A B C

D3C 214 8.1 127 4.8 159 6.0

D3D 187 7.1 127 4.8 149 5.7

D5 157 6.0 112 4.3 129 4.9

D5 221 8.5 128 4.9 162 6.2

D5 AWD 226 8.6 137 5.2 169 6.4

A DRIVe for certain markets.


B Flexifuel engines can be driven on both 95 octane unleaded petrol and bioethanol E85. Both fuels are filled in the common fuel tank so that any variations of mixing ratios between these two fuels
is possible. For more information, see page 115.
C Without Start/Stop.
D With Start/Stop.

NOTE Fuel consumption and emissions of


: gram/km
carbon dioxide
If the consumption and emission data is
missing then it is included in the enclosed Fuel consumption and emission values in the
: litre/100 km
supplement. table above are based on specific EU cycles1,
A = urban driving that apply to cars with kerb weight in the basic
B = extra-urban driving version and without extra equipment. The car's
weight may increase depending on equipment.
C = combined driving This, as well as how heavily the car is loaded,
increases fuel consumption and carbon diox-
ide emissions.

364
09 Specifications

Fuel 09

There are several reasons for increased fuel • Drive gently and avoid unnecessary accel-
consumption compared with the table's val- eration as well as braking too hard.
ues. Examples of this are: • Drive with the correct air pressure in the
• The driver's driving style. tyres and check this regularly - select ECO
tyre pressure for best results, see the tyre
• If the customer has specified wheels larger pressure table on page 366.
than those fitted as standard on the mod-
el's basic version, then resistance increa- • Choice of tyres can affect fuel consump-
ses. tion - seek advice on suitable tyres from a
dealer.
• High speed results in increased wind resis-
tance. See further information and more advice on
pages 12 and 270.
• Fuel quality, road and traffic conditions,
weather and the condition of the car. See page 274 for general information on fuel.
Even a combination of the above-mentioned
examples can result in significantly improved
consumption. For further information, please
refer to the regulations referred to1.
Large deviations in fuel consumption may arise
in a comparison with the EU driving cycles1
which are used in the certification of the car
and on which the consumption figures in the
table are based.

To bear in mind
Tips that the driver can use in order to reduce
consumption:

1 Official fuel consumption figures are based on two standardised driving cycles in a laboratory environment ("EU driving cycles") all in accordance with EU Directive 80/1268/EEC (Euro 4), EU Regulation
no 692/2008 (Euro 5) and UN ECE Regulation no 101. The regulations cover the driving cycles for urban driving and extra-urban driving. - Urban driving - the measurement starts with cold starting
the engine. The driving is simulated. - Extra-urban driving - the car is accelerated and braked at speeds between 0-120 km/h. The driving is simulated. - Cars with the D5 engine and 6-speed manual
transmission or DRIVe engine and 6-speed manual transmission, are started in 2nd gear. The value for combined driving, which is given in the table, according to legislation, is a combination of
urban driving and extra-urban driving. CO2 emission - to calculate the carbon dioxide emissions from the two driving cycles, the exhaust gases are collected. These are then analysed and give the
value for CO2 emissions.

365
09 Specifications

09 Wheel and tyres, dimensions and pressure

Approved tyre pressures

Engine Tyre size Speed Load, 1 - 3 persons Max. load ECO pressureA
(km/h) Front Rear Front Rear Front/rear
(kPa)B (kPa) (kPa) (kPa) (kPa)
205/60 R 16 0 - 160 230 230 260 260 260
215/55 R 16
T3
215/50 R 17
T4 160 + 260 240 280 260 -
235/45 R 17
T4F
235/40 R 18
DRIVe
0 - 160 230 230 260 260 260
235/45 R 17 SST
160 + 260 260 280 280 -

215/55 R 16 0 - 160 230 230 260 260 260


235/45 R 17 160 + 280 240 300 260 -

215/50 R 17 0 - 160 240 240 260 260 260


T6
235/40 R 18 160 + 300 240 320 280 -

0 - 160 230 230 260 260 260


235/45 R 17 SST
160 + 280 280 300 300 -

366
09 Specifications

Wheel and tyres, dimensions and pressure 09

Engine Tyre size Speed Load, 1 - 3 persons Max. load ECO pressureA
(km/h) Front Rear Front Rear Front/rear
(kPa)B (kPa) (kPa) (kPa) (kPa)
215/55 R 16 0 - 160 230 230 260 260 260
215/50 R 17
T5
235/45 R 17 160 + 260 240 280 260 -
D3
235/40 R 18
D5 FWD
0 - 160 230 230 260 260 260
235/45 R 17 SST
160 + 260 260 280 280 -

215/55 R 16 0 - 160 230 230 260 260 260


235/45 R 17 160 + 260 240 280 260 -

215/50 R 17 0 - 160 240 240 260 260 260


D5 AWD
235/40 R 18 160 + 280 240 300 260 -

0 - 160 230 230 260 260 260


235/45 R 17 SST
160 + 260 260 280 280 -

Temporary Spare Tyre max. 80 420 420 420 420 -


A Economical driving.
B In certain countries there is the "bar" unit beside the SI unit "Pascal": 1 bar = 100 kPa.

``

367
09 Specifications

09 Wheel and tyres, dimensions and pressure

NOTE
All engines, tyres or combinations of these
are not always available in all markets.

368
09 Specifications

Electrical system 09

Electrical system The battery capacity is dependent upon the IMPORTANT


The car has a voltage-regulated AC alternator. equipment level in the vehicle.
If the battery is replaced, replace it with a
The electrical system is single-pole and uses battery of the same cold start capacity and
the chassis and engine casing as a conductor. reserve capacity as the original (see the
decal on the battery).

Battery
Engine Voltage (V) Cold start capacity, Reserve capacity
CCA - Cold Cranking Amperes (A) (minutes)
Petrol (Ethanol) 12 520–800 100–160

Diesel 12 700–800 135–160

Petrol/Diesel with Start/Stop function 12 760A 135


A Battery type AGM (Absorbed Glass Mat) must be used in cars with the Start/Stop function.

NOTE
• The battery's container size should be
consistent with the original battery's
dimensions.
• The battery's height is different depend-
ing on size.

Eco Start/Stop DRIVe*


For information on batteries in cars with
Eco Start/Stop DRIVe, see page 330.

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 369


09 Specifications

09 Type approval

Remote control system Country Radar system


Country BR
Country
A, B, CY, Singapore
CZ, D, DK, Delphi hereby certifies
E, EST, F, that this remote control key
FIN, GB, system conforms to the
GR, H, I, IDA: Infocomm Development
essential characteristic Authority of Singapore.
IRL, L, LT, requirements and other rele- RC
LV, M, NL, vant regulations of directive CCAB06LP1940T4 Brazil
P, PL, S, 1999/5/EC.
SK, SLO

IS, LI, N, CH

HR

ROK Delphi 2003-07-15, Germany


R-LPD1-03-0151

370
09 Specifications

Type approval 09

BluetoothŸ
Declaration of Conformity (Declaration of Conformity)
Country
Countries
in the EU:

Exporting country: Japan


Manufacturer: Alpine Electronics Inc.
Type of equipment: BluetoothŸ device
For further information visit http://ec.europa.eu/enterprise/rtte/faq.htm #informing

``

371
09 Specifications

09 Type approval

Country

Czech Alpine Electronics, Inc. tímto prohlašuje, že tento BluetoothŸ Module je ve shodě se základními požadavky a dalšími příslušnými
Republic: ustanoveními směrnice 1999/5/ES.

Denmark: Undertegnede Alpine Electronics, Inc. erklærer herved, at følgende udstyr BluetoothŸ Module overholder de væsentlige krav og øvrige
relevante krav i direktiv 1999/5/EF.

Germany: Hiermit erklärt Alpine Electronics, Inc., dass sich das Gerät BluetoothŸ Module in Übereinstimmung mit den grundlegenden
Anforderungen und den übrigen einschlägigen Bestimmungen der Richtlinie 1999/5/EG befindet.

372
09 Specifications

Type approval 09

Country
Estonia: Käesolevaga kinnitab Alpine Electronics, Inc. seadme BluetoothŸ Module vastavust direktiivi 1999/5/EÜ põhinõuetele ja nimetatud
direktiivist tulenevatele teistele asjakohastele sätetele.

UK Hereby, Alpine Electronics, Inc., declares that this BluetoothŸ Module is in compliance with the essential requirements and other
relevant provisions of Directive 1999/5/EC.

Spain: Por medio de la presente Alpine Electronics, Inc. declara que el BluetoothŸ Module cumple con los requisitos esenciales y cualesquiera
otras disposiciones aplicables o exigibles de la Directiva 1999/5/CE.

Greece: ΜΕ ΤΗΝ ΠΑΡΟΥΣΑ Alpine Electronics, Inc. ΔΗΛΩΝΕΙ ΟΤΙ BluetoothŸ Module ΣΥΜΜΟΡΦΩΝΕΤΑΙ ΠΡΟΣ ΤΙΣ ΟΥΣΙΩΔΕΙΣ ΑΠΑΙΤΗΣΕΙΣ
ΚΑΙ ΤΙΣ ΛΟΙΠΕΣ ΣΧΕΤΙΚΕΣ ΔΙΑΤΑΞΕΙΣ ΤΗΣ ΟΔΗΓΙΑΣ 1999/5/ΕΚ.

France: Par la présente Alpine Electronics, Inc. déclare que l'appareil BluetoothŸ Module est conforme aux exigences essentielles et aux autres
dispositions pertinentes de la directive 1999/5/CE.

Italy: Con la presente Alpine Electronics, Inc. dichiara che questo BluetoothŸ Module è conforme ai requisiti essenziali ed alle altre
disposizioni pertinenti stabilite dalla direttiva 1999/5/CE.

Latvia: Ar šo Alpine Electronics, Inc. deklarē, ka BluetoothŸ Module atbilst Direktīvas 1999/5/EK būtiskajām prasībām un citiem ar to
saistītajiem noteikumiem.

Lithuania: Šiuo Alpine Electronics, Inc. deklaruoja, kad šis BluetoothŸ Module atitinka esminius reikalavimus ir kitas 1999/5/EB Direktyvos
nuostatas.

Nether- Hierbij verklaart Alpine Electronics, Inc. dat het toestel BluetoothŸ Module in overeenstemming is met de essentiële eisen en de andere
lands: relevante bepalingen van richtlijn 1999/5/EG.

Malta: Hawnhekk, Alpine Electronics, Inc., jiddikjara li dan BluetoothŸ Module jikkonforma mal-ĘtiĒijiet essenzjali u ma provvedimenti oĘrajn
relevanti li hemm fid-Dirrettiva 1999/5/EC.

Hungary: Alulírott, Alpine Electronics, Inc. nyilatkozom, hogy a BluetoothŸ Module megfelel a vonatkozó alapvetõ követelményeknek és az
1999/5/EC irányelv egyéb elõírásainak.

``

373
09 Specifications

09 Type approval

Country
Poland: Niniejszym Alpine Electronics, Inc. oświadcza, że BluetoothŸ Module jest zgodny z zasadniczymi wymogami oraz pozostałymi
stosownymi postanowieniami Dyrektywy 1999/5/EC.

Portugal: Alpine Electronics, Inc. declara que este BluetoothŸ Module está conforme com os requisitos essenciais e outras disposições da
Directiva 1999/5/CE.

Slovenia: Alpine Electronics, Inc. izjavlja, da je ta BluetoothŸ Module v skladu z bistvenimi zahtevami in ostalimi relevantnimi določili direktive
1999/5/ES.

Slovakia: Alpine Electronics, Inc. týmto vyhlasuje, že BluetoothŸ Module spĺňa základné požiadavky a všetky príslušné ustanovenia Smernice
1999/5/ES.

Finland: Alpine Electronics, Inc. vakuuttaa täten että BluetoothŸ Module tyyppinen laite on direktiivin 1999/5/EY oleellisten vaatimusten ja sitä
koskevien direktiivin muiden ehtojen mukainen.

Sweden: Härmed intygar Alpine Electronics, Inc. att denna BluetoothŸ Module står I överensstämmelse med de väsentliga egenskapskrav och
övriga relevanta bestämmelser som framgår av direktiv 1999/5/EG.

Iceland: Alpine Electronics, Inc. hereby certifies that this BluetoothŸ Module conforms to the essential characteristic requirements and other
relevant regulations of directive 1999/5/EC.

Norway: Alpine Electronics, Inc. erklærer herved at utstyret BluetoothŸ Module er i samsvar med de grunnleggende krav og øvrige relevante
krav i direktiv 1999/5/EF.

374
09 Specifications

Type approval 09

Country
China: ㄀कϝᴵǂ䖯ষ੠⫳ѻॖଚ೼݊ѻકⱘ䇈ᯢк៪Փ⫼᠟‫ݠ‬Ёˈᑨߞॄϟ䗄᳝݇‫ݙ‬ᆍ˖
ᷛᯢ䰘ӊЁ᠔㾘ᅮⱘᡔᴃᣛᷛ੠Փ⫼㣗ೈˈ䇈ᯢ᠔᳝᥻ࠊǃ䇗ᭈঞᓔ݇ㄝՓ⫼ᮍ⊩˗
ƵՓ⫼乥⥛˖*+]
Ƶㄝᬜܼ৥䕤ᇘࡳ⥛ (,53 ˖໽㒓๲Ⲟ˘ G%L ᯊ˖싨P:៪싨G%P ǂķ
Ƶ᳔໻ࡳ⥛䈅ᆚᑺ˖໽㒓๲Ⲟ˘ G%L ᯊ˖싨G%P0+] (,53 ķ
Ƶ䕑乥ᆍ䰤˖SSP
Ƶᴖᬷথᇘ 䕤ᇘ ࡳ⥛ ᇍᑨ䕑⊶f ‫ֵס‬䘧ᏺᆑҹ໪ ˖
• 싨G%PN+] 0+]
• 싨G%PN+] *+]
• 싨G%P0+] *+]
• 싨G%P0+] *+]
• 싨G%P0+] ݊ᅗ *+]
ϡᕫ᪙㞾᳈ᬍথᇘ乥⥛ǃࡴ໻থᇘࡳ⥛ ࣙᣀ乱໪ࡴ㺙ᇘ乥ࡳ⥛ᬒ໻఼ ˈϡᕫ᪙㞾໪᥹໽㒓៪ᬍ⫼݊ᅗথᇘ໽㒓˗
Փ⫼ᯊϡᕫᇍ৘⾡ড়⊩ⱘ᮴㒓⬉䗮ֵϮࡵѻ⫳᳝ᆇᑆᡄ˗ϔᮺথ⦄᳝ᑆᡄ⦄䈵ᯊˈᑨゟे‫ذ‬ℶՓ⫼ˈᑊ䞛প᥾ᮑ⍜䰸ᑆᡄৢᮍৃ㒻㓁
Փ⫼˗
Փ⫼ᖂࡳ⥛᮴㒓⬉䆒໛ˈᖙ乏ᖡফ৘⾡᮴㒓⬉Ϯࡵⱘᑆᡄ៪ᎹϮǃ⾥ᄺঞए⭫ᑨ⫼䆒໛ⱘ䕤ᇘᑆᡄ˗
ϡᕫ೼亲ᴎ੠ᴎഎ䰘䖥Փ⫼DŽ

``

375
09 Specifications

09 Type approval

Country
Taiwan: ‫܅‬㧤෷ሽंᘿ୴ࢤሽᖲጥ෻䏺ऄรԼ㦕
รԼԲය
ᆖী‫ڤ‬ᎁᢞ‫ٽ‬௑հ‫פ܅‬෷୴᙮ሽᖲΔॺᆖ๺‫ױ‬Δֆ‫׹‬Ε೸ᇆࢨࠌ‫݁ृش‬լ൓ᖐ۞!᧢‫ޓ‬᙮෷Ε‫ף‬Օ‫פ‬෷ࢨ᧢‫଺ޓ‬๻ૠհ௽ࢤ֗‫פ‬౨Ζ
รԼ؄ය
‫פ܅‬෷୴᙮ሽᖲհࠌ‫ش‬լ൓ᐙ᥼ଆ౰‫ڜ‬٤֗եឫ‫ٽ‬ऄຏॾΙᆖ࿇෼‫ڶ‬եឫ෼ွழΔ!ᚨ‫ܛم‬ೖ‫ش‬Δࠀ‫ޏ‬࿳۟ྤեឫழֱ൓ᤉᥛࠌ‫ش‬Ζছႈ
‫ٽ‬ऄຏॾΔਐࠉሽॾऄ๵ࡳ!‫܂‬ᄐհྤᒵሽຏॾΖ‫פ܅‬෷୴᙮ሽᖲႊ‫ٽ࠹ݴ‬ऄຏॾࢨՠᄐΕઝᖂ֗᠔᛭‫ش‬ሽं!ᘿ୴ࢤሽᖲ๻ໂհեឫΖ

CCAB10LP0230T7

376
09 Specifications

Type approval 09

Country
South 뇗빃뇐ꚯ
Korea:
Volvo Car Korea
겛뙨녋뤏麗1,$09
뇗빃ꑀ%OXHWRRWK$XGLR1DYLJDWLRQ5DGLR
ꑣ鴳ꑀ,$0
ꩫ驛뎗0DUFK
Alpine Electronics, Inc
Made in Japan

際闘뇐ꚯ
Volvo Car Korea
ꚷꚯ녋鶔뗣뤏ꍧ껿
꫗끳겗끤ꩫ霧뼗驣  鶔ꚷꚯꠇ黤 런
ꚷꚯ녋鶔뗣際闘꫷뫫
http://www.volvocars.com/kr

ꩧ끤녋늷넓ꩧ뼨
ೇ鲴뼯ꓯꫛ꫟ꟿ鱏놿볇뿷겛閻鱠ꫬ넯녃냷ꕻꈗ넳ꑀ꼃놿隷隻ꇣ鷗꫗ꟿ걟鱏뼛ꯓ꾁거鲃鲟

``

377
09 Specifications

09 Type approval

Country
Singa-
pore:

The Uni-
ted Arab
Emirates:

Jordan: The product that contains the Bluetooth module is approved with the following certification number.
BT module certification number: TRC/LPD/2010/4.
BT module name: IAM2.1BT PWB EU

378
09 Specifications

Type approval 09

Country
South
Africa:

Uruguay: This product contains URSEC approved transmitter [module name and model name (IAM2.1 BT PWB EU + BVJG905A, BVVE905A,
BVLV905A)]

``

379
09 Specifications

09 Type approval

Country
Jamaica: Approved for use in Jamaica SMA EI: IAM2.1

Thailand: This telecommunication equipment conforms to NTC technical requirement.

Nigeria:

Mexico: Warning
"Este equipo opera a titulo secundario, consecuentemente, debe aceptar interferencias perjudiciales incluyendo equipos de la misma
clase y puede no causar interferencias a sistemas operando a titulo primario."
BluetoothŸ module installation information
This module board is to be installed only by the professional line operator and used only for car audio produced by ALPINE ELEC-
TRONICS, INC. When this BluetoothŸ Module Board is installed in the Car Audio, we shall consider the following points: 1. Since
"IAM2.1 BT PWB US" owns its FCC ID/IC Number, we shall affix an exterior label on the outside of the product if the FCC ID is not
visible. The exterior label shall use wording such as either "Contains Transmitter Module Board FCC ID: A269ZUA130 / IC: 700B-
IAM2101" or "Contains FCC ID: A269ZUA130 / IC: 700B-IAM2101". 2. "IAM2.1 BT PWB US" complies with requirements of subsections
15.19(a)(3) in FCC Rules Part 15 Subpart C. The manual statement 15.19 (a)(3) is included in User Guide of the product.
COFETEL No. RCPALIA10-0353

380
09 Specifications

Type approval 09

Country
Bot-
swana:

Croatia:

381
09 Specifications

09 Symbols in the display

General Symbols in the display Indicator and information symbols in the


There are a variety of different symbols in the combined instrument panel
Indicator and warning symbols in the
display in the car. The symbols are divided into Symbol Meaning Page
warning, indicator and information symbols. combined instrument panel
Shown below are the most common symbols Symbol Meaning Page Fault in the ABL 74, 89
with their meanings and a reference to where system*
in the manual further information can be found. Low oil pres- 76
For more information on symbols and text sure Emissions sys- 74
messages, see pages 74, 76 and 142. tem
Parking 76, 133, 135
- Red warning symbol, illuminates when brake Fault in the ABS 74, 132
a fault has been indicated which could affect system
Airbags - 19, 76
the safety and/or driveability of the car. At the SRS Rear fog lamp on 74, 90
same time an explanatory text is displayed in
the information display. Seatbelt 16, 76
reminder Stability system, 74, 169, 288
- Yellow information symbol, illuminates DSTC, Trailer
in combination with text in the information dis- Alternator 76 stability assist
play, when a deviation in any of the car's sys- not charging
Stability system, 74, 169
tems has occurred. The yellow symbol infor-
Fault in the 76, 132 sport mode
mation can also illuminate in combination with
other symbols. brake system
Engine pre- 74
Warning, 19, 30, 76, 77, heater (diesel)
safety mode 121
Low level in fuel 74, 163
tank

Information, 74
read display text

Main beam on 74, 89

382 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


09 Specifications

Symbols in the display 09

Symbol Meaning Page Symbol Meaning Page Symbol Meaning Page


Left-hand direc- 74 Adaptive cruise 183 Camera sensor*, 191,
tion indicators control* Laser sensor* 197,
201, 203
Right-hand 74
direction indica- Adaptive cruise 178, 185 Auto Brake*, Dis- 186,
tors control*, Distance tance Warning* 191, 197
Warning* (Distance (Distance Alert), City
DRIVe - Start/ 74, 123, 127
Alert) SafetyTM, Collision
Stop*
warning system*
Adaptive cruise 178, 185
Other information symbols in the control*, Distance Fuel-driven engine 163
combined instrument panel Warning* (Distance block heater and

G025102
Alert) passenger com-
Symbol Meaning Page
partment heater*
Adaptive cruise 177
Adaptive cruise 171,
control* ABL system* 89
control* 177, 183

Adaptive cruise 183


control* Radar sensor* 183,
186, 197 Fuel filler flap, right- 273
Adaptive cruise 183, 186 hand side
control*, Distance
Warning* (Distance Start/Stop*, Adap- 127, 183 Low battery 163
Alert) tive cruise control*

Speed limiter 173 Parking brake 135


Adaptive cruise 183, 186
control*, Distance
Warning* (Distance Rain sensor* 97
Alert)

``

* Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction. 383


09 Specifications

09 Symbols in the display

Symbol Meaning Page


Driver Alert System* 200

Driver Alert Sys- 201, 203


tem*, Lane Depar-
ture Warning*

Driver Alert Sys- 203


tem*, Lane Depar-
ture Warning*

Driver Alert Sys- 201


tem*, Time for a
break

Information symbols in the roof console


display
Symbol Meaning Page
Seatbelt reminder 18

Airbag, passenger 22, 23


seat, activated

Airbag, passenger 23
seat, deactivated

384 * Option/accessory, for more information, see Introduction.


09 Specifications

09

385
10 Alphabetical Index

A Air conditioning, AC................................. 159 Audio volume .......................................... 223


Air distribution.................................. 154, 161 phone.................................................. 254
10
ACC – Adaptive cruise control................. 175 phone/media player............................ 254
Air quality system IAQS .......................... 159
Active Bending Lights (ABL)...................... 89 ring signal, phone............................... 254
Air vents................................................... 154
Active chassis – FOUR-C........................ 170 Auto
Alarm.......................................................... 65 climate control settings...................... 158
Active Xenon headlamps........................... 89 alarm indicator...................................... 65
Automatic car washes............................. 344
Adaptation............................................... 115 alarm signals......................................... 66
arming................................................... 65 Automatic gearbox.................................. 117
Adapting driving characteristics.............. 170
checking the alarm............................... 49 manual gear positions (Geartronic)..... 118
Adaptive cruise control............................ 175 towing and recovery........................... 289
deactivate............................................. 65
fault tracing......................................... 182 trailer................................................... 284
deactivating a triggered alarm.............. 66
radar sensor........................................ 181
reduced alarm level.............................. 66 Automatic locking...................................... 61
Adaptive cruise control fault tracing........ 182
Alcolock................................................... 108 Automatic relocking................................... 59
Additional heater (Diesel)......................... 165
Allergy and asthma inducing sub- Auxiliary heater........................................ 165
Adjusting headlamp pattern...................... 93 stances.................................................... 153 AUX input......................................... 222, 240
halogen headlamp................................ 94
All-wheel drive, AWD............................... 130 AWD, All-wheel drive............................... 130
Adjusting the steering wheel...................... 87
All Wheel Drive (AWD).............................. 130
Airbag
Approach light, duration...................... 48, 93
activating/deactivating, PACOS........... 22
driver's and front passenger side......... 20 Audio B
key switch off........................................ 22 settings....................................... 226, 227
Backrest..................................................... 82
surround..................................... 220, 227
AIRBAG ..................................................... 20 front seat, lowering............................... 82
audio system .......................................... 222
Airbag system ........................................... 19 Backrest rear seat, lowering...................... 85
Audio system........................................... 220
Air conditioning........................................ 159 Bag holder .............................................. 279
functions............................................. 226
general................................................ 152
overview.............................................. 222

386
10 Alphabetical Index

Battery............................................. 327, 369 filling brake fluid.................................. 318 CD ........................................................... 236


maintenance....................................... 327 symbols in the combined instrument Centre console........................................ 144 10
remote control ................................... 250 panel................................................... 132
Chassis settings...................................... 170
remote control key/PCC....................... 53 Bulbs, see Lighting.................................. 319
start assistance................................... 116 Checking and topping up the coolant..... 316
symbols on the battery....................... 328 Checking the engine oil level................... 313

C
warning symbols................................. 328 Children..................................................... 31
Bioethanol E85........................................ 275 child safety locks.................................. 38
Blind spot (BLIS)...................................... 211 Calls child seats and side airbags................. 24
incoming............................................. 253 location in the car................................. 31
Blind Spot Information System, BLIS...... 211
operation............................................. 253 safety.................................................... 31
BluetoothŸ
Camera sensor................................ 189, 195 Child safety locks...................................... 64
handsfree ........................................... 251
media ................................................. 243 Car care................................................... 344 Child seat................................................... 31
microphone off .................................. 253 Car care, leather upholstery.................... 346 Child seats................................................. 31
streaming audio ................................. 243 Cargo area integrated two-stage booster cushion. 36
transfer call to mobile ........................ 253 cargo cover......................................... 281 ISOFIX fixture system for child seats. . . 38
Bonnet, opening...................................... 312 lighting.................................................. 92 recommended...................................... 33
loading................................................ 278 size classes for child seats with the ISO-
Brake and clutch fluid.............................. 317
mounting points.................................. 279 FIX fixture system................................. 38
Brake light.................................................. 90 upper mounting points for child seats.. 42
safety grille.......................................... 281
Brakes...................................................... 131 safety net............................................ 280 Cigarette lighter socket............................ 216
anti-lock braking system, ABS........... 131
Cargo cover............................................. 281 City Safety™............................................ 188
brake light............................................. 90
brake system...................................... 131 Car upholstery......................................... 346 Cleaning
electric parking brake......................... 133 Car wash.................................................. 344 automatic car washes......................... 344
Emergency Brake Assistance, EBA ... 131 car wash............................................. 344
Catalytic converter................................... 274
emergency brake lights........................ 90 rims..................................................... 345
recovery.............................................. 290

387
10 Alphabetical Index

seatbelts............................................. 347 Controls Distance Warning.................................... 185


upholstery........................................... 346 centre console.................................... 144 Dolby Surround Pro Logic II.................... 220
10
Clean Zone Interior Package (CZIP)........ 153 Controls, lights........................................... 88 Door mirrors............................................. 102
Climate control........................................ 152 Cooling system........................................ 270 Driveable punctured tyres........................ 304
general................................................ 152 Corner Traction Control .......................... 168 Driver Alert Control.................................. 199
sensors............................................... 152
Crash, see Collision................................... 30 Driver Alert System.................................. 199
Clock, setting............................................. 78
Cruise control.......................................... 171 Driving...................................................... 270
CO2 emissions ........................................ 363
CZIP (Clear Zone Interior Package)......... 153 cooling system.................................... 270
Collision..................................................... 30 with the tailgate open......................... 271
Collision warning............................. 192, 193 with trailer........................................... 283
Collision warning system D Driving in water........................................ 270
radar sensor........................ 181, 188, 193 Driving with a trailer
DAB Radio............................................... 233
Collision Warning with Auto Brake*......... 192 towball load........................................ 355
Deadlock towing capacity.................................. 355
Colour code, paint................................... 348
deactivation.......................................... 62
DSTC, see also Stability control system.. 169
Combined instrument panel.................... 142 temporary deactivation......................... 63
DVD ......................................................... 236
Comfort inside the passenger compart- Deadlocks.................................................. 62
ment......................................................... 215
Defroster.................................................. 159
Comfort lighting......................................... 93
Compass................................................. 105
Diesel....................................................... 275 E
Diesel particle filter.................................. 276
calibration........................................... 105 ECC, electronic climate control............... 155
Dipstick, electronic.................................. 315
Condensation in headlamps.................... 344 Economical driving.................................. 270
Direction indicators.................................... 91
controls ECO pressure.......................................... 301
centre console ........................... 223, 263 Disengaging the gear selector inhibitor... 120
Eco Start/Stop DRIVe.............................. 123
Display lighting.......................................... 88

388
10 Alphabetical Index

Electrical socket...................................... 217 filter..................................................... 313 Flexifuel.................................................... 114


cargo area........................................... 279 oil grade.............................................. 359 adaptation........................................... 115
10
front seat............................................. 217 Engine specifications............................... 358 Fluids, capacities..................................... 361
Electric parking brake.............................. 133 Environmental labelling, FSC, owner's Fluids and oils.......................................... 361
low battery voltage............................. 133 manual....................................................... 12 Fog lamps
releasing automatically....................... 134
Error messages rear........................................................ 90
releasing manually.............................. 134
Driver Alert Control............................. 201 Foot brake............................................... 131
Emergency equipment Lane Departure Warning..................... 203
warning triangle.................................. 302 FOUR-C – Active chassis........................ 170
see Messages and symbols....... 135, 183
Emergency puncture repair..................... 305 FSC, environmental labelling..................... 12
Error messages in BLIS........................... 213
Emissions of carbon dioxide................... 277 Fuel.......................................................... 274
Error messages in Distance Alert............ 186
fuel consumption................................ 363
Engine Error messages in the Adaptive cruise con- fuel economy...................................... 301
overheating......................................... 283 trol............................................................ 183 fuel filter.............................................. 276
starting................................................ 112
ETC, electronic temperature control ....... 156 Fuse box.................................................. 333
Engine block heater................................. 114
Expectant mothers, seatbelt...................... 17 glovebox............................................. 338
fuel-driven........................................... 162
External dimensions................................ 354 Fuses....................................................... 333
Engine compartment
box in cargo area................................ 341
coolant................................................ 316
changing............................................. 333
oil........................................................ 313
overview.............................................. 313 F cold zone............................................
general................................................
342
333
power steering fluid............................ 318
Fan........................................................... 157 relay/fuse box in engine compart-
Engine drag control ................................ 168 ment.................................................... 334
Fault tracing for the camera sensor. 190, 196
Engine oil......................................... 313, 359 Start/Stop........................................... 342
First aid equipment.................................. 302
adverse driving conditions.................. 359 Fuse table
capacities........................................... 359 First aid kit .............................................. 302
fuses in engine compartment............. 335

389
10 Alphabetical Index

G Headlamps............................................... 319 Indicator lamps, PCC................................ 49

10 Head restraint Inflatable curtain........................................ 26


Gearbox................................................... 117 centre seat, rear.................................... 84 Information and warning symbols............. 74
automatic............................................ 117 lowering.......................................... 85, 86
manual................................................ 117 Information button, PCC............................ 49
Heated washer nozzles.............................. 98
Gear selector inhibitor............................. 119 Information displays.................................. 73
Heating.................................................... 158
Gear selector inhibitor, mechanical disen- Infotainment system ............................... 220
rearview and door mirrors.................. 103
gagement................................................. 120 basic functions .................................. 223
rear window........................................ 103
menus ................................................ 263
Geartronic................................................ 118 seats................................................... 157
overview ............................................. 222
Glass Heat-reflecting windscreen...................... 100 source buttons ................................... 222
laminated/reinforced........................... 100 High engine temperature......................... 283 voice control....................................... 259
Global opening........................................ 153 High-pressure headlamp washing............. 98 Inlaid mats............................................... 216
Glovebox................................................. 216 HomeLinkŸ .............................................. 137 Instrument lighting, see Lighting................ 88
locking.................................................. 61
Home safe lighting..................................... 93 Instrument overview
Gross vehicle weight............................... 355 left-hand drive....................................... 70
Hoot........................................................... 87
GSI - Gear selector assistance................ 125 right-hand drive.................................... 72
Horn........................................................... 87
Instruments and controls........................... 70
Interior lighting, see Lighting..................... 92
H I Interior rearview mirror............................. 104
Hazard warning flashers............................ 91 automatic dimming............................. 104
IAQS – Interior Air Quality System........... 153 Intermittent wiping..................................... 97
Headlamp levelling.................................... 88
IC – Inflatable Curtain................................ 26
Headlamp pattern, adjusting..................... 93 iPodŸ, connection................................... 240
Ignition keys............................................... 80
Headlamp pattern adjustment
Immobiliser................................................ 47
Active Bending Lights .......................... 94

390
10 Alphabetical Index

K bulbs, specifications........................... 324 Locking/unlocking


controls................................................. 92 inside.................................................... 59
10
Kerb weight.............................................. 355 display lighting...................................... 88 tailgate.................................................. 61
Key............................................................. 46 headlamp levelling................................ 88 Locks
home safe lighting................................ 93 automatic locking................................. 59
Key blade................................................... 50
in passenger compartment................... 92 locking.................................................. 59
Keyless drive...................................... 55, 112 instrument lighting................................ 88 unlocking.............................................. 59
Keyless start (keyless drive)............... 55, 112 main/dipped beam............................... 88
Lubricants................................................ 361
Keypad in the steering position/parking lamps......................... 90
rear fog lamp........................................ 90 Lubricants, capacities.............................. 361
wheel................................. 87, 145, 171, 224
Key positions............................................. 80 Lighting, bulb replacement...................... 319
bulb holder, rear................................. 322
bulb holder, rear, direction indicators. 322 M
cargo area........................................... 323
L dipped beam halogen......................... 321
Main/dipped beam, see Lightning............. 88
direction indicators............................. 322 Maintenance
Labels...................................................... 352
main beam, Xenon lamp..................... 321 rustproofing........................................ 345
Laminated glass....................................... 100 main beam halogen............................ 321 Making calls............................................. 253
Lamps, see Lighting................................ 319 number plate lighting.......................... 323
Manual gearbox....................................... 117
Lane Departure Control........................... 202 vanity mirror........................................ 323
GSI - Gear selector assistance........... 125
Laser sensor................................................ 9 Light switches............................................ 88 towing and recovery........................... 289
Leather upholstery, washing instructions 346 Loading Manual gear positions (Geartronic).......... 118
cargo area........................................... 278
Lighting.................................................... 319 Max. roof load ......................................... 355
general................................................ 278
Active Xenon headlamps...................... 89 Media, BluetoothŸ ................................... 243
mounting points.................................. 279
approach light, duration................. 48, 93
roof load............................................. 278 media player ........................................... 236
automatic lighting, passenger compart-
ment...................................................... 92 Lock confirmation ..................................... 46 Memory function in seats.......................... 83

391
10 Alphabetical Index

Menu navigation, Infotainment ............... 263 remove with the air vents................... 161 Panic function............................................ 48
Menus/Functions..................................... 146 timer function...................................... 159 Park assist camera.................................. 208
10
Menus and messages.............................. 142 Mobile phone Parking assistance................................... 205
connect............................................... 254 parking assistance sensors................ 207
Menu structure, Infotainment ................. 263
handsfree............................................ 251
Menu system MY CAR............................ 144 Parking brake........................................... 133
register phone..................................... 252
Messages and symbols voice control....................................... 259 Parking heater.......................................... 162
Collision Warning with Auto battery and fuel................................... 162
MY CAR................................................... 144
Brake.......................................... 191, 197 parking on a hill.................................. 162
Distance Alert..................................... 186 time setting......................................... 164
Driver Alert Control............................. 201
Lane Departure Warning..................... 203
O Passenger compartment......................... 215
Passenger compartment filter................. 153
Messages and symbols in the Adaptive Oil, see also Engine oil............................. 359 Passenger compartment heater
cruise control........................................... 183 Oil level low.............................................. 313 fuel-driven........................................... 162
Messages in BLIS.................................... 213 Overheating............................................. 283 PCC – Personal Car Communicator
Messages in the combined instrument Owner's manual, environmental labelling.. 12 functions............................................... 47
panel........................................................ 142 range............................................... 48, 49
Messages in the information display....... 169 Pedestrian protection.............................. 192
Meters in the combined instrument panel P Petrol grade............................................. 274
fuel gauge............................................. 74 Phone
speedometer......................................... 74 PACOS....................................................... 22
connect............................................... 254
tachometer........................................... 74 PACOS, switch.......................................... 22 handsfree............................................ 251
Misting..................................................... 159 Paintwork incoming calls..................................... 253
attending to the windows................... 152 colour code......................................... 348 making calls........................................ 253
condensation in headlamps............... 344 damage and touch-up........................ 347 phone book......................................... 255
phone book, shortcut......................... 255
Panel lighting............................................. 88

392
10 Alphabetical Index

receiving a call.................................... 253 DAB ................................................... 233 Remote control, HomeLinkŸ


register phone..................................... 252 menu structure .................................. 263 programmable ................................... 137
10
voice control....................................... 259 Rain sensor................................................ 97 Remote control key................................... 46
Pinch protection, sunroof........................ 107 Rear bulbs battery replacement.............................. 53
Polishing.................................................. 345 location............................................... 322 detachable key blade........................... 50
functions............................................... 47
Position/parking lamps.............................. 90 Rearview and door mirrors
range..................................................... 48
Power seat................................................. 83 compass............................................. 105
door.................................................... 102 Remote control key system, type appro-
Powershift gearbox.......................... 120, 289 val............................................................ 370
electrically retractable......................... 103
Power sunroof......................................... 106 heating................................................ 103 Resetting the door mirrors....................... 103
Power windows....................................... 100 interior................................................. 104 Resetting the power windows................. 102
Privacy locking........................................... 51 Rear window, defrosting.......................... 103 Retractable power door mirrors............... 103
Recirculation............................................ 159 Reverse gear inhibitor.............................. 117
Recommendations during driving............ 270
Q Recommended child seats, table.............. 33
Rims
cleaning.............................................. 345
Queue Assist............................................ 179 Recovery.................................................. 291 Roof load, max. weight ........................... 355
Queue Assistant....................................... 179 Refrigerant............................................... 152 Rustproofing............................................ 345
Refuelling................................................. 273
fuel cap............................................... 273
R fuel filler flap, electrical opening......... 273 S
fuel filler flap, manual opening............ 273
Radar sensor........................................... 175 refuelling............................................. 273 Safety grille.............................................. 281
limitations........................................... 181 Relay/fuse box: see Fuses....................... 333 Safety mode.............................................. 30
Radio ...................................................... 229 Remote control ....................................... 249 Safety net................................................. 280
AM/FM ............................................... 229 battery replacement ........................... 250 Seat, see Seats.......................................... 82

393
10 Alphabetical Index

Seatbelt Stability and traction control system....... 168 Symbols and messages
rear seat................................................ 18 Stability system....................................... 168 Collision Warning with Auto
10
seatbelt tensioner................................. 18 Brake.......................................... 191, 197
Stains....................................................... 346
Seatbelt reminder...................................... 18 Distance Alert..................................... 186
Start assistance....................................... 116 Driver Alert Control............................. 201
Seatbelts.................................................... 16
Steering force, speed related.................. 170 Lane Departure Warning..................... 203
Seats.......................................................... 82
Steering force level, see Steering force... 170 Symbols and messages in the Adaptive
head restraints, rear.............................. 84
Steering lock............................................ 113 cruise control........................................... 183
heating................................................ 157
lowering the front backrest................... 82 Steering wheel........................................... 87
lowering the rear backrest.................... 85 keypad.......................... 87, 145, 171, 224
power seats.......................................... 83 keypad, adaptive cruise control......... 177 T
Securing loads (Loading)......................... 279 steering wheel adjustment.................... 87
Tailgate
Sensus....................................................... 79 Stone chips and scratches...................... 347 locking/unlocking.................................. 61
Service programme................................. 312 Storage spaces in the passenger compart- Temperature
ment......................................................... 215 actual temperature............................. 152
Set time interval....................................... 185
Sunroof Temperature control................................ 158
Side airbags............................................... 24
opening and closing........................... 106
Signal input, external....................... 222, 240 Theatre lighting.......................................... 93
pinch protection.................................. 107
SIPS bags.................................................. 24 sunscreen........................................... 107 Timer........................................................ 159
Soot filter................................................. 276 ventilation position.............................. 106 Total airing function........................... 60, 153
Soot filter full............................................ 276 Sunscreen, sunroof.................................. 107 Towbar
Surround.......................................... 220, 227 detachable, attachment ..................... 286
Spare wheel............................................. 299
detachable, removal .......................... 287
Spin control............................................. 168 Symbols................................................... 169
indicator symbols................................. 74 Towbar, see Towing equipment.............. 284
Spin control function............................... 168
information symbols............................. 74 Towing..................................................... 289
SST – Self Supporting run flat Tyres....... 304 warning symbols................................... 74 towing eye.......................................... 290

394
10 Alphabetical Index

Towing capacity....................................... 355 pressure.............................................. 301 W


Towing equipment................................... 284 puncture repair................................... 305
10
specifications...................................... 285 specifications...................................... 296 Warning lamp
speed ratings...................................... 297 adaptive cruise control....................... 175
Towing eye.............................................. 290
tread wear indicators.......................... 295 collision warning system.................... 193
TPMS – Tyre Pressure Monitoring........... 303 tyre pressure monitoring..................... 303 stability and traction control system. . 168
Trailer....................................................... 283 winter tyres......................................... 296 Warning lamps
cable................................................... 283 airbags SRS.......................................... 76
driving with a trailer............................ 283 alternator not charging......................... 76
snaking............................................... 288 U fault in brake system............................ 76
Trailer stability assist .............................. 168 low oil pressure..................................... 76
Unlocking parking brake applied........................... 76
Trailer Stability Assist.............................. 288
from the inside...................................... 60 seatbelt reminder.................................. 76
Transmission............................................ 117 from the outside................................... 59 warning................................................. 76
Transponder............................................ 100 USB, connection...................................... 240 Warning sound
Trip computer.......................................... 166 collision warning system.................... 193
Trip meter.................................................. 77 Warning symbol, airbag system................ 19
TSA - trailer stability assist ............. 168, 288 V Warning triangle....................................... 302
TV............................................................. 246 Vanity mirror...................................... 92, 217 Washer fluid, filling................................... 326
Type approval, remote control key sys- Ventilation................................................ 154 Washer nozzles, heated............................. 98
tem........................................................... 370
Vibration damper..................................... 284 Washers
Type designation..................................... 352 rear window.......................................... 98
Voice control, mobile phone.................... 259
Tyres washer fluid, filling.............................. 326
Volvo Sensus............................................. 79 windscreen........................................... 98
direction of rotation............................ 294
driving characteristics......................... 294 Water and dirt-repellent coating.............. 100
maintenance....................................... 294
Water-repellent surface, cleaning............ 345

395
10 Alphabetical Index

Waxing..................................................... 345 Wipers and washing.................................. 97

10 Weights
kerb weight......................................... 355
Wheels
changing............................................. 298
installation........................................... 299
rims..................................................... 295
snow chains........................................ 296
spare wheel........................................ 299
Wheels and tyres..................................... 294
Whiplash injury, WHIPS............................. 27
WHIPS
child seat/booster cushion................... 27
whiplash injury...................................... 27
Windows, rearview and door mirrors....... 100
Windscreen washing.................................. 98
Windscreen wipers.................................... 97
rain sensor............................................ 97
Winter driving........................................... 271
Winter tyres.............................................. 296
Wiper blades............................................ 325
changing............................................. 325
cleaning.............................................. 326
replacing, rear window....................... 326
service position................................... 325

396
Kdakd8Vg8dgedgVi^dc51 &OHMJTI
"5 1SJOUFEJO4XFEFO (zUFCPSH $PQZSJHIU©7PMWP$BS$PSQPSBUJPO

También podría gustarte